1996 econoline

388

Upload: nerijus-budzius

Post on 08-Apr-2015

877 views

Category:

Documents


0 download

TRANSCRIPT

Page 1: 1996 econoline

[PI00400( E )02/95]

thirty-six pica chart:0021231-D

File:01ltpie.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:23:53 1996

Page 2: 1996 econoline

*[PI00800( ALL)04/95]

thirty-six pica chart:

File:01ltpie.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:23:53 1996

Page 3: 1996 econoline

*[PI02300( ALL)04/01]

Table of Contents

Introductory Information ............................... 1

Safety Restraints ............................................ 11

Starting Your Econoline ............................... 55

Warning Lights and Gauges ....................... 67

Instrument Panel Controls .......................... 81

Steering Column Controls .......................... 99

Features .......................................................... 113

Electronic Sound Systems ......................... 149

Driving Your Econoline ............................. 195

Roadside Emergencies ................................ 243

Customer Assistance ................................... 259

Reporting Safety Defects........................ 266

Accessories .................................................... 271

Servicing Your Econoline .......................... 279

Quick Index .................................................. 369

Index ............................................................... 377

File:01ltpie.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:23:53 1996

Page 4: 1996 econoline

1

Introductory Information

*[IN00300( ALL)04/95] Ford’s Commitment to You

*[IN00400( ALL)04/95] At Ford Motor Company, excellence is thecontinuous commitment to achieve the bestresult possible. It is dedication to learning whatyou want, determination to develop the rightconcept, and execution of that concept with care,precision, and attention to detail. In short,excellence means being the standard by whichothers are judged.

*[IN00500( ALL)04/95] Our Guiding Principles

*[IN00600( ALL)04/95] ❑Quality comes first. For your satisfaction, thequality of our products and services must beour number one priority.

*[IN00700( ALL)04/95] ❑You are the focus of everything we do. Ourwork must be done with you in mind,providing better products and services thanour competition.

*[IN00750( ALL)04/95] ❑Continuous improvement is essential to oursuccess. We must strive for excellence ineverything we do: in our products — in theirsafety and value — and in our services, ourhuman relations, our competitiveness, andour profitability.

*[IN00800( ALL)04/95] ❑Employee involvement is our way of life.We are a team. We must treat one anotherwith trust and respect.

*[IN00900( ALL)04/95] ❑Dealers and suppliers are our partners. Wemust maintain mutually beneficialrelationships with dealers, suppliers, and ourother business associates.

File:02ltine.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:46 1996

Page 5: 1996 econoline

2

*[IN01000( ALL)04/95] ❑ Integrity is never compromised. Our conductworldwide must be pursued in a manner thatis socially responsible and commands respectfor its integrity and for its positivecontributions to society.

*[IN01100( ALL)05/95] Things to Know About UsingThis Guide

*[IN01112(BEF )05/95] Congratulations on the purchase of your newvehicle. This guide has information about theequipment and the options for your new vehicle.You may not have bought all of the optionsavailable to you. If you do not know whichinformation applies to your vehicle, talk to yourdealer.

*[IN01137(BEF )05/95] This guide describes equipment and givesspecifications for equipment that was in effectwhen this guide was approved for printing. Fordmay discontinue models or change specificationsor design without any notice and withoutincurring obligation.

*[IN01162( ALL)05/95] NOTES and WARNINGS

*[IN01164( ALL)05/95] NOTES give you additional information aboutthe subject matter you are referencing.

*[IN01166( ALL)05/95] WARNINGS remind you to be especially carefulin those areas where carelessness can causedamage to your vehicle or personal injury toyourself, your passengers or other people. Pleaseread all WARNINGS carefully.

*[IN01168( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

File:02ltine.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:46 1996

Page 6: 1996 econoline

3

*[IN01600( ALL)05/95] Finding Information in This Guide

[IN01700( ALL)04/95] After you have read this guide once, you willprobably return to it when you have a specificquestion or need additional information. To helpyou find specific information quickly, you canuse the table of contents or the index.

*[IN01800(BEF )05/95] The Quick Index at the end of the bookprovides a page number following each itemwhich indicates where detailed information canbe found.

*[IN02000( ALL)06/95] This guide has a table of contents at thebeginning of the book to show chapter titles.

*[IN02100( ALL)05/95] To use the Index, turn to the back of the bookand search in the alphabetical listing for theword that best describes the information youneed. If the word you chose is not listed, thinkof other related words and look them up. Wehave designed the Index so that you can findinformation under a technical term.

%*[IN02200( ALL)05/95] Canadian Owners — French Version

*[IN02300( ALL)06/95] French Owner Guides can be obtained from yourdealer or by writing to Ford Motor Company ofCanada, Limited, Service Publications, P.O. Box1580, Station B, Mississauga, Ontario L4Y 4G3.

*[IN02400( ALL)04/95] Your Maintenance Schedule andRecord Booklet

*[IN02500( ALL)03/95] The Maintenance Schedule and Record booklet liststhe services that are most important for keepingyour vehicle in good condition. A record log isalso provided to help you keep track of allservices performed.

File:02ltine.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:46 1996

Page 7: 1996 econoline

4

*[IN02600( ALL)01/95] About the Warranties

*[IN02700(BEF )04/95] Your vehicle is covered by three types ofwarranties: Basic Vehicle Warranty, ExtendedWarranties on certain parts, and EmissionsWarranties.

%*[IN03100( ALL)03/95] Read your Warranty Information Booklet carefullyto find out about your vehicle’s warranties andyour basic rights and responsibilities.

*[IN03250( ALL)03/95] If you lose your Warranty Information Booklet, youcan get a new one free of charge. Contact anyFord or Lincoln-Mercury dealer, or refer to theaddresses and phone numbers on the first pageof this owner guide.

%*[IN04000( ALL)01/95] Buying a Ford Extended Service Plan

*[IN04100( ALL)01/94] If you bought your vehicle in the U.S., you canbuy a Ford Extended Service Plan for yourvehicle. This optional contract provides serviceprotection for a longer period of time than thebasic warranty that comes with your vehicle.

*[IN04200( ALL)01/95] You do not have to buy this option when youbuy your vehicle. However, your option topurchase the Ford Extended Service Plan runsout after 18 months or 18,000 miles. See yourdealer for more details about the Ford ExtendedService Plan.

*[IN04250( ALL)01/95] If you purchased a Canadian vehicle and did nottake advantage of the Ford Extended ServicePlan at the time of purchase, you may still beeligible. See your dealer for the details.

File:02ltine.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:46 1996

Page 8: 1996 econoline

5

%*[IN04600( EF )06/92] Special Notices

%*[IN04820( EF )02/89] NOTICE TO OWNERS OFLIGHT TRUCK AMBULANCECONVERSIONS

*[IN04900( EF )03/91] If your light truck is equipped with the FordAmbulance Preparation Package, it can beutilized as an ambulance. Ford urges ambulancemanufacturers to follow the recommendations ofthe Ford Incomplete Vehicle Manual, FordTruck Body Builder’s Layout Book, and theQVM Guidelines as well as pertinentsupplements. For further information, please callthe Light Truck Body Builders Advisory Serviceon 1-800-635-5560.

*[IN05000( EF )12/91] Use of your Ford light truck as an ambulance,without the Ford Ambulance PreparationPackage voids the Ford New Vehicle LimitedWarranty and may void the EmissionsWarranties. In addition, ambulance usagewithout the preparation package could causehigh underbody temperatures, overpressurizedfuel, and a risk of spraying fuel which couldlead to fires. If your light truck is equipped withthe Ford Ambulance Preparation Package it willsay so on its information decal. The decal islocated on the driver’s side door pillar or on therear edge of the driver’s door. You candetermine whether the ambulance manufacturerfollowed Ford’s recommendations by directlycontacting that manufacturer. NOTE: FordAmbulance Preparation Package is onlyavailable on certain 7.3L Diesel Econoline andF-Series vehicles.

File:02ltine.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:46 1996

Page 9: 1996 econoline

6

%*[IN05050( EF )02/89] NOTICE TO OWNERS OFDIESEL-POWERED VEHICLES

*[IN05070( EF )04/89] Read the 7.3L Diesel Engine Owner’s GuideSupplement for information regarding correctoperation and maintenance of yourdiesel-powered light truck.

%*[IN05100( ALL)06/95] Your Vehicle IdentificationNumber (VIN)

*[IN05200( ALL)06/95] Your Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is thesame as the warranty number that appears onyour owner card. You should include thisnumber any time you write to Ford MotorCompany about your vehicle.

*[IN05300(BEF )06/95] The Vehicle Identification Number is attached toyour vehicle in the following places:

*[IN05350( EF )05/90] Complete Ford Built Vehicles

*[IN05400(BEF )05/95] ❑on the metal tag attached to the top of theinstrument panel on the driver’s side — youcan see the tag by looking through thewindshield from outside your vehicle.

*[IN05450(BEF )10/89]

one inch art:0010558-A

Vehicle Identification Number (VIN/Serial Number)

%*[IN05500(BEF )06/95] ❑on the Safety Compliance Certification Label— this label is attached to the left front doorlock facing or the door latch post pillar. It isrequired by the National Highway TrafficSafety Administration and is made of specialmaterial. If someone tampers with it, it willbe destroyed and/or a destruction patternwill appear.

File:02ltine.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:46 1996

Page 10: 1996 econoline

7

*[IN05515( ALL)05/95] The label contains the name of the manufacturer,the month and year of manufacture, thecertification statement and the VehicleIdentification Number. The label also containsGross Vehicle Weight Rating and Gross AxleWeight Ratings, wheel and tire data andinformation codes for additional vehicle data.For further information about the SafetyCompliance Certification Label and theinformation contained on it, refer to the Index.

*[IN05520( EFM)05/90] Incomplete Vehicles

*[IN05530( EFM)12/91] On completed derivations of incomplete vehicles,the Safety Compliance Certification Label isaffixed at a location determined by a subsequentstage manufacturer of the completed vehicle. Inthese cases the completed vehicle ismanufactured in two (or more) stages by two (ormore) separate manufacturers, with themanufacture of the completed vehicle occurringat a later date than the manufacture of theincomplete vehicle. Consequently, the modelyear of the completed vehicle may be later thanthe model year of its chassis.

%*[IN05545( ALL)06/95] Federal Highway AdministrationRegulation

*[IN05560( ALL)06/95] Regulations such as those issued by the FederalHighway Administration or issued pursuant tothe Occupational Safety and Health Act (OSHA),and/or state and local laws and regulations mayrequire additional equipment for the way youintend to use the vehicle. It is the responsibilityof the registered owner to determine theapplicability of such laws and regulations toyour intended use for the vehicle, and toarrange for the installation of requiredequipment. Your Ford dealer has informationabout the availability of many items ofequipment which may be ordered for yourvehicle.

File:02ltine.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:46 1996

Page 11: 1996 econoline

8

*[IN06000( ALL)01/95] Breaking Your Vehicle In

*[IN06100( ALL)03/95] Your new vehicle goes through an adjustment orbreak-in period during the first 1,000 miles(1,600 km) that you drive it. During the break-inperiod, you need to pay careful attention to howyou drive your vehicle.

%*[IN06300( ALL)01/95] ❑Avoid sudden stops. Because your vehiclehas new brake linings, you should take thesesteps:

*[IN06400( ALL)01/95] — Watch traffic carefully so that you cananticipate when to stop.

*[IN06500( ALL)01/95] — Begin braking well in advance.

*[IN06600( ALL)01/95] — Apply the brakes gradually.

*[IN06700( ALL)01/95] The break-in period for new brake liningslasts for 100 miles (160 km) of city driving or1,000 miles (1,600 km) of highway driving.

*[IN06750( ALL)12/93] ❑Wheel lug nuts must be retightened to propertorque specifications at 500 miles/800 km ofnew vehicle operation. Proper torquespecifications are provided in this guide. Alsoretighten to proper torque specification at 500miles/800 km after any wheel change or anyother time the wheel lug nuts have beenloosened.

%*[IN06800(BEF )01/95] ❑Use only the type of engine oil that Fordrecommends. See Engine oil recommendationsin the Index. Do not use special “break-in”oils.

File:02ltine.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:46 1996

Page 12: 1996 econoline

9

%*[IN07100(BEF )04/95] Cleaning the Outside of YourVehicle

%*[IN07200(BEF )04/95] Washing and Polishing Your Vehicle

*[IN07300(BEF )04/95] Wash the outside of your vehicle, including theunderside, with a mild detergent.

*[IN07400(BEF )06/95] DO NOT:

*[IN07500(BEF )04/95] ❑Wash your vehicle with hot water

*[IN07600(BEF )04/95] ❑Wash your vehicle while it sits in directsunlight

*[IN07700(BEF )04/95] ❑Wash your vehicle while the body is hot

*[IN07800(BEF )05/95] Pollen, bird droppings and tree sap can damagethe paint, especially in hot weather. Wash yourvehicle as often as necessary to keep it clean.

*[IN07900(BEF )05/95] Take similar precautions if your vehicle isexposed to chemical industrial fallout.

*[IN08000(BEF )06/95] Paint damage resulting from fallout is notrelated to a defect in paint materials orworkmanship and therefore is not covered bywarranty. Ford, however, believes that continualimprovement in customer satisfaction is a highpriority. For this reason, Ford has authorized itsdealers to repair, at no charge to the owner, thesurfaces of new vehicles damaged byenvironmental fallout within 12 months or 12,000miles (20,000 km) of purchase, whichever comesfirst. Customers may be required to bring theirvehicle in for inspection by a Fordrepresentative.

*[IN08100(BEF )04/95] Polish your vehicle to remove harmful depositsand protect the finish.

File:02ltine.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:46 1996

Page 13: 1996 econoline

10

*[IN08200(BEF )04/95] Cleaning Chrome and Aluminum Parts

*[IN08300(BEF )04/95] Wash chrome and aluminum parts with thesame detergent you use to wash the vehiclebody, such as Ford Premium Car WashConcentrate. You can use Ford Extra StrengthTar and Road Oil Remover or equivalent toclean grease, oil, and tar from chrome-platedparts, including wheelcovers, aluminum wheels,bumpers, or anodized aluminum parts.

%*[IN08400(BEF )04/95] Cleaning Plastic Parts

*[IN08500(BEF )04/95] Some of your vehicle’s exterior trim parts areplastic. Clean with a tar and road oil remover ifnecessary. Use a vinyl cleaner for routinecleaning.

*[IN08600(BEF )04/95] Do not clean plastic parts with thinners, solventsor petroleum-based cleaners.

%*[IN08700(BEF )04/95] If you have your vehicle rustproofed, removeoversprayed rustproofing with a tar and road oilremover. If rustproofing is not removed fromplastic and rubber parts, it can causedeterioration.

File:02ltine.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:46 1996

Page 14: 1996 econoline

11

Safety Restraints

*[SR00500(BEF )04/95] Important Safety Belt Information

*[SR00600(BEF )03/95] The use of safety belts helps to restrain you andyour passengers in case of a collision. In moststates and in Canada the law requires their use.

*[SR00700(BEF )01/95] Safety belts provide best restraint when:

*[SR00800(BEF )01/95] ❑ the seatback is upright

*[SR00900(BEF )01/95] ❑ the occupant is sitting upright (not slouched)

*[SR01000(BEF )01/95] ❑ the lap belt is snug and low on the hips

*[SR01100(BEF )01/95] ❑ the shoulder belt is snug against the chest

*[SR01200(BEF )01/95] ❑ the knees are straight forward

*[SR02000(BEF )05/95] To help you remember to fasten your safety belt,a warning light may come on and a chime maysound. See Safety Belt Warning Light and Chime inthe Warning Lights and Gauges chapter.

*[SR02100(BEF )06/95] See the following sections in this chapter fordirections on how to properly use these safetybelts. Also see Safety Restraints for Children in thischapter for special instructions about usingsafety belts for children.

%*[SR02200(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Make sure that you and your passengerswear safety belts. Always drive and ridewith your seatback upright and the lapbelt snug and low across the hips.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 15: 1996 econoline

12

*[SR02400(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Passengers should not be allowed to ridein the cargo area. Persons not riding in aseat with a fastened seat belt are muchmore likely to suffer serious injury in acollision. Cargo should always be securedto prevent it from shifting and causingdamage to the vehicle or harm topassengers.

*[SR02500(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Never let a passenger hold a child on hisor her lap while the vehicle is moving.The passenger cannot protect the childfrom injury in a collision.

*[SR02600(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

To reduce the risk of serious injury in acollision, children should always ride withthe seatback upright.

*[SR02800(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Never wear the shoulder belt under thearm. Never swing it around the neck overthe inside shoulder. Never use a singlebelt for more than one person or acrossmore than one seating position. Eachseating position in your vehicle has aspecific safety belt assembly which ismade up of one buckle and one tonguethat are designed to be used as a pair.Failure to follow these precautions couldincrease the risk and/or severity of injuryin a collision.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 16: 1996 econoline

13

*[SR02900(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Lock the doors of your vehicle beforedriving to lessen the risk of the doorcoming open in a collision.

[SR02910( EF )04/95] Your vehicle is equipped with a dual lockingmode retractor on the shoulder belt portion ofthe combination lap/shoulder safety belt forfront seat passenger and rear seat outboardpassengers.

% [SR02930(BEF )04/95] Dual Locking Mode Retractors

[SR02940(BEF )04/95] Vehicle Sensitive (Emergency) Locking Mode

[SR02950(BEF )04/95] In this operating mode, the shoulder beltretractor will allow the occupant freedom ofmovement, locking tight only on hard braking,hard cornering or impacts of approximately5 mph (8 km/h) or more.

[SR02960(BEF )04/95] The front seat belt retractor can also be made tolock by pulling/jerking on the belt.

% [SR02970(BEF )04/95] Automatic Locking Mode

[SR02980(BEF )04/95] In this operating mode, the shoulder beltretractor will be automatically locked and remainlocked when the combination lap/shouldersafety belt is buckled, and does not allow theoccupant freedom of movement. This modeprovides the following:

[SR02990(BEF )04/95] ❑A tight lap/shoulder belt fit on occupant

[SR03000(BEF )04/95] ❑Child seat/infant carrier installation restraint

[SR03020(BEF )04/95] This mode must be used when installing a childseat on the front passenger seat and rearoutboard seats where dual locking retractors areprovided.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 17: 1996 econoline

14

[SR03030(BEF )04/95] To switch the retractor from the “emergencylocking mode” to the “automatic locking mode,”perform the following steps:

[SR03040(BEF )04/95] 1. Buckle the lap/shoulder combination belt.

[SR03050(BEF )04/95] 2. Grasp the shoulder portion of the belt andpull downward until all of the belt isextracted, and when allowed to retract, aclicking sound will be heard. At this time,the belt retractor is in the “automatic lockingmode” (child restraint mode).

[SR03060(BEF )04/95] 3. A clicking sound will continue to be heardas the belt is allowed to retract. Thisindicates that the retractor is in the“automatic locking mode.”

[SR03070(BEF )04/95] NOTE: When the combination lap/shoulderbelt is unbuckled and allowed toretract completely, the retractor willswitch back to the vehicle sensitive(emergency) locking mode. See thedetailed instructions under Safety Seatsfor Children in this chapter.

*[SR03120(BEF )05/95] Combination Lap and ShoulderBelts

*[SR03125(BEF )05/95] While your vehicle is in motion, the combinationlap and shoulder belt adjusts to your movement.However, if you brake hard, corner hard or ifyour truck receives an impact of 5 mph(8 km/h) or more, the combination lap/shoulderbelt locks and helps reduce your forwardmovement. The front seat belt systems can alsobe made to lock by jerking on the shoulder belt.

*[SR03130(BEF )05/95] NOTE: The rear belts cannot be made to lockup by jerking on shoulder belt.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 18: 1996 econoline

15

*[SR03135(BEF )05/95] After you get into your vehicle, close the doorand lock it. Then adjust the seat to the positionthat suits you best.

[SR03137(BEF )05/95] To fasten the belt

*[SR03140(BEF )05/95] Pull the combination lap/shoulder belt from theretractor so that the shoulder portion of the beltcrosses your shoulder and chest. Be sure the beltis not twisted. If it is, remove the twist. Insertthe belt tongue into the proper buckle until youhear a snap and feel it latch. Make sure thetongue is securely fastened to the buckle bypulling on tongue.

[SR03145( EF )05/95]

7-1/2 pica art:0020639-D

*[SR03160(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Use the shoulder belt on the outsideshoulder only. Never wear the shoulderbelt under the arm. Never swing it aroundthe neck over the inside shoulder. Neveruse a single belt for more than oneperson. Failure to follow these precautionscould increase the risk and/or severity ofinjury in a collision.

*[SR03165(BEF )05/95] To tighten the lap portion of the belt, pull up onthe shoulder belt until it fits you snugly. Thebelt should rest as low on your hips as possible.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 19: 1996 econoline

16

[SR03170( E )05/95] RWARNING

Front and rear seat occupants, includingpregnant women, should wear safety beltsfor optimum protection in an accident.

[SR03185(BEF )05/95] Due to folding rear seats, sometimes the bucklesand tongues toward the center of the vehiclemay be hidden by the rear edge of the seatcushion. Pull them out so they will be accessible.

[SR03190(BEF )05/95] While you are fastened in the seat belt, thecombination lap and shoulder belt adjusts toyour movement. However, if you brake hard,turn hard, or if your vehicle receives an impactof 5 mph (8 km/h) or more, the lap andshoulder belt will become locked and helpreduce your forward movement.

% [SR04300( E )05/95] All Three Passenger Bench/Bed Seat orCaptain’s Chair

*[SR04400( E )12/91] In addition to anchorages in the floor and roofstructures, some rear safety belts have adetachable anchor mounted to the outboard sideof the rear seats. This should remain attached,except when removing the rear seats.

*[SR04500( E )11/93] The second row passenger side outboard seatingposition uses a hook above the sliding/cargodoor to stow the shoulder safety belt whenentering or exiting the vehicle or when it is notbeing used.

*[SR04525( E )11/93] NOTE: When the belt is stowed using thehook, DO NOT use the hanging belt asan assist when entering the vehicle.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 20: 1996 econoline

17

[SR04701( E )03/93]

three fourths page art:0020854-B

Proper stowage of shoulder safety belt

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 21: 1996 econoline

18

[SR04750( E )05/95]

three fourths page art:0020784-C

Location of the stowage hook caution label on safety belt

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 22: 1996 econoline

19

[SR04800( E )05/91]

three fourths page art:0020783-B

Location of the detachable anchor warning label on safetybelt

[SR04850( E )05/95] In order to remove the rear seat, the safety beltmust be disengaged from the seat. To disengagethe safety belt from the seat, insert a key orsmall screwdriver into the slot provided on thedetachable anchor. Then lift upward. Seeprevious illustration.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 23: 1996 econoline

20

[SR05200( E )02/95] Whenever a rear seat has been removed, thetongue end of the detachable anchor must becorrectly stowed. See the following illustrations.

[SR05400( E )05/95]

two third page art:0020856-C

Rear seat shoulder safety belt — stowage (with seatremoved)

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 24: 1996 econoline

21

[SR05500( E )05/95]

two third page art:0020857-B

Rear seat shoulder safety belt — stowage (with seatremoved)

*[SR05600( E )06/95] RWARNING

When reinstalling a rear seat in yourvehicle it must be placed in its originalposition. Improper installation of the seatwill prevent correct use of the safety beltsand could increase the risk of injury.Refer to the warning label on the seatbelt.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 25: 1996 econoline

22

*[SR05700( E )03/95] After installing the rear seat, make sure thesafety belt is not twisted before you insert it intothe detachable anchor. A twisted safety belt maycause the retractor to not work properly. Theninsert the detachable anchor tongue into thedetachable anchor until you hear a “snap” andfeel the latch engage.

%*[SR06800(BEF )05/95] Adjustable Lap Belts Without Retractors

[SR07200( E )05/95] On the center seat of the three-passenger benchseat, and both inboard seats of thefour-passenger bench seat, you will find a lapbelt without a retractor, but does have a lockingadjustable tongue. Shorten and fasten these beltswhen you are not using them. To make eachbelt longer, tip the tongue at a right angle to thebelt and pull the belt over your lap until thetongue reaches the buckle.

[SR07400(BEF )05/95]

one third page art:0020638-C

Fastening occupant safety lap belts

[SR07500(BEF )04/95] To fasten the belt, pull the belt across your hipsand insert the tongue into the correct buckle onyour seat until you hear a snap and feel it latch.Make sure the buckle is securely fastened bypulling tongue.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 26: 1996 econoline

23

*[SR07600(BEF )05/95] Adjust the belt so that it fits snugly and as lowas possible around the hips:

*[SR07700(BEF )06/95] ❑ If you need to lengthen the belt, unfasten itand repeat the procedure above.

*[SR07800(BEF )06/95] ❑ If you need to shorten the belt, pull on theloose end of the webbing.

[SR08200( E )05/95] Safety Belt Bed/Seat Pocket

[SR08450( E )05/95]

one third page art:0020862-B

Location of the safety belt bed/seat pockets

[SR08500(BEF )05/95] To unfasten the belt:

[SR08525(BEF )05/95] 1. Push the release button on the buckle. Thisallows the tongue to unlatch from thebuckle.

[SR08550( EF )05/95]

7-1/2 pica art:0020639-D

Unfastening the outboard lap/shoulder belts

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 27: 1996 econoline

24

[SR08650(BEF )05/95] 2. While the belt retracts, guide the tongue toits stowed position. If you do not guide thetongue, it may strike you or part of thevehicle.

*[SR08800(BEF )03/95] How to Untwist or Unjam a Safety BeltRetractor

*[SR08900(BEF )03/95] If you should jam the lap belt retractor byallowing the belt to retract when it is twisted,you can free the webbing with this procedure:

*[SR09000(BEF )06/95] 1. Pull on the belt with both hands to tighten iton the retractor spool.

*[SR09100(BEF )03/95] 2. Feed the belt back into the retractor until itis completely retracted. Repeat previous stepif necessary.

[SR09200(BEF )02/95] 3. Pull the belt out of the retractor as far as itwill go and untwist the belt or remove theobject that is jamming the belt. Let the beltretract.

*[SR09300(BEF )03/95] 4. Then, pull the belt out and let it retractseveral times to make sure that the beltworks properly.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 28: 1996 econoline

25

[SR09505(BEF )06/95] Procedure to Correct a Twisted SafetyShoulder Belt at the “D” Ring (if soequipped) Front and/or Rear OutboardSeating Positions.

[SR09507(BEF )05/95] NOTE: The restraint system shown in thefollowing figures may be different thanthe restraint system in your vehicle.However, use these figures and thisprocedure to correct a twisted safetyshoulder belt at any outboard seatingposition that has a “D” ring.

[SR09510(BEF )05/95]

half page art:0060598-C

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 29: 1996 econoline

26

[SR09515(BEF )05/95] 1. Grasp the belt webbing at the “D” ring. SeeFigure 2.

[SR09520(BEF )05/95]

half page art:0060599-D

[SR09525(BEF )05/95] 2. Rotate and fold the belt webbing over itselfas required to remove the twist.

[SR09527(BEF )05/95] 3. Feed the folded portion of the belt throughthe “D” ring.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 30: 1996 econoline

27

[SR09530(BEF )05/95] 4. When completed, the safety belt should looklike Figure 3.

[SR09535(BEF )05/95]

half page art:0060600-D

%*[SR09600(BEF )06/95] Safety Belt Extension Assembly

*[SR09700(BEF )06/95] For some people, the safety belt may be tooshort even when it is fully extended. You canadd about eight inches (20 cm) to the belt lengthwith a safety belt extension assembly (partnumber 611C22). Safety belt extensions areavailable at no cost from your dealer.

*[SR09750(BEF )06/95] Use only extensions manufactured by the samesupplier as the safety belt. Manufactureridentification is located at the end of thewebbing on the label. Also, use the safety beltextension only if the safety belt is too short foryou when fully extended. Do not use extensionto change the fit of the shoulder belt across thetorso.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 31: 1996 econoline

28

*[SR09800(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Failure to follow these instructions willaffect the performance of the safety beltsand increase the risk of personal injury.

*[SR09900(BEF )06/95] Safety Belt Maintenance[SR10000(BEF )02/95] Check your safety belt system periodically to

make sure that it works properly and isn’tdamaged. If the webbing shows any wear, nicksor cuts, have it examined by a qualifiedtechnician to determine if replacement isnecessary. Always have your safety belt systemchecked after a collision by a qualifiedtechnician.

*[SR10200(BEF )05/95] All safety belt assemblies, including retractors,buckles, front seat belt buckle support assemblies(slide bar) (if so equipped), child safety seattether bracket assemblies (if so equipped), andattaching hardware, should be inspected afterany collision. Ford recommends that all safetybelt assemblies used in vehicles involved in acollision be replaced. However, if the collisionwas minor and a qualified technician finds thatthe belts do not show damage and continue tooperate properly, they do not need to bereplaced. Safety belt assemblies not in useduring a collision should also be inspected andreplaced if either damage or improper operationis noted.

%*[SR10210(BEF )06/95] Cleaning the Safety Belts

*[SR10220(BEF )06/95] Clean the safety belts with any mild soapsolution that is recommended for cleaningupholstery or carpets. Do not bleach or dye thebelt webbing because this may weaken it.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 32: 1996 econoline

29

*[SR10300(BEF )06/95] Air Bag Supplemental RestraintSystem (SRS)

[SR10475( E )02/95] Driver air bag for E-150, E-250 and E-350,except cutaway and strip chassis

[SR10550( E )01/94] If the letters “SRS” appear in the center of thesteering wheel, your vehicle is equipped with adriver side air bag supplemental restraintsystem, located in the steering wheel.

*[SR10600(BEF )05/95] The driver air bag is a Supplemental RestraintSystem (SRS), provided in addition to the driverlap/shoulder belt, and is designed tosupplement the protection provided to aproperly belted driver in moderate to severefrontal collisions. The supplemental air bagsystem does not provide restraint to the lowerbody.

*[SR10650(BEF )05/95] The Importance of Wearing Safety Belts

*[SR10700(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Safety belts must be worn by all vehicleoccupants to be properly restrained andhelp reduce the risk of injury in acollision.

*[SR10750(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

All occupants of the vehicle, including thedriver, should always wear their safetybelts, even when an air bag SupplementalRestraint System is provided.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 33: 1996 econoline

30

*[SR10900(BEF )01/95] There are four very important reasons to usesafety belts even with an air bag system. Useyour safety belts to:

[SR11000(BEF )02/95] ❑help keep you in the proper seating position(away from the air bag) when it inflates

*[SR11100(BEF )01/95] ❑ reduce the risk of harm in rollover, side orrear impact collisions, because an air bag isnot designed to inflate in such situations

*[SR11200(BEF )01/95] ❑ reduce the risk of harm in frontal collisionsthat are not severe enough to activate thesupplemental air bag

*[SR11300(BEF )01/95] ❑ reduce the risk of being thrown from yourvehicle

%*[SR11400(BEF )01/95] The Importance of Being Properly Seated

*[SR11500(BEF )05/95] In a collision, the air bag must inflate extremelyfast to help provide additional protection foryou. In order to do this, the air bag must inflatewith considerable force. If you are not seated ina normal riding position with your back againstthe seatback, the air bag may not protect youproperly and could possibly hurt you as itinflates.

*[SR11600(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Do not place objects or mount equipmenton or near the air bag cover on thesteering wheel or in front seat areas thatmay come in contact with a deploying airbag. Failure to follow this instruction mayincrease the risk of personal injury in theevent of a collision.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 34: 1996 econoline

31

*[SR11800(BEF )01/95] How the Air Bag Supplemental RestraintSystem Operates

*[SR11900(BEF )05/95] The air bag supplemental restraint system hastwo main parts. One part is the air bag systemwith the driver air bag and inflator located inthe center of the steering wheel. The second partis the electrical system, which has impactsensors, and a diagnostic module, and backuppower supply. The diagnostic module monitorsits own internal circuits and the supplemental airbag electrical system readiness, including theimpact sensors, the system wiring, the air bagsystem readiness light, air bag power, and theair bag ignitor.

[SR12100( E )05/91]

half page art:0020843-B

The location of the air bag and warning label

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 35: 1996 econoline

32

*[SR12200(BEF )06/95] The air bag system uses a readiness light on theinstrument cluster or a tone to indicate thecondition of the system. When you turn theignition to the ON position, this light willilluminate for approximately six (6) seconds andthen turn off. This indicates that the system isoperating normally. NOTE: Maintenance of theair bag system is not required.

*[SR12300(BEF )05/95] A problem with the system is indicated by oneor more of the following: the readiness light willeither flash or stay lit, or it will not light, or agroup of five beeps will be heard.

*[SR12360(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

If any of these things happen, evenintermittently, have the air bag systemserviced at your Ford or Lincoln-Mercurydealer immediately.

%*[SR12400(BEF )03/95] Tone generator

*[SR12500(BEF )03/95] The air bag readiness light indicates the air bagsystem condition. However, a series of five setsof five beeps will be heard only if the readinesslight does not work and there is a problem withthe air bag system. This also means that the AirBag Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) is inneed of service. The tone pattern will repeat(five sets of five beeps) periodically until theproblem and light are repaired. Unless serviced,the Air Bag Supplemental Restraint System maynot function properly in the event of a collision.

*[SR12600(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Do not attempt to service, repair, ormodify the Air Bag SupplementalRestraint System or its fuses. See yourFord or Lincoln-Mercury dealer.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 36: 1996 econoline

33

[SR12700(BEF )04/95] The air bag system is designed to stay out ofsight until it is activated. The air bag system isdesigned to deploy in frontal and front-angledcollisions more severe than hitting a parkedvehicle of similar size and weight head-on atabout 28 mph (45 km/h). Because the systemsenses the crash severity rather than vehiclespeed, some frontal collisions at speeds above28 mph (45 km/h) will not inflate the air bag.The system activates when the sensors detect aforward deceleration equal to or greater than thedeceleration experienced if you would driveyour vehicle into a solid wall at 14 mph. Insome side impacts, the forward deceleration ofyour vehicle can be great enough to deploy yourair bag.

*[SR12720(BEF )03/95] The following four steps show how the air bagsystem works:

*[SR12740(BEF )03/95] 1. Sensors in the vehicle will detect the degreeof severity of a frontal impact. When thesensor system is activated, electric currentflows to the inflator and the system ignitesthe gas generant.

*[SR12760(BEF )03/95] 2. The propellant then rapidly burns in themetal container. The rapid burning producesnitrogen gas and small amounts of dust. Thenitrogen gas and dust are cooled and filteredduring inflation of the air bag.

*[SR12780(BEF )03/95] 3. The inflating supplemental air bag splitsopen the trim cover. The supplemental airbag then rapidly unfolds and inflates in frontof the driver.

*[SR12801(BEF )03/95] NOTE: STEPS 1-3 TAKE PLACE IN AFRACTION OF A SECOND.

*[SR12820(BEF )03/95] 4. After inflation, the gas empties through holesin the air bag. The air bag deflates at once.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 37: 1996 econoline

34

*[SR12840(BEF )03/95] The surface of the air bags and the vehicleinterior may be dusted with a powdery residue.The powder is cornstarch or talcum powder,which is used to lubricate the air bag as itinflates, and sodium compounds such as sodiumcarbonates (e.g., baking soda), and possibly avery small amount of sodium hydroxide thatmay be irritating to the skin and eyes, but is nottoxic.

*[SR12860(BEF )03/95] Right after air bag inflation, you may noticesmoke (from the powder and dust) and smellthe burnt propellant. This is normal.

*[SR12880(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Air bag system components get hot afterinflation. Do not touch them afterinflation.

*[SR12901(BEF )06/95] Air bags may not inflate in certain frontalcollisions, even though the vehicle may be badlydamaged. The fact that your air bag did notinflate in such a collision does not mean thatsomething is wrong with the air bag system.Rather, it means the crash forces were not severeenough to need an air bag to prevent seriousinjury.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 38: 1996 econoline

35

*[SR13000(BEF )05/95]

half page art:0011063-A

Inflated driver side air bag

*[SR13500(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

If the air bag is inflated, THE AIR BAGWILL NOT FUNCTION AGAIN ANDMUST BE REPLACED IMMEDIATELY. Ifthe air bag is not replaced, the unrepairedarea will increase the risk of injury in acollision.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 39: 1996 econoline

36

%*[SR13600(BEF )06/95] Disposal of supplemental air bag equippedvehicles

*[SR13700(BEF )03/95] For disposal of air bags or air bag equippedvehicles, see your local Ford or Lincoln-Mercurydealer, or refer to the procedures in the 1995Ford Service Manual. Information on how toorder a service manual is available at anauthorized Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer. Youcan also order a service manual using the orderform in the Accessories chapter of your OwnerGuide.

%*[SR13800(BEF )06/95] Service and information labels

*[SR13900(BEF )06/95] Service and information labels are attached tothe sun visors, the headliner above the sunvisors (Canadian vehicles), and the radiatorsupport in the engine compartment.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 40: 1996 econoline

37

*[SR14000(BEF)05/95]

fullpageart:0020847-D

Th

elab

ellocated

onth

eb

ackof

the

driver’s

sun

visor

File:03ltsre.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 41: 1996 econoline

38

*[SR14200(BEF )05/95]

one third page art:0010605-D

Label on radiator support in the engine compartment

*[SR14300(BEF )05/95] Safety Restraints for Children

*[SR14400(BEF )02/95] In the U.S. and Canada, you are required by lawto use safety restraints for children. If smallchildren ride in your vehicle — this generallyincludes children who are four years old oryounger and who weigh 40 pounds (18 kg) orless — you must put them in safety seats thatare made specially for children. Safety beltsalone do not provide maximum protection forthese children. Check your local and state lawsfor specific requirements.

*[SR14500(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Never let a passenger hold a child on hisor her lap while the vehicle is moving.The passenger cannot protect the childfrom injury in a collision.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 42: 1996 econoline

39

*[SR14600(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Passengers should not be allowed to ridein the cargo area. Persons not riding in aseat with a fastened seat belt are muchmore likely to suffer serious injury in acollision. Cargo should always be securedto prevent it from shifting and causingdamage to the vehicle or harm topassengers.

*[SR14700(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Carefully follow all of the manufacturer’sinstructions included with the safety seatyou put in your vehicle. If you do notinstall and use the safety seat properly,the child may be injured in a sudden stopor collision.

*[SR14800(BEF )06/95] When possible, put children in the rear seat ofyour vehicle. Accident statistics suggest thatchildren are safer when properly restrained inthe rear seating positions than in the frontseating positions.

*[SR15000(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Safety belts and seats can become hot in avehicle that has been closed up in sunnyweather; they could burn a small child.Check seat covers and buckles before youplace a child anywhere near them.

*[SR15025(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Never leave a child unattended in yourvehicle.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 43: 1996 econoline

40

%*[SR15250(BEF )06/95] Safety Belts for Children

*[SR15300(BEF )05/95] Children who are too large for child safety seatsshould always wear safety belts. (See instructionswith your child seat, or contact its manufacturer,to determine maximum size of child that willsafely fit in the seat.)

*[SR15400(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

If safety belts are not properly worn andadjusted as described, the risk of seriousinjury to the child in a collision will bemuch greater.

*[SR15500(BEF )06/95] If the shoulder belt portion of one of the lap andshoulder belts can be positioned so that it doesnot cross or rest in front of the child’s face orneck, the child should wear the lap and shoulderbelt. Moving the child closer to the center of thevehicle may help provide a good shoulder beltfit.

*[SR15600(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

If the shoulder belt cannot be properlypositioned, move the child to one of theseats with a lap belt only (preferably in arear seat) and use the lap belt.

*[SR15700(BEF )06/95] Lap belts and the lap belt portion of lap andshoulder belts should always be worn snuglyand below the hips, touching the child’s thighs.

*[SR15800(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

To reduce the risk of serious injury in acollision, children should always ride withthe seatback upright.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 44: 1996 econoline

41

%*[SR15900(BEF )01/95] Safety Seats for Children

*[SR16000(BEF )05/95] Use a safety seat that is recommended for thesize and weight of the child. Always follow thesafety seat manufacturer’s instructions wheninstalling and using the safety seat.

*[SR16015(BEF )02/95] Ford recommends the use of a child safety seathaving a top tether strap. Install the child safetyseat in a seating position which is capable ofproviding a tether anchorage. For moreinformation on top tether straps see AttachingSafety Seats With Tether Straps in this chapter.

[SR16025(BEF )05/95] When installing a child safety seat, be sure touse the correct safety belt buckle for that seatingposition making sure the tongue is securelyfastened in the buckle and for a shoulder/lapbelt combination with a sliding tongue makesure the retractor is in the “automatic lockingmode.”

[SR16035( E )05/95] Most child safety seats can be used in thisvehicle only in vehicle seating positions withlap-shoulder belts. The Ford Tot-Guard shouldNOT be used in this vehicle. Any booster-typeseat that places the vehicle’s lap belt or shoulderbelt around a shield above and ahead of thechild’s hips should not be used in this vehiicle.This type of safety seat could cause injury bytipping over the front edge of the vehicle seatduring a collision.

[SR16050( E )05/95] RWARNING

The following instructions MUST BEFOLLOWED to reduce risk of injury froma safety seat tipping too far forward in asevere crash.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 45: 1996 econoline

42

[SR16055( E )05/95] A safety seat can appear to be securely fastenedby the safety belts, but the high forces during asevere crash could tip it forward if held only bya lap belt.

[SR16060( E )05/95] Infants (under one year)

[SR16067( E )05/95] Restrain infants in a rear-facing infant safety seator convertible safety seat in the rear-facingposition. These safety seats can be placed in anypassenger seating position in this vehicle otherthan the last row of a 12 or 15 passenger clubwagon, and restrained by either a lap orlap-shoulder belt according to the instructions onthe safety seat. In vehicle seats equipped withlap-shoulder belts make sure the retractor is inthe automatic locking mode.“

[SR16070( E )05/95] Toddlers (one to four years)

[SR16080( E )05/95] Install forward-facing convertible safety seatsonly in vehicle seating positions equipped withlap-shoulder belts. Forward facing convertiblesafety seats can be used in the center of thethree-passenger second row bench seat only if atop tether strap is used. Ford recommendsplacing forward-facing safety seats in the secondrow and using safety seats with top tether strapsfor added protection. For more information ontop tether straps see Attaching safety seats withtether straps later in this section.

[SR16090( E )05/95] RWARNING

DO NOT use a forward-facing safety seator an infant seat in the last row of a 12-or 15-passenger Club Wagon.

*[SR16095(BEF )06/95] All child restraint systems are designed to besecured in vehicle seats by lap belts or by thelap portion of a lap-shoulder belt.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 46: 1996 econoline

43

*[SR16100(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

If you do not properly secure the safetyseat, the child occupying the seat may beinjured during a collision or sudden stop.An unsecured safety seat could also injureother passengers.

*[SR16200(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Carefully follow all of the manufacturer’sinstructions included with the safety seatyou put in your vehicle. If you do notinstall and use the safety seat properly,the child may be injured in a sudden stopor collision.

*[SR16250(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Seatbacks should be upright for use withchild safety seats.

*[SR16275(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Always keep the buckle release buttonpointing upward and away from the childseat, with the tongue between the childseat and the release button as shown inthe following illustration.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 47: 1996 econoline

44

[SR16280(BEF )05/95]

half page art:0021377-B

[SR16300(BEF )04/95] Installing Child Safety Seats

[SR16310( E )04/95] Your vehicle is equipped with a dual lockingmode retractor on the shoulder belt portion ofthe combination lap/shoulder safety belt for thefront seat passenger and rear seat outboardpassengers.

[SR16320( EF )04/95] If you choose to install a forward-facing childsafety seat or infant carrier in the front seatingpositions, move vehicle seat as far back aspossible.

[SR16325( EF )04/95] For seating positions equipped with adual-locking mode retractor, use the followingprocedure:

*[SR16345(BEF )06/95] 1. Position the child seat in the center of thepassenger seat.

*[SR16350(BEF )06/95] 2. Pull down on shoulder belt, then graspshoulder belt and lap belt together. Figure 1.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 48: 1996 econoline

45

*[SR16355(BEF )06/95]

half page art:0011238-B

*[SR16360(BEF )06/95] 3. While holding the shoulder and lap beltportions together, route the tongue throughthe child seat according to the child seatmanufacturer’s instructions. See Figure 2. Besure that the belt webbing is not twisted.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 49: 1996 econoline

46

[SR16365(BEF )04/95]

half page art:0011239-B

Routing the lap/shoulder belt

*[SR16370(BEF )06/95] 4. Insert the belt tongue into the buckle for thatseating position until you hear and feel thelatch engage. Figure 3. Make sure tongue islatched securely to buckle by pulling ontongue.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 50: 1996 econoline

47

*[SR16375(BEF )06/95]

half page art:0011240-B

Buckling the belt

*[SR16380(BEF )06/95] 5. Grasp the shoulder portion of the belt andpull downward until all of the belt isextracted and a click is heard. At this time,the retractor is in the automatic lockingmode (child seat restraint mode). Figure 4.

*[SR16385(BEF )06/95] NOTE: The dual-locking mode retractor mustbe in the automatic locking mode toproperly restrain a child.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 51: 1996 econoline

48

*[SR16390(BEF )06/95]

half page art:0011241-A

Setting the retractor to automatic locking mode

*[SR16395(BEF )06/95] 6. Allow the belt to retract. Pull up on theshoulder webbing. A clicking sound will beheard as the belt retracts. This indicates theretractor is in the automatic locking mode.Push down on the child seat while you pullup on the belt to remove any slack in thebelt. Figures 5 and 6.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 52: 1996 econoline

49

*[SR16400(BEF )06/95]

half page art:0011242-A

*[SR16405(BEF )06/95]

half page art:0011243-A

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 53: 1996 econoline

50

*[SR16410(BEF )06/95] 7. Before placing the child in the child seat,forcibly tilt the seat from side to side, andtug it forward to make sure that the seat issecurely held in place, Figure 7.

*[SR16412(BEF )06/95]

half page art:0011244-A

Checking that the seat is secure

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 54: 1996 econoline

51

*[SR16415(BEF )06/95] 8. Double check that the retractor is in theautomatic locking mode. Try to pull morebelt out of the retractor. If you cannot, thebelt is in the automatic locking mode,Figure 8.

*[SR16420(BEF )06/95]

half page art:0011245-B

Checking the retractor

*[SR16425(BEF )06/95] 9. Check to make sure that the child seat isproperly secured prior to each use. If theretractor is not locked, repeat steps 4through 7.

*[SR16430(BEF )06/95] To remove the retractor from automatic lockmode, allow webbing to retract fully to itsstowed position and the retractor willautomatically switch back to the vehicle sensitivelocking mode for normal adult usage.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 55: 1996 econoline

52

[SR16440(BEF )04/95] Installing a Child Safety Seat at the RearCenter Seating Position with LockingAdjustable Lap Belt

[SR16450(BEF )04/95] 1. Lengthen the lap belt. To lengthen the belt,hold the tongue so that its bottom isperpendicular to the direction of webbingwhile sliding the tongue up the webbing.

[SR16455(BEF )04/95] 2. Place the child safety seat in the centerseating position.

[SR16460(BEF )04/95] 3. Route the tongue and webbing through thechild seat according to the child seatmanufacturer’s instructions.

[SR16465(BEF )04/95] 4. Insert the belt tongue into the proper bucklefor the center seating position until you heara snap and feel it latch. Make sure thetongue is securely fastened to the buckle bypulling on tongue.

[SR16470(BEF )04/95] 5. Push down on the child seat while pullingon the loose end of the lap belt webbing totighten the belt.

[SR16475(BEF )04/95] 6. Before placing the child into child seat,forcibly tilt the child seat from side-to-sideand in forward directions to ensure that theseat is held securely in place. If the childseat moves excessively, repeat steps 5through 6, or properly install the child seatin a different seating position.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 56: 1996 econoline

53

*[SR18400(BEF )06/95] Attaching Safety Seats With Tether Straps

*[SR18410(BEF )05/95] General Instructions

[SR18413(BEF )02/95] Some manufacturers make safety seats thatinclude an upper tether strap that goes over theseatback and attaches to an anchoring point.Other manufacturers offer the tether strap as anaccessory. Contact the manufacturer of yourchild safety seat for information about orderinga tether strap.

[SR18418( E )04/95] You can install a tether strap anchor bracket tothe back of the seat by using a tether anchor kit(613D74), available at no charge from any Forddealer.

*[SR18420(BEF )05/95] Read and follow the instructions provided withthe kit carefully for installation of the childtether strap anchor.

*[SR18501(BEF )05/95] Follow the child seat manufacturer’s instructionsto attach the tether strap to the tether bracket.

[SR18600( E )03/91] Ford recommends placement of tethered safetyseats in a rear seating position with the tetherstrap attached to the tether anchoring point asshown in the following illustration. The front,right hand seating position may be used if it isthe only seating position available.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 57: 1996 econoline

54

[SR18625( E )02/92]

two third page art:0020794-B

Tether strap anchorage locations

*[SR18950(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Only use the tether attachment holelocations shown in the illustrations. Thetether anchor may not perform properly ifthe wrong mounting location is used.

*[SR19500(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Failure to follow these precautions couldincrease the chance of injury in anaccident.

File:03ltsre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:51:22 1996

Page 58: 1996 econoline

55

Starting Your Econoline

*[ST01700( ALL)03/95] Ignition

*[ST01800( ALL)01/95] Understanding the Positions of the Ignition

*[ST02000( ALL)05/90]

quarter page art:0020004-B

The positions of the key in the ignition lock cylinder.

*[ST02200( ALL)05/95] ON allows you to test your vehicle’s warninglights (except the brake system warning light) tomake sure they work before you start theengine. The key returns to the ON position oncethe engine is started and remains in this positionwhile the engine runs.

*[ST02300( ALL)03/95] START cranks the engine. Release the key oncethe engine starts so that you do not damage thestarter. The key should return to ON when yourelease it. The START position also allows youto test the brake warning light.

*[ST02400( ALL)03/95] OFF allows you to shut off the engine and allaccessories without locking the steering wheel orthe automatic transmission gearshift lever.

[ST02550( E M)07/94] LOCK locks the steering wheel. It also locks thegearshift.

*[ST02700( ALL)01/95] LOCK is the only position that allows you toremove the key. The LOCK feature helps toprotect your vehicle from theft.

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 59: 1996 econoline

56

%*[ST02800( ALL)05/95] If the key is stuck in the LOCK position, movethe steering wheel left or right until the keyturns freely.

%*[ST02900( ALL)03/95] ACCESSORY allows some of your vehicle’selectrical accessories such as the radio and thewindshield wipers to operate while the engine isnot running.

*[ST03025(BEF )03/91] Ignition Key Buzzer or Chime

*[ST03050(BEF )03/91] The buzzer or chime will sound if you open thedriver’s door while the key is in the ignition.Never leave your vehicle unattended with thekey in the ignition.

%*[ST03075( ALL)02/95] Removing the Key From the Ignition

[ST03125( E M)03/91] Procedures for removing your key from theignition are as follows:

[ST03350( E M)03/91] Your vehicle’s gearshift lever is mounted onthe column:

*[ST03400( ALL)06/95] 1. Put the gearshift in P (Park).

*[ST03500( ALL)03/91] 2. Set the parking brake fully before removingyour foot from the service brake. (This willavoid “binding” or “loading” the park gearif you park on a grade.)

*[ST03600( ALL)03/95] 3. Turn the ignition key to LOCK.

*[ST03700( ALL)03/95] 4. Remove the key.

*[ST04625( E M)06/95] RWARNING

Always set the parking brake fully andmake sure the gearshift is securely latchedin P (Park).

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 60: 1996 econoline

57

*[ST04750( ALL)01/93] RWARNING

Do not leave children, unreliable adults,or pets alone in your vehicle. They couldaccidentally injure themselves or othersthrough inadvertent operation of thevehicle. Further, on hot, sunny days,temperatures in a closed vehicle couldquickly become high enough to causesevere and possibly fatal injuries topeople as well as animals.

%*[ST04800( ALL)03/95] Fuel-Injected Engines

*[ST04850( EF )04/94] NOTE: For owners of diesel-powered vehicles,refer to the Diesel Engine Owners GuideSupplement for information on startingyour vehicle.

*[ST04900(BEF )03/95] When starting a fuel-injected engine, the mostimportant thing to remember is to avoidpressing down on the accelerator before orduring starting. Only use the accelerator whenyou have problems getting your vehicle started.See Starting Your Engine in this chapter fordetails about when to use the accelerator whileyou start your vehicle.

%*[ST05050( E )05/95] Because your vehicle’s engine is electronicallycontrolled by a computer, some controlconditions are maintained by power from thebattery. If you ever disconnect the battery, installa new battery, or experience a dead battery youmust allow the computer to “relearn” its idleconditions before your vehicle will driveproperly. To let the engine do this, put thegearshift in P (Park), turn off all the accessories,and start the vehicle. Let the engine idle for atleast one minute.

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 61: 1996 econoline

58

*[ST05100(BEF )03/95] If you do not let the engine relearn its idle, theidle quality of your vehicle may be adverselyaffected until the idle is relearned. Your vehiclewill eventually relearn its idle while you driveit, but it takes much longer than if you use theprevious procedure.

[ST05150( ALL)02/95] Starting your vehicle%*[ST05200( ALL)05/94] Preparing to Start Your Vehicle

*[ST05300( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Do not start your vehicle in a closedgarage or other enclosed area. Never sit ina stopped vehicle for more than a shortperiod of time with the engine running.Exhaust fumes are toxic. See GuardingAgainst Exhaust Fumes in this chapter formore instructions.

*[ST05400( ALL)01/95] Before you start your vehicle, do the following:

*[ST05500(BEF )01/95] 1. Make sure you and all your passengersbuckle your safety belts. See Safety Restraintsin the Index for more details.

*[ST05600( ALL)03/95] 2. Make sure the headlamps and otheraccessories are turned off when starting.

*[ST05750( E M)03/95] 3. Make sure that the gearshift is in P (Park)and the parking brake is set before you turnthe key.

*[ST05900(BEF )03/95] Testing the Warning Lights

*[ST06015(BEF )03/95] Before you start your vehicle, you should testthe warning lights on the instrument panel tomake sure that they work. Refer to the WarningLights and Gauges chapter.

*[ST06025(BEF )03/95] If your Brake Warning Light does light up withthe key in the ON position, you may not havefully released the parking brake or the brakefluid may be low.

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 62: 1996 econoline

59

*[ST06200( ALL)02/95] Starting Your Engine

*[ST06300( ALL)06/95] To start your engine:

*[ST06400( ALL)05/95] 1. Follow the steps under Preparing to StartYour Vehicle at the beginning of this section.

*[ST06425( ALL)03/95] 2. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.

*[ST06451( ALL)06/95] 3. DO NOT depress the accelerator pedal whenstarting your engine. DO NOT use theaccelerator while the vehicle is parked.

*[ST06475( ALL)02/95] 4. Turn the key to the START position(cranking) until the engine starts. Allow thekey to return to the ON position after theengine has started.

*[ST06501( ALL)02/95] If you have difficulty in turning the key,rotate the steering wheel slightly because itmay be binding.

%*[ST06510( ALL)04/95] For a cold engine:

*[ST06515( ALL)06/95] ❑At temperatures 10˚F (-12˚C) and below: Ifthe engine does not start in fifteen (15)seconds on the first try, turn the key to OFF,wait approximately ten (10) seconds so youdo not flood the engine, then try again.

*[ST06520( ALL)04/95] ❑At temperatures above 10˚F (-12˚C): If theengine does not start in five (5) seconds onthe first try, turn the key to OFF, waitapproximately ten (10) seconds so you do notflood the engine, then try again.

*[ST06525( ALL)06/95] ❑Do not hold the key in the START positionfor more than fifteen (15) seconds at a time.

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 63: 1996 econoline

60

%*[ST06550( ALL)05/95] For a warm engine:

*[ST06551( ALL)04/95] ❑Do not hold the key in the START positionfor more than five (5) seconds at a time. Ifthe engine does not start within five (5)seconds on the first try, turn the key to theOFF position. Wait a few seconds after thestarter stops, then try again.

*[ST06575( ALL)05/95] Whenever you start your vehicle, release the keyas soon as the engine starts. Excessive crankingcould damage the starter or flood the engine.

*[ST06601( ALL)05/95] After you start the engine, let it idle for a fewseconds. Keep your foot on the brake pedal andput the gearshift lever in gear. Release theparking brake. Slowly release the brake pedaland drive away in the normal manner.

%*[ST06625( ALL)01/95] NOTE: Your vehicle is equipped with abrake-shift interlock feature. Thisfeature prevents you from shiftingfrom P (Park) unless you have thebrake pedal depressed. (The ignitionmust be in the ON position.) If youcannot shift from P (Park) with thebrake pedal depressed:

*[ST06627( ALL)01/95] 1. Apply the parking brake.

*[ST06629( ALL)01/95] 2. Remove the key.

*[ST06631( ALL)01/95] 3. Insert the key and rotate one positionclockwise (ignition in the OFF position).

*[ST06633( ALL)01/95] 4. Apply the brake pedal and shift to N(Neutral). (If the vehicle is shifted to P(Park), you must repeat the previous steps.)

*[ST06635( ALL)01/95] 5. Start the vehicle.

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 64: 1996 econoline

61

*[ST06637( ALL)06/95] If you need to shift out of P (Park) by using thealternate procedure described above, it ispossible that a fuse has blown and that yourbrakelamps may also not be functional. Pleaserefer to the chapter titled Servicing Your Econolinein this Owner Guide for instructions on checkingand replacing fuses.

*[ST06640( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

DO NOT DRIVE YOUR VEHICLE UNTILYOU VERIFY THAT THE BRAKELAMPSARE WORKING.

*[ST06775( ALL)03/95] For cold or warm engines:

*[ST06800( ALL)06/95] If the engine still does not start after twoattempts:

*[ST06825( ALL)04/95] 1. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position.

*[ST06851( ALL)04/95] 2. Press the accelerator all the way to the floorand hold it.

*[ST06876( ALL)04/95] 3. Turn the ignition key to the START position.

*[ST06900( ALL)04/95] 4. Release the ignition key when the enginestarts.

*[ST06925( ALL)04/95] 5. Release the accelerator gradually as theengine speeds up. Then drive away in thenormal manner.

*[ST06951( ALL)04/95] If the engine still does not start, the fuel pumpshut-off switch may have been triggered. Fordirections on how to reset the switch see FuelPump Shut-Off Switch later in this chapter.

*[ST07300(BEF )06/95] A computer system controls the engine’s idlespeed. When you start your vehicle, the engine’sidle speed normally runs higher than when it’swarmed up. These faster engine speeds will

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 65: 1996 econoline

62

make your vehicle move slightly faster than itsnormal idle speed. It should, however, slowdown after a short time. If it does not, have theidle speed checked.

*[ST07350( ALL)06/95] If the engine idle speed does not slow downautomatically, do not allow your vehicle to idlefor more than 10 minutes. Have the vehiclechecked.

*[ST07400( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Extended idling at high engine speeds canproduce very high temperatures in theengine and exhaust system, creating therisk of fire or other damage.

*[ST07450( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle indry grass or other dry ground cover. Theemission system heats up the enginecompartment and exhaust system, whichcan start a fire.

*[ST07500(BEF )03/95] If you consistently start your vehicle in subzerotemperatures, use an engine block heater (ifyour vehicle has this option).

%*[ST07600(BEF )06/95] Engine Block Heater (If equipped)

*[ST07700(BEF )03/95] Engine block heaters are strongly recommendedif you live in a region where temperatures reach-10˚F (-23˚C) or below. An engine block heaterwarms the engine coolant, which improvesstarting, warms up the engine faster, and allowsthe heater-defrost system to respond quickly.

*[ST08000(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

To prevent electrical shock, do not useyour heater with ungrounded electricalsystems or two-pronged (cheater) adapters.

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 66: 1996 econoline

63

*[ST08100(BEF )03/95] For best results, plug the heater in at least threehours before you start your vehicle. Using theheater for longer than three hours will notdamage the engine, so you can plug it in atnight to start your vehicle the followingmorning.

*[ST08150(BEF )12/91] NOTE: Be sure to disconnect the engine blockheater before driving your vehicle.

*[ST08160( ALL)03/95] If the Engine Cranks but DoesNot Start or Does Not Start Aftera Collision

%*[ST08170(BEF )04/95] Fuel Pump Shut-off Switch

*[ST08190( ALL)03/95] If the engine cranks but does not start or doesnot start after a collision, the fuel pump shut-offswitch may have been triggered. The shut-offswitch is a device intended to stop the fuelpump when your vehicle has been involved in asubstantial jolt.

*[ST08200( ALL)03/95] Once the shut-off switch is triggered, you mustreset the switch by hand before you can startyour vehicle.

[ST08230( E )02/95]

one third page art:0020008-A

Fuel pump shut-off switch location

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 67: 1996 econoline

64

[ST08240( E )02/95]

one third page art:0020988-A

Fuel pump shut-off switch location — Commercial strippedchassis vehicles

*[ST08260( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

If you see or smell fuel, do not reset theswitch or try to start your vehicle. Haveall the passengers get out of the vehicleand call the local fire department or atowing service.

*[ST08270( ALL)03/95] If your engine cranks but does not start after acollision or substantial jolt:

*[ST08280( ALL)04/95] 1. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position.

*[ST08290( ALL)03/95] 2. Check under the vehicle for leaking fuel.

*[ST08300( ALL)03/95] 3. If you do not see or smell fuel, push the redreset button down. If the button is alreadyset, you may have a different mechanicalproblem.

*[ST08310(BEF )03/95] 4. Turn the ignition key to the ON position fora few seconds, then turn it to the OFFposition.

*[ST08330( ALL)03/95] 5. Check under the vehicle again for leakingfuel. If you see or smell fuel, do not startyour vehicle again. If you do not see orsmell fuel, you can try to start your vehicleagain.

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 68: 1996 econoline

65

*[ST08340( ALL)03/95] 6. Check all vehicle warning lights beforedriving your vehicle.

*[ST08350(BEF )03/95]

quarter page art:0020107-A

Reset button for fuel pump shut-off switch

%*[ST09300( ALL)05/95] Guarding Against Exhaust Fumes

*[ST09400( ALL)02/95] Carbon monoxide, although colorless andodorless, is present in exhaust fumes. Takeprecautions to avoid its dangerous effects.

*[ST09500( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Do not start your vehicle in a closedgarage or other enclosed area. Never sit ina stopped vehicle for more than a shortperiod of time with the engine running.Exhaust fumes are toxic. See GuardingAgainst Exhaust Fumes in this chapter formore instructions.

*[ST09600( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

If you smell exhaust fumes inside yourvehicle, have your dealer inspect yourvehicle immediately. Do not drive if yousmell exhaust fumes.

*[ST09700( E )03/95] If your vehicle has rear windows and doors thatwere installed as part of a van conversion, closethem while it is running. This prevents exhaustfumes from being drawn into the passengercompartment.

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 69: 1996 econoline

66

*[ST09900( ALL)01/95] Have the exhaust and body ventilation systemschecked whenever:

*[ST10000( ALL)02/95] ❑your vehicle is raised for service

*[ST10100( ALL)02/95] ❑ the sound of the exhaust system changes

*[ST10200( ALL)01/95] ❑your vehicle has been damaged in a collision

*[ST10300( ALL)01/95] Improve your ventilation by keeping all air inletvents clear of snow, leaves, and other debris.

*[ST10400( ALL)03/95] If the engine is idling while you are stopped inan open area for long periods of time, open thewindows at least one inch (2.5 cm). Also, adjustthe heating or air conditioning to bring inoutside air.

[ST10500( E )03/91] ❑HEATING — Set fan speed on MEDIUM orHIGH, with the function control lever onFLOOR, DEFROST or VENT and thetemperature control lever on any desiredposition.

[ST10700( E )03/91] ❑AIR CONDITIONING — Set fan speed onMEDIUM or HIGH with the function controllever on any position (except OFF or MAX)and the temperature control lever at acomfortable level.

File:04ltste.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:38 1996

Page 70: 1996 econoline

67

Warning Lights andGauges

*[LG00400( ALL)01/95] The instrument panel (dashboard) on yourvehicle is divided into several different sections.The illustrations on the following pages showthe major parts of the instrument panel that aredescribed in this chapter. Some items shownmay not be on all vehicles.

*[LG00525( E M)12/91] In your vehicle, the warning lights and gaugesare grouped together on the instrument panel.We call this grouping a cluster. Your vehicle hasa mechanical cluster.

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 71: 1996 econoline

68

[LG02600(E)05/95]

fullpageart:0020042-J

Mech

anical

cluster

File:05ltlge.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 72: 1996 econoline

69

%*[LG03000( ALL)06/94] The Mechanical Cluster

*[LG03100( ALL)06/93] The following warning lights and gauges are onthe mechanical cluster. All of the warning lightsand gauges alert you to possible problems withyour vehicle. Some of the lights listed areoptional. The following sections detail what eachof these indicators means.

*[LG03200( ALL)06/95] Brake System Warning Light

*[LG03350( EF )06/92] The red warning light for the brakes can showthree things — that either the parking brake isnot fully released, that the brake fluid level islow in the master cylinder reservoir or thevacuum pressure is low on diesel enginevehicles. If the fluid level is low, the brakesystem should be checked by a qualified servicetechnician.

*[LG03400( ALL)05/94] This light comes on when you turn the ignitionkey to START to verify that the indicator bulb isworking. If the light stays on or comes on afteryou have released the parking brake fully, havethe hydraulic brake system serviced.

*[LG03500( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

The BRAKE light indicates that the brakesmay not be working properly. Have thebrakes checked immediately.

*[LG03600( ALL)05/95]

one inch art:0020044-A

Brake warning light symbols

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 73: 1996 econoline

70

%*[LG03800(BEF )02/95] Anti-Lock Brake System Warning Light

*[LG03925(BEF )03/03] To check the amber ABS brake warning lightturn the ignition key to ON. The ABS brakewarning light should glow momentarily.

*[LG03950(BEF )06/94] NOTE: If it does not glow momentarily, haveyour vehicle’s electrical system checkedimmediately.

*[LG03985(BEF )07/94] NOTE: If the ABS brake warning light beginsto flash in a repeatable flash sequence,check the rear anti-lock systemcontinuous power fuse and brake lightsfor proper operation.

[LG04050(BEF )05/95]

one inch art:0020913-B

Antilock warning light symbol

*[LG04100(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

If the anti-lock brake system warninglight remains on or comes on whiledriving, have the braking system checkedby a qualified service technician as soonas possible.

*[LG04125(BEF )06/95] NOTE: If a fault occurs in the anti-locksystem, and the brake warning light isnot lit, the anti-lock system is disabledbut normal brake function remainsoperational.

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 74: 1996 econoline

71

*[LG04150(BEF )02/95] Safety Belt Warning Light and Chime

*[LG04301(BEF )03/95] This warning light and chime remind you tofasten your safety belt. The following conditionswill take place:

*[LG04325(BEF )03/95] ❑ If the safety belt is not buckled when the keyis turned to the ON position, the light comeson for 1 to 2 minutes and the chime soundsfor 4 to 8 seconds.

*[LG04351(BEF )02/95] ❑ If the safety belt is buckled while the light ison and the chime is sounding, both the lightand chime turn off.

*[LG04365(BEF )05/95] ❑ If the safety belt is buckled before theignition is turned to the ON position, neitherthe light nor the chime will come on.

*[LG04400( ALL)10/92]

one inch art:0020046-B

Safety belt warning light symbol

*[LG04500( ALL)03/95] Check Engine Warning Light

*[LG04525( ALL)05/95] The Powertrain On-Board Diagnostic II (OBD II)system consists of the hardware and softwarenecessary to monitor the operation of thepowertrain. The OBD II system is designed tocheck the function of the vehicle’s powertraincontrol system during normal operation. If anemission problem is detected, the Check EngineWarning Light (in the cluster) is turned on.

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 75: 1996 econoline

72

*[LG04550( ALL)05/95]

one inch art:0020048-A

Check engine warning light symbol

*[LG04575( ALL)05/95] Modification or additions to the vehicle maycause incorrect operation of the OBD II system.Additions such as burglar alarms, cellularphones, and CB radios must be carefullyinstalled. Do not install these devices by tappinginto or running wires close to powertrain controlsystem wires or components.

*[LG04600( ALL)05/95] The light comes on briefly when you turn theignition key to ON, but it should turn off whenthe engine starts. If the light does not come onwhen you turn the ignition to ON or if it comeson and stays on when you are driving, haveyour vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Thisindicates a possible problem with one of thevehicle’s emission control systems. You do notneed to have your vehicle towed in.

*[LG04625( ALL)05/95] If the light turns on and off at one (1) secondintervals while you are driving the vehicle, itmeans that the engine is misfiring. If thiscondition persists, damage could occur to theengine or catalytic convertor. Have your vehicleserviced at the first opportunity. You do notneed to have your vehicle towed in.

*[LG04650( ALL)05/95] If the light turns on and off on rare occasionswhile you are driving, it means that amalfunction occurred and the condition correcteditself.

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 76: 1996 econoline

73

*[LG04675( ALL)05/95] An example of a condition which corrects itselfoccurs when an engine running out of fuelbegins to misfire. In this case, the Check EngineWarning Light may turn on and will then set aDiagnostic Trouble Code indicating that theengine was misfiring while the last of the fuelwas being consumed. After refueling, the CheckEngine Warning Light will turn off after thevehicle has completed three consecutive warmup cycles without a misfire condition occurring.A warm up cycle consists of engine start from acold condition (engine at ambient temperature)and running until the engine reaches normaloperating temperature.

*[LG04700( ALL)05/95] On the fourth engine start up, the Check EngineWarning Light will turn off as soon as theengine begins to crank. It is not necessary tohave the engine serviced.

*[LG04725( ALL)05/95] Under certain conditions, the Check EngineWarning Light may come on if the fuel cap isnot properly installed. If the Check EngineWarning Light comes on and you suspect thatthe fuel cap is not properly installed, pull off theroad as soon as it is safely possible and turn offthe engine. Remove and replace the fuel cap,making sure it is properly seated.

*[LG04750( ALL)05/95] After completing the three consecutive warm upcycles and on the fourth engine start up, theCheck Engine Warning Light should turn off. Ifthe light does not go off after the fourth enginerestart, have your vehicle serviced by yourdealer or a qualified technician.

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 77: 1996 econoline

74

*[LG05900( ALL)01/95] Charging System Light

*[LG06000( ALL)03/95] This light, shown as a battery symbol on yourcluster, indicates that your battery is not beingcharged and that you need to have the electricalsystem checked.

*[LG06050( ALL)05/95]

one inch art:0020777-A

Charging system light

*[LG06100( ALL)05/95] This light comes on every time you turn theignition to the ON or START position (engineoff). The light should go off when the enginestarts and the alternator begins to charge.

%*[LG06305(BEF )06/93] Supplemental Air Bag Readiness Light andTone Generator

*[LG06310(BEF )06/93] This light illuminates for six seconds when theignition is turned to the ON position. If the lightfails to illuminate, continues to flash, remains on,or if a series of five beeps is heard, have thesystem serviced as soon as possible.

*[LG06315( E )05/95]

one inch art:0020778-B

Supplemental air bag readiness light

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 78: 1996 econoline

75

*[LG06325( E )04/95] Anti-Theft Alarm Light (If equipped)

*[LG06335( E )04/95] This light flashes on and off when the ignitionswitch is OFF and any door is opened. As soonas you lock the doors, the light glows steadily.Within 30 seconds of closing all the doors, thelight goes out. This indicates that the alarmsystem is armed.

*[LG06345( E )04/95]

one inch art:0020921-A

Anti-Theft Alarm Light

*[LG06400( ALL)05/94] Battery Voltage Gauge (Voltmeter)

*[LG06601( ALL)05/94] This gauge shows you the battery voltage whenthe ignition key is in the ON position.

*[LG06700( ALL)11/89] If you are running electrical accessories (whenthe engine is off, or idling at a low speed), thepointer may move toward the lower end of thenormal band. If it stays outside the normal bandarea, have your vehicle’s electrical systemchecked as soon as it is safely possible.

*[LG06701( ALL)05/95] If the battery is operating under cold weatherconditions, the pointer may indicate in the upperrange of the NORMAL band while the battery ischarging. If you are running electrical accessorieswith the engine off or idling at a low speed, orthe battery is not fully charged, the pointer maymove toward the lower end of the NORMALband.

*[LG06750( ALL)05/94] If it stays outside the NORMAL band, have yourvehicle’s electrical system checked as soon as itis safely possible.

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 79: 1996 econoline

76

[LG07001( E M)03/93]

quarter page art:0020863-B

Battery voltage gauge

*[LG07500( ALL)05/94] Engine Oil Pressure Gauge

*[LG07601( ALL)06/93] This gauge indicates the engine’s oil pressure,not the oil level. However, if your engine’s oillevel is low, it could affect the oil pressure. Withthe engine running, the pointer should moveinto the NORMAL band. If the pointer dropsbelow the NORMAL band while the engine isrunning, you have lost oil pressure andcontinued operation will cause severe enginedamage.

*[LG07701( ALL)03/95] If you lose engine oil pressure:

*[LG07801( ALL)01/95] 1. Pull off the road as soon as safely possible.

*[LG07901( ALL)04/95] 2. Shut off the engine immediately or severeengine damage could result.

*[LG08001( ALL)02/95] 3. Check the engine’s oil level, following theinstructions on checking and adding engineoil. Refer to Engine oil in the Index. If youdo not follow these instructions, you orothers could be injured. To assure anaccurate reading, your vehicle should be onlevel ground.

*[LG08051( ALL)03/93] 4. If the level is low, add only as much oil asnecessary before you start the engine again.Do not overfill. Do not operate the engine ifthe pointer is below the NORMAL band,regardless of the oil level. Contact yournearest dealer for further service actions.

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 80: 1996 econoline

77

[LG08250( E M)03/93]

quarter page art:0020059-D

Engine oil pressure gauge

*[LG08900( ALL)01/95] High Beam Light

*[LG09001( ALL)03/95] This light comes on when the headlamps areturned on high beam or when you flash thelights.

*[LG09025( ALL)11/89]

one inch art:0020537-B

High beam indicator light

*[LG09300(BEF )03/95] “Headlamps On” Alert Chime

*[LG09400(BEF )03/95] This chime will sound if you open the doorwhile the headlamps or parklamps are on.

*[LG09500( ALL)01/95] Fuel Gauge

*[LG09700( ALL)06/93] The fuel gauge displays approximately howmuch fuel is in the fuel tank only when theignition switch is ON.

*[LG09860( ALL)06/93] The fuel gauge indicator may vary slightly whenthe vehicle is in motion.

*[LG09875( ALL)08/93] With ignition switch OFF, the fuel gaugeindicator may drift from the ignition switch ONposition.

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 81: 1996 econoline

78

[LG10130( E M)10/92]

one inch art:0020064-C

Fuel gauge

*[LG11100( ALL)01/95] Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge

*[LG11201( ALL)03/95] This gauge tells you the temperature of theengine coolant, not the coolant level. If thecoolant is not at its proper level or mixture, thegauge indicator will not be accurate.

*[LG11301( ALL)02/95] The pointer moves from the C (cold) mark intothe Normal band as the engine coolant warmsup. It is acceptable for the pointer to fluctuatewithin the Normal band under normal drivingconditions. Under certain driving conditions,such as heavy stop and go traffic or driving uphills in hot weather, the pointer may indicate atthe top of the Normal band.

*[LG11401( ALL)05/95] If, under any circumstances, the pointer movesabove the NORMAL band, the engine coolant isoverheating and continued operation may causeengine damage.

*[LG11501( ALL)01/95] If your engine coolant overheats:

*[LG11601( ALL)03/95] 1. Pull off the road as soon as it is safelypossible.

*[LG11701( ALL)03/95] 2. Turn off the engine. If you do not stop theengine as soon as safely possible, severeengine damage could result.

*[LG11801( ALL)05/95] 3. Let the engine cool. DO NOT REMOVECOOLANT SYSTEM FILL CAP UNTILTHE ENGINE IS COOL.

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 82: 1996 econoline

79

*[LG11901( ALL)04/95] 4. Check the coolant level following theinstructions on checking and adding coolantto your engine, see Engine Coolant in theIndex. If you do not follow theseinstructions, you or others could be injured.

*[LG12200( ALL)03/95] For instructions on checking and adding coolantto your engine, see Engine coolant in the Index. Ifyou do not follow these instructions, you orothers could be injured.

[LG12375( E M)03/93]

quarter page art:0020687-C

Engine coolant temperature gauge

*[LG12601( ALL)01/95] Speedometer

*[LG12700( ALL)01/95] The speedometer tells you how many miles(kilometers) per hour your vehicle is moving.

*[LG12750(BEF )04/95] Your vehicle contains a speedometer whichreceives its input from the Anti-Lock brakesensor. The speedometer is also used to providea speed signal for correct operation of thevehicle’s Powertrain Control Module (PCM),electronic transmission, and speed control (if soequipped). Because of this, it is veryIMPORTANT to change the speedometer’sinternal conversion constant if the size of thetires on the vehicle is changed. Changing theconversion constant to the proper value whenthe tires are changed will also ensure that thespeedometer retains the original factory-setaccuracy. NOTE: The conversion constant canonly be changed six times once the vehicleleaves the factory. Your Ford dealership servicepersonnel can change the conversion constant.

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 83: 1996 econoline

80

*[LG12753(BEF )05/95] Some vehicles are equipped with a vehicle speed(MPH/km/h) limiting device that is containedwithin the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).The purpose of this device is to maintain peakvehicle speed below a specified limit. (Vehiclespeed limits may vary based on enginedisplacement).

[LG12780( E M)10/92]

one third page art:0020872-B

Speedometer

%*[LG13130( ALL)10/92] Odometer/Trip Odometer

*[LG13160( ALL)05/95] The Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) odometer is acombination trip odometer and total odometer.The total odometer is normally displayed. To seethe trip odometer, press and release the SELECTBUTTON on the upper right side of thespeedometer. To zero out the trip odometer,press and release the RESET button on theupper left side of the speedometer while the tripodometer is displayed. If the trip odometer isdisplayed, press and release the “Select” buttonto return the display to the total odometer value.

File:05ltlge.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:49:15 1996

Page 84: 1996 econoline

81

Instrument Panel Controls

*[IP00450( EF )05/90] NOTE: The following section does not applyto Stripped Chassis vehicles. See yourBody Builder’s instructions for locationand operation of controls for climatecontrol systems, lamps, radio andwindshield wiper/washer.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 85: 1996 econoline

82

[IP00495(E)05/94]

fullpageart:0020030-G

Instru

men

tP

anel

&C

ontrols

File:06ltipe.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 86: 1996 econoline

83

*[IP00500(BEF )06/95] The Climate Control Systems

*[IP00601(BEF )12/91] Your vehicle is equipped with a controlassembly designed to handle either acombination A/C-Heater System or aHeater-Only System.

*[IP00701( E )05/94] If your vehicle has a factory installed auxiliarysystem, the front control will be equipped with arear fan control switch. If it is a factory installedauxiliary system with REAR A/C and REARHEATER functions, an auxiliary fan speedcontrol switch is installed in the rear of thevehicle.

%*[IP00801(BEF )10/93] Instrument Panel Registers

*[IP00901( E )02/95] There are four registers in the instrument panel.Each of these registers contains a louverassembly which can be manually adjusted todirect airflow up, down, left and right. Anillustration of the register locations follows.

[IP01101( E )12/91]

quarter page art:0020100-C

Instrument panel registers

%*[IP01598( E )05/94] Standard Heater

[IP01599( E )05/94] The control for your Heater system is located atthe center of the instrument panel and willoperate only when the ignition key is turned tothe RUN position. Your Heater will heat orventilate your vehicle interior depending on theFunction lever position and temperature youselect. The bottom lever is the Function Selectorlever which allows you to determine where the

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 87: 1996 econoline

84

air will be directed. The top lever is theTemperature lever. The setting or position of thetop lever determines the temperature of the airthat flows into the vehicle.

[IP01600( E )04/95]

quarter page art:0020986-A

Front heater only

[IP01605( E )01/93]

quarter page art:0020987-A

Front and rear heater only

[IP01675( E )05/94] To turn your Heater system on, move the lowerlever to any position except OFF. This will turnthe fan ON and allow air flow into the vehicle.To turn your Heater off, move the lower lever toOFF. This will turn the fan off and stop air flowfrom coming into the vehicle.

*[IP01680( E )03/95] Temperature selection

[IP01685( E )05/94] The temperature lever is the top lever locatedbelow the broken RED and BLUE band. TheRED part of the band (right side) is the heat orWARM area. The BLUE area (left side) is thecool or unheated temperature area. Any positionselected between full right and full left will givea temperature between the two extremetemperatures.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 88: 1996 econoline

85

[IP01690( E )05/94] Fan Speed Adjustment

[IP01695( E )05/95] The H knob (upper left) on the control is thefan speed knob which controls the volume of airflow. Rotate the H knob to the right to increasefan speed and increase the amount of airentering the vehicle. Four fan speed positions areavailable and are indicated by LO, two separatedots and HI beside the H control knob. The HIposition provides the most air flow.

[IP01698( E )05/94] Airflow selections (lower lever)

*[IP01699( E )03/95] VENT

[IP01700( E )05/94] Use VENT to bring outside air through theinstrument panel registers. You can heat the airin this position by moving the top lever into theRED area. The air CANNOT be cooled belowthe outside temperature.

*[IP01705( E )03/95] FLOOR

[IP01710( E )05/94] Air flow will be to the floor when FLOOR isselected. The air can be heated by moving thetop lever into the RED area.

[IP01715( E )05/94] DEF FLR

[IP01720( E )05/94] Select DEF FLR to get air to the floor andwindshield defrosters at the same time.

[IP01723( E )04/95] VDEFROST

[IP01730( E )05/95] Select V DEFROST to obtain maximum airflow to the windshield. Move the top lever intothe RED area for the air temperature required todefrost. Rotate the H knob to increase ordecrease the air flow.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 89: 1996 econoline

86

*[IP01735( E )05/94] Operating Tips

*[IP01740( E )02/95] The following tips will help you to get the mostsatisfaction from your heater system.

[IP01745( E )04/95] ❑ In humid weather, select V DEFROST. Thiswill help to prevent windshield fogging. Aftera few minutes of operation, you may selectanother air flow position.

*[IP01750( E )02/95] ❑To prevent humidity buildup inside yourvehicle, always drive with the heater systemturned on.

[IP01755( E )05/94] ❑Do not put objects under the front seatsunless your vehicle is equipped with anunderseat storage tray. Improperly storedobjects will interfere with the flow of airunder the seats to the back seat area.

*[IP01756( E )02/95] ❑Remove any snow, ice, or leaves from the airintake area at the bottom of the windshield.

[IP01760( E )05/94]

quarter page art:0020983-A

Front A/C — Heater only (Main system)

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 90: 1996 econoline

87

[IP01765( E )05/94] Operational Air Conditioner and Heater

[IP01770( E )05/94] The control for your Air Conditioning andHeater system is located at the center of theinstrument panel and will operate only when theignition key is turned to the RUN position. YourAir Conditioner & Heater will heat and/or coolyour vehicle interior depending on the Functionlever position and temperature you select. Thebottom lever is the Function Selector lever whichallows you to select heating or cooling anddetermine where the air will be directed. Thetop lever is the Temperature lever. The settingor position of the top lever determines thetemperature of the air that flows into thevehicle.

[IP01775( E )05/94]

quarter page art:0020984-A

Front and Rear A/C and Heater (Main and Auxiliarysystem)

[IP01780( E )05/94]

quarter page art:0020985-A

A/C and Heater, front - Heater only, rear

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 91: 1996 econoline

88

[IP01785( E )04/95] To turn your Air Conditioner & Heater systemon, move the lower lever to any position exceptOFF. This will turn the fan ON and allow airflow into the vehicle. To turn your AirConditioner & Heater off, move the lower leverto OFF. This will turn the fan off and stop airflow from coming into the vehicle.

*[IP01790( E )03/95] Temperature selection

[IP01795( E )05/94] The temperature lever is the top lever locatedbelow the broken RED and BLUE band. TheRED part of the band (right side) is the heat orWARM area. The BLUE area (left side) is thecooling or COOL temperature area. Any positionselected between full right and full left will givea temperature between the two extremetemperatures.

[IP01800( E )04/95] H Fan speed adjustment

[IP01805( E )05/95] The H knob (upper left) on the control is thefan speed knob which controls the volume of airflow. Rotate the H knob to the right to increasefan speed and increase the amount of airentering the vehicle. Four fan speed positions areavailable and are indicated by LO, two separatedots and HI beside the H control knob. The HIposition provides the most air flow.

[IP01810( E )05/94] Airflow selections (lower lever)

*[IP01815( E )03/95] VENT

[IP01820( E )05/94] Use VENT to bring outside air through theinstrument panel registers. You can heat the airin this position by moving the top lever into theRED area. The air CANNOT be cooled belowthe outside temperature regardless of the toplever setting. Select NORMAL A/C or MAX A/Cto get cooled air through the instrument panelregisters.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 92: 1996 econoline

89

[IP01825( E )03/95] NORM A/C

[IP01830( E )05/94] Select NORM A/C to get refrigerated outside airthrough the instrument panel registers. TheNORM A/C position is used for cooling exceptwhen it is extremely hot or fast cooling of thevehicle is needed. Then, select MAX A/C forfast cooling and return to NORM A/C whenyou are comfortable.

*[IP01835( E )03/95] MAX A/C

[IP01840( E )05/95] The MAX A/C position produces cool air morerapidly to provde faster cooling of your vehicle.This is possible because cooler air is drawn frominside the passenger area and then refrigeratedagain instead of using warmer outside air. Usinginside air will also make the fan sound louderwhich is normal when using MAX A/C. The airflow will be from the instrument panel registers.

*[IP01845( E )03/95] FLOOR

[IP01850( E )05/94] Air flow will be to the floor when FLOOR isselected. The air cannot be cooled in the FLOORposition but can be heated by moving the toplever into the RED area.

[IP01855( E )05/94] DEF FLR

[IP01860( E )05/95] Select DEF FLR to get air to the floor andwindshield defrosters at the same time. If theoutside temperature is about 50˚F (9˚C) orwarmer, the air will also be dehumidified toremove moisture. This feature will help preventfogging in humid weather. The air can be cooledor heated.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 93: 1996 econoline

90

[IP01865( E )04/95] VDEFROST

[IP01870( E )05/95] Select V DEFROST to obtain maximum airflow to the windshield. Move the top lever intothe RED area for the air temperature required todefrost. When the outside temperature is about50˚F (9˚C) or warmer, the air will bedehumidified to remove moisture. The air can becooled or heated. Rotate the H knob to increasethe air flow.

*[IP01875( E )05/94] Operating Tips

*[IP01880( E )02/95] The following tips help you get the mostsatisfaction from your air conditioner and heatersystem:

[IP01885( E )04/95] ❑ In humid weather, select V DEFROST. Thiswill help to prevent windshield fogging. Aftera few minutes of operation, you may selectanother air flow position.

*[IP01890( E )02/95] ❑To prevent humidity buildup inside yourvehicle, always drive with the air conditionerand heater system turned on.

[IP01895( E )05/94] ❑Do not put objects under the front seatsunless your vehicle is equipped with anunderseat storage tray. Improperly storedobjects will interfere with the flow of airunder the seats to the back seat area.

[IP01899( E )05/95] ❑Remove any snow, ice, or leaves from the airintake area of your Air Conditioner andHeater System which could block the airintake. The intake area is located at thebottom of the windshield.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 94: 1996 econoline

91

%*[IP04010( E )12/91] Auxiliary Heater and AirConditioner (If equipped)

*[IP04020( E )03/93] If your vehicle is equipped with a factoryinstalled auxiliary unit (heater or heater/airconditioner), the front control assembly willinclude separate switches for FRONT and REARfan control. Fan speed for front and rear systemscan be set as desired by adjusting these switches.

[IP04050( E )03/93] In addition, on vehicles equipped with auxiliaryA/C, an auxiliary unit fan switch is located inthe headliner at a location between the front andrear seats.

[IP04055( E )03/93] ❑To control the auxiliary fan with this switch,the rear fan switch on the front control mustbe in the REAR CONTROL position.

[IP04060( E )03/93] NOTE: The air flow from the auxiliary unit isdischarged from the headlinerregisters (if so equipped) or the A/Cregister (untrimmed vehicles) whenfront control selector is in MAX A/C,NORM A/C and VENT only, and fromfloor registers when front control is inFLOOR FLR/DEF and DEF only.

[IP04065( E )03/93] ❑The auxiliary unit does not provide formixing of hot and cold air; adjustment oftemperature in the rear may be accomplishedby increasing or decreasing the rear fanspeed.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 95: 1996 econoline

92

[IP04080( E )03/93]

quarter page art:0020924-A

Rear mounted auxiliary fan switch

*[IP16800(BEF )01/95] The Interior and Exterior Lights

*[IP16900( ALL)01/95] Turning On the Exterior Lights

*[IP17000( ALL)02/95] To turn on your headlamps, parking lamps,marker lamps, and tail lamps, use the headlampswitch to the left of the steering column.

*[IP17100( ALL)06/94] 1. Pull the headlamp control knob toward youto the first position. Parking lamps, taillamps and marker lamps are now on.

*[IP17200( ALL)06/94] 2. Pull the headlamp control knob toward youto the outer position. Headlamps are now onin addition to the above.

*[IP17250(BEF )02/95] 3. Rotate the knob when it is in an on positionto brighten or dim the instrument panellamps. Rotate fully counterclockwise tooperate courtesy and cargo lamps.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 96: 1996 econoline

93

[IP17280( E )12/91]

half page art:0020123-D

Headlamp switch

%*[IP17400(BEF )05/95] Cleaning the Exterior Lamps

*[IP17500(BEF )05/95] Do not use dry paper towel, chemical solventsor abrasive cleaners to clean the lamps, as thesemay cause scratches or crack the lamps.

*[IP17815( ALL)01/95] Daytime Running Light System

*[IP17820( ALL)03/95] (Canadian vehicles only)

*[IP17830( ALL)03/95] The Daytime Running Light (DRL) system turnsthe high beam headlamps on, with a reducedlight output, when:

*[IP17835( ALL)03/95] ❑The headlamp system is in the OFF position,and

*[IP17840( ALL)03/95] ❑The vehicle is running, and

*[IP17850( ALL)01/95] ❑The vehicle has a fully released parkingbrake.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 97: 1996 econoline

94

*[IP17875( ALL)01/95] NOTE: You may notice that the lights flickerwhen the vehicle is turned on or off.This is a normal condition.

*[IP17890(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

The Daytime Running Light (DRL) systemwill not illuminate the tail lamps andparking lamps. Turn on your headlampsat dusk. Failure to do so may result in acollision.

*[IP17900(BEF )03/95] Lighting Up the Instrument Panel and theInterior of Your Vehicle

*[IP18000(BEF )03/95] The instrument panel lights can be turned on bypulling the headlamp switch toward you toeither the first or outer position. You canbrighten or dim the instrument panel lights byrotating the headlamp switch knob.

%*[IP18400(BEF )03/95] Cargo, Courtesy and Dome Lamps

*[IP18700(BE )12/91] Rear cargo lamps, equipped with anON/OFF/DOOR switch will light when thedoors are closed and the switch is in the ONposition.

[IP18900( E )03/91] The standard dome lamp and cargo lamp (withswitch in DOOR position, if so equipped)operate as courtesy lamps when either frontdoor is opened. Both the dome lamp and cargolamp can be turned on by rotating the headlampswitch knob.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 98: 1996 econoline

95

[IP18950( E )12/91] When the cargo lamp switch (if so equipped) isin the “OFF” position, it will not turn on whenyou open the doors or turn the headlamp switchknob.

*[IP19000(BE )05/95]

quarter page art:0020125-B

Rear cargo lamp with rear headliner

[IP19050( E )05/95]

quarter page art:0020829-A

Cargo lamp without rear headliner

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 99: 1996 econoline

96

*[IP19425( E )10/94] High-mount Brakelamp

[IP19465( E )02/92] The highmount brakelamp is located outside thevehicle, directly over the rear doors.

[IP19485( E )02/92]

one third page art:0020926-B

Highmount stoplamp

*[IP20010( E )01/95] Front and Rear Courtesy/Reading Lamps

[IP20020( E )05/91] Your vehicle may be equipped with either onecourtesy/reading lamp located at the front-centeror three courtesy/reading lamps located at thefront-center, mid-center and rear-center of theheadliner (roof). The right lamps are for theright side passengers and the left lamps are forthe driver and rear left side passenger.

*[IP20030( E )05/95] With the lens in the flat position, thecourtesy/reading lamp will illuminate when anydoor is opened or when the headlamp dimmerknob is rotated to the courtesy lamp position.

*[IP20040( E )01/95] With the lens in the rotated position, thecourtesy/reading lamp will illuminate.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 100: 1996 econoline

97

[IP20050( E )03/91]

one third page art:0010480-C

Courtesy/reading lamps

%*[IP20060(BEF )04/95] Cleaning the Instrument Panel Lens

*[IP20070(BEF )04/95] Clean the instrument panel lens with a soft clothand a glass cleaner, such as Ford Ultra-ClearSpray Glass Cleaner, or equivalent. Do not usepaper towel or an abrasive cleaner to clean thelens as these may cause scratches.

%*[IP20075(BEF )04/95] Cleaning the Interior Lamps

*[IP20080(BEF )04/95] Your interior dome lamps and map lamps areplastic and should be cleaned with a milddetergent diluted in water. Rinse them with clearwater.

File:06ltipe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:48:31 1996

Page 101: 1996 econoline

99

Steering Column Controls

*[SC00400( ALL)01/95] The controls on the steering column and wheelare designed to give you easy access to thecontrols while you are driving.

*[SC00500( ALL)01/95] The Turn Signal Lever

*[SC00600( ALL)01/95] You can use the turn signal lever on the left sideof the steering column to:

*[SC00700( ALL)03/95] ❑operate the turn signals and cornering lamps

*[SC00800(BEF )01/95] ❑ turn the high beams on/off

*[SC00900(BEF )05/95] ❑ flash the lamps

*[SC01000(BEF )01/95] ❑ turn the windshield wipers and washeron/off

*[SC01100( ALL)01/95] Turn Signals

*[SC01200( ALL)03/95] Move the lever up to signal a right turn. Moveit down to signal a left turn. The correspondingindicator light in the instrument cluster willflash.

*[SC01400( ALL)03/95] If the turn signal stays on after you turn, movethe lever back to the center (off) position.

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 102: 1996 econoline

100

*[SC01700( ALL)05/95]

one third page art:0020081-C

Turn signal lever and functions

*[SC01800( ALL)11/89] If the turn indicator light in the instrumentpanel does not illuminate or remains on (doesn’tflash) when you signal a turn, the turn signalingsystem is malfunctioning. Have this conditioncorrected as soon as possible, but make sure thatyou use the accepted hand signals in themeantime.

*[SC03200( ALL)05/95] High Beams

*[SC03300( ALL)05/95] To turn on the high beams, turn the headlampcontrol knob to the headlamp ON position andpush the turn signal lever away from you untilit latches. When the high beams are ON, thehigh beam indicator light on the instrumentpanel comes on.

*[SC03400( ALL)05/95] To turn off the high beams, pull the levertoward you until it latches. The high beamindicator light turns off.

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 103: 1996 econoline

101

*[SC03800( ALL)05/95]

one third page art:0020074-B

Headlamp high beam switch and turn signal lever

*[SC04200( ALL)05/95] Flashing the Lights

*[SC04300( ALL)06/95] To flash the headlamps, pull the lever towardyou for a moment and then release it. Theheadlamps will flash whether the headlampknob is in the on or off position.

*[SC04400( ALL)03/95] Windshield Wipers and Washer

*[SC04500( ALL)03/95] To turn on the windshield wipers, the ignitionkey must be turned to the ON or ACC position.

*[SC04600( ALL)05/95] Turn the knob on the end of the turn signallever toward the front of the vehicle. You canturn it to either the LO or HI speed position.

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 104: 1996 econoline

102

*[SC04700( ALL)05/95] Variable Interval Wipers

*[SC04800( ALL)03/95] In addition to two speed wipers, your vehicle isequipped with wipers that you can set tooperate at varying intervals. For example, youcan set the interval so they wipe less often whenit drizzles or more often in heavier rain.

*[SC04950( ALL)05/95]

one third page art:0020831-A

Interval wiper on turn signal lever

*[SC05000( ALL)02/95] To set the interval wipers, rotate the knob at theend of the turn signal lever toward or awayfrom the instrument panel to the intervaloperation you desire.

*[SC05100( ALL)05/95] Windshield Washer

*[SC05200( ALL)05/95] To clean the windshield, push in the end of thewiper knob. For a constant spray, keep the knobpushed in. After you release the knob, thewipers operate for two to three cycles beforeturning off (if wipers were off) or returning tothe interval selected.

*[SC05300( ALL)01/95] Do not try to clean the windshield when thewasher fluid container is empty or activate thewashers at any time for more than 15 secondscontinuously. This could damage the washerpump system.

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 105: 1996 econoline

103

*[SC05400( ALL)01/93] RWARNING

In freezing weather, the washer solutionmay freeze on the windshield and obscureyour vision. Always warm up thewindshield with the defroster before youuse the washer fluid. If you cannot seethrough the windshield clearly, it canincrease the risk of being involved in acollision.

*[SC05500(BEF )04/95] For information about refilling the washer fluidor replacing your windshield wiper blades, seeWindshield washer fluid and Wipers in the Index.

*[SC05510( ALL)03/95] Hazard Flasher

*[SC05520( ALL)04/95] The hazard flasher is used to alert other driversto hazardous situations.

*[SC05527(BE )10/94] The flashers will flash and the high-mountbrakelamp will stay on steadily (not flash) withthe brake pedal depressed.

*[SC05530( ALL)03/95] The flashers work whether your vehicle isrunning or not. The flashers work for up to twohours when the battery is fully charged and ingood condition without draining the batteryexcessively. If the flashers run for longer thantwo hours or if the battery is not fully charged,the battery can be drained.

*[SC05540( ALL)09/93] To use the hazard flasher:

*[SC05550( ALL)10/92] 1. Push in the flasher button; it will pop outand the lamps will begin to flash.

*[SC05560( ALL)10/92] 2. To stop the flashers, push in the flasherbutton again.

*[SC05562( ALL)10/92] NOTE: The flasher button will be sticking upslightly higher when ON than whenOFF.

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 106: 1996 econoline

104

*[SC05575(BEF )06/93]

one third page art:0020075-B

Hazard flasher

*[SC05600( ALL)01/95] Horn

*[SC05800(BEF )05/95] To sound the horn, press either horn pad.

*[SC06150(BEF )06/93]

one third page art:0020086-B

Horn location (with speed control option)

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 107: 1996 econoline

105

*[SC06200(BEF )05/95] Tilt Steering (If equipped)

*[SC06300( ALL)06/95] RWARNING

Never adjust the steering wheel when thevehicle is moving.

*[SC06500(BEF )01/94]

one third page art:0020089-C

Turn signal and tilt release wheel lever

*[SC06700( ALL)04/95] To change the position of the steeringcolumn/wheel, pull the release lever on thecolumn toward you. Tip the steering wheel tothe desired position. Release the lever to lock thesteering wheel in place.

*[SC07250( ALL)12/89] Be sure the steering wheel locks in a notch. It isnot infinitely adjustable. Do not adjust thesteering wheel while the vehicle is in motion.

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 108: 1996 econoline

106

*[SC07300(BEF )03/91] Speed Control (If equipped)

*[SC07450( ALL)06/95] Your vehicle has speed control, so you canautomatically maintain a constant speed above30 mph (50 km/h). The switches to operate thespeed control are on the steering wheel.

*[SC07500( ALL)06/95] Use of radio transmitting equipment that is notFederal Communications Commission (FCC) orin Canada the Canadian Radio andTelecommunications Commission (CRTC)approved may cause the speed control tomalfunction. Therefore, use only properlyinstalled FCC (CRTC in Canada) approved radiotransmitting equipment in your vehicle.

*[SC07700(BEF )05/95]

quarter page art:0020093-B

The speed control switches

*[SC07800( ALL)03/95] To set the speed control:

*[SC08000( ALL)06/95] 1. Press and release the ON switch.

*[SC08100( ALL)06/95] 2. Accelerate to the desired speed above30 mph (50 km/h) using the acceleratorpedal.

*[SC08400( ALL)06/95] 3. Press the SET ACCEL switch and release itimmediately to set your speed. If you keepthis switch pressed, your speed will continueto increase.

*[SC08500( ALL)03/95] 4. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.Your vehicle will maintain the speed you set.

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 109: 1996 econoline

107

*[SC08600( ALL)06/95] If you drive up or down a steep hill, yourvehicle may momentarily slow down or speedup, even though the speed control is on. This isnormal.

*[SC08640( ALL)04/95] NOTE: If your speed increases above your setspeed while driving in j (Overdrive)on a downhill grade, you may want todepress the transmission control switchlocated on the shift lever to turn offoverdrive to reduce vehicle speed.Speed control cannot reduce the vehiclespeed if it goes above your set speedon a downhill grade. For the best fueleconomy during normal drivingconditions, leave the shift select in j(Overdrive), or resume as soon aspractical.

*[SC08700( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Do not use the speed control in heavytraffic or on roads that are winding,slippery, or unpaved.

*[SC08801( ALL)05/95] In mountainous areas, at higher elevations, orwhen pulling a trailer, the speed control maynot be able to maintain the preset speed withthe transmission in j (Overdrive).

*[SC09325( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Do not shift the transmission into N(Neutral) with the speed control on.

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 110: 1996 econoline

108

*[SC09350( ALL)03/94] To maintain a preset speed under the aboveconditions, with electronically controlledtransmissions — press the Transmission ControlSwitch. The indicator light will turn on andilluminate the word “OFF.” This will cancel“Overdrive”. You can press the TransmissionControl Switch on or off at any speed. For thebest fuel economy during normal drivingconditions, press the Transmission ControlSwitch to turn off the light. This allowsoverdrive operation.

*[SC09375( ALL)05/95]

quarter page art:0020771-C

Transmission control switch and Indicator light

%*[SC09400( ALL)06/95] Accelerating With the Speed ControlOperating

*[SC09500( ALL)05/95] You can use the accelerator pedal to speed upmomentarily. When you take your foot off theaccelerator, the vehicle will return to the setspeed.

*[SC09600( ALL)06/95] Resetting the Speed Control

*[SC09700( ALL)06/95] To reset the speed control to a lower speed,press and hold the COAST switch. Let yourvehicle slow down to the desired speed andrelease the COAST switch.

*[SC09750( ALL)10/94] Your vehicle has a “tap-down” feature thatallows you to decrease your current speed inincrements of 1 mph (1.6 km/h) by amomentary tap of the COAST switch. Multipletaps of the COAST switch will decrease yourvehicle speed 1 mph (1.6 km/h) for each tap.

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 111: 1996 econoline

109

For example, if you are currently set at 65 mph(104 km/h) and tap the COAST switch 5 timesyour vehicle speed will decrease and set at60 mph (96 km/h).

*[SC09800( ALL)06/95] To reset the speed control to a higher speed,you can follow any of these procedures:

*[SC10000( ALL)06/95] ❑Accelerate to the desired speed using theaccelerator pedal, then press the SET ACCELswitch and release it immediately.

*[SC10200( ALL)06/95] ❑Press and hold the SET ACCEL switch untilthe vehicle accelerates to the desired speed,then release the switch.

*[SC10250(BEF )10/94] ❑TAP-UP — This allows you to increase yourcurrent speed in increments of 1 mph(1.6 km/h) by a momentary tap of theSET-ACCEL switch. Multiple taps of theSET-ACCEL switch will increase your vehiclespeed 1 mph (1.6 km/h) for each tap. Forexample, if you are currently set at 60 mph(96 km/h) and tap the SET-ACCEL switch 5times your vehicle speed will increase and setat 65 mph (104 km/h).

*[SC10300( ALL)06/95] Turning the Speed Control Off

*[SC10400( ALL)06/95] You can cancel the speed control while you aredriving.

*[SC10500( ALL)06/95] ❑Press the OFF switch. The speed control isoff. If you want to resume speed control,press the ON switch and reset the speedcontrol by pressing the SET ACCEL button.

[SC10750( ALL)04/95] ❑Press the brake pedal slightly. The speedcontrol is suspended, but you can reset it bypressing SET ACCEL or return to theprevious set speed with the RESUME switch.

*[SC10800( ALL)06/95] In addition, the speed control is turned off eachtime you turn the vehicle off.

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 112: 1996 econoline

110

*[SC11100( ALL)11/89] Driving uphill or on a steep grade

*[SC11200( ALL)05/95] When the speed control is on, your vehicle maysignificantly drop speed when driving uphill,especially with a heavy load. If the speed dropsmore than 8 to 14 mph (15 - 25 km/h) theautomatic speed control will, by design, becanceled. You may have to temporarily resumemanual speed control while driving up a steepgrade in order to maintain the speed you desire.

*[SC11250( ALL)03/93] Frequent shifting of an automatic transmission orspeed loss during speed control operation can beeliminated by shifting out of overdrive intodrive (or by pressing the Transmission ControlSwitch, if equipped). These conditions couldoccur in hilly terrain or at higher elevations.

*[SC11400( ALL)06/95] If the speed control “dropped out” after yourclimb is completed, the speed of your vehiclecan be reset with the SET ACCEL switch, orreturned to the previous set speed with theRESUME switch, as long as you are driving over30 mph (50 km/h).

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 113: 1996 econoline

111

%*[SC11500( ALL)06/95] Resuming a Set Speed

*[SC11600( ALL)06/95] If you press the brake pedal, the speed control iscancelled. You can return to the speed you setby using the RSM switch, as long as you did notpress the OFF switch.

*[SC11700( ALL)06/95] To resume the speed you had before, you mustbe driving at least 30 mph (50 km/h).

*[SC11800( ALL)06/95] Press and release the RESUME switch. Yourvehicle gradually returns to the previously setspeed and then maintains it.

*[SC11850( ALL)03/95] RWARNING

If your vehicle has speed control, do notuse it on slippery roads. You could losecontrol of your vehicle and could injuresomeone.

File:07ltsce.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:45 1996

Page 114: 1996 econoline

113

Features

*[FV00401(BEF )02/95] Your vehicle has a variety of features designedfor your comfort, convenience and safety. Readthis chapter to find out about standard andoptional features.

*[FV00501( EF )05/90] NOTE: For Stripped Chassis vehicles, see yourBody Builders manual for location andoperation of all items defined in thissection.

*[FV00601(BEF )01/95] Doors%*[FV01801(BEF )03/95] Anti-theft front door lock knobs

*[FV01901(BEF )10/89] Anti-theft lock knobs are designed to precludeunlocking the door by pulling up on the bullettype lock knob. To unlock and open the frontdoor from the inside of the vehicle, pull on theinside door handle.

[FV03401( E )04/95] Side Double Doors (If equipped)

[FV03500( E )05/91] To open the forward door of the side doubledoor from the inside, first unlock the door withthe lock plunger or the power lock switch. Nowreach into the depression in the door and pullthe release handle inward. Open the forwardside door from the outside by pulling the doorhandle towards you.

[FV03600( E )03/91] The rear side door cannot be opened until theforward side door is open. With the forwardside door open, pull the release handle (from themiddle of the rear door pillar) to open the rearside door.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 115: 1996 econoline

114

[FV03701( E )03/91]

one third page art:0020189-B

Side double door handles

*[FV03801( E )04/95] Sliding Door

[FV04001( E )03/94] Unlock the door first. Then unlatch the slidingdoor by pulling the inside handle to the rear, orby pulling the outside handle outward. Nowslide the door back until the catch at the bottomof the door engages. To close, pull the insidehandle forward or pull the outside handleforward, and slide the door forward until it isclosed and latched. If the door is not completelyclosed repeat the process.

[FV04201( E )03/91]

one third page art:0020180-B

Sliding door handles

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 116: 1996 econoline

115

% [FV08701( E )05/90] Dual Rear Cargo Door

[FV08901( E )05/91] To open the right rear door from the inside, firstunlock the door with the lock plunger. Nowreach into the depression in the door and pullthe release handle inward. Open the right reardoor from the outside by pulling on the doorhandle.

[FV09000( E )05/93] The left rear door cannot be opened until theright rear door is open. With the right rear dooropen, pull the release handle (from the middleof the left door) to open the left door.

[FV09100( E )03/91]

quarter page art:0020198-B

Dual rear cargo door handles - outside

[FV09200( E )03/91]

one third page art:0020199-B

Dual rear cargo door handles - inside

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 117: 1996 econoline

116

*[FV09801( E )05/95] RWARNING

Do not operate your vehicle with the reardouble doors open.

*[FV14100(BEF )04/95] Power Door Locks (If equipped)

*[FV14500(BEF )05/95] The power door lock switches are located in thefront doors. To lock all doors push the switchmarked L. To unlock all doors push the switchmarked U.

*[FV14701(BEF )03/91] The manual door locks will override the powerdoor lock controls.

*[FV15001(BEF )05/95]

quarter page art:0020203-C

Power door lock controls

*[FV15301(BEF )05/95] Remote Entry System(If equipped)

*[FV15401(BEF )06/95] If your vehicle has the remote entry system, youcan lock or unlock the vehicle doors withoutusing a key. The remote also has a personalalarm feature. The buttons for the system arelocated on the two hand held transmitters thatcame with your vehicle.

*[FV15600(BEF )06/95] The system will work with up to fourtransmitters. Your vehicle came with twotransmitters. Additional transmitters can beordered from your dealer.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 118: 1996 econoline

117

*[FV15700(BEF )02/95] The remote entry features only operate with theignition in the OFF position.

*[FV15800(BEF )04/94]

quarter page art:0020788-A

The remote entry transmitter

%*[FV15901(BEF )02/95] Unlocking the doors with the remote entrysystem

*[FV16001(BEF )02/95] To unlock the driver’s door, press the UNLOCKbutton.

*[FV16101(BEF )02/95] To unlock the other doors, press the UNLOCKbutton a second time within five (5) seconds ofunlocking the driver’s door.

*[FV16300(BEF )02/95] Locking the doors with the remote entrysystem

*[FV16401( E )04/95] To lock all the doors, press the LOCK button.This will also arm the optional factory installedAnti-Theft system.

%*[FV16800(BEF )02/95] Remote entry personal alarm

*[FV16900(BEF )04/95] If you wish to activate the remote entry systempersonal alarm, press the PANIC button. Thiswill honk the horn and flash the lights forapproximately 2 minutes 45 seconds. You canturn it OFF by pressing the PANIC button againfrom the same transmitter or by turning theignition to the ON or ACCESSORY position.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 119: 1996 econoline

118

*[FV17000(BEF )02/95] When you use the remote entry UNLOCK orPANIC buttons, the illuminated entry systemturns on the vehicle’s interior lights for 25seconds. You can turn these lights off with theremote entry LOCK button or by turning theignition to the ON or ACCESSORY position.

*[FV17100(BEF )04/94]

quarter page art:0060566-B

%*[FV17200( E )04/95] Arming and Disarming the Alarm Systemwith Remote Entry

*[FV17300( E )04/95] Your Remote Entry System will automaticallyarm the factory installed Anti-Theft System whenthe doors are locked, and automatically disarm itwhen the doors are unlocked. The remote willalso reset the anti-theft alarm (when the driver’sdoor is unlocked) if it was triggered.

*[FV17400( E )04/95] The remote entry system may not arm anddisarm non-factory installed anti-theft systems.

%*[FV17501(BEF )02/95] Replacing the batteries

*[FV17601(BEF )02/95] The remote entry transmitter is powered by twocoin type three-volt lithium 2016batteries (included) that should last for severalyears of normal use. If you notice a significantdecrease in operating range, the batteries shouldbe replaced. Replacement batteries can bepurchased at most pharmacies, watch stores orat your Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 120: 1996 econoline

119

*[FV17701(BEF )02/95] NOTE: The operating range of the remoteentry system can also be affected byweather conditions (such as very coldtemperatures) or structures around thevehicle (buildings, other vehicles, radioand TV towers, etc.). Typical operatingrange will allow you to be up to 33feet (10 meters) away from yourvehicle.

*[FV17801(BEF )03/93]

quarter page art:0020789-A

Opening the remote transmitter

*[FV17901(BEF )02/95] The transmitter can be snapped apart to replacethe batteries by twisting a thin coin between thetwo halves of the transmitter. DO NOT TAKETHE FRONT PART OF THE TRANSMITTERAPART. When installing the new batteries, besure to place the positive (+) side down asmarked. Snap the two halves back together.

*[FV18001(BEF )02/95]

quarter page art:0020790-A

Replacing the batteries

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 121: 1996 econoline

120

%*[FV18101(BEF )02/95] Replacing lost transmitters

*[FV18200(BEF )06/95] In the event a transmitter is lost, you shouldtake all your vehicle’s transmitters to yourdealer to have the remote entry systemdeprogrammed for the lost transmitter. This isnecessary to prevent further unauthorized use ofthe lost transmitter.

*[FV18301(BEF )02/95] You can also purchase additional transmitters(up to 4 transmitters can be used) from yourdealer. You will need to take all yourtransmitters to the dealer so they can programthem to the remote entry system all at the sametime.

*[FV18400( E )03/94] Memory lock (sliding door)

[FV18500( E )05/91] Your Econoline has a “Memory Lock” featurethat does not require the sliding door or the60/40 cargo doors to be closed before using thepower locks. If you lock your doors with thepower lock switch or the Remote Transmitterwhile the door is open, the door willautomatically lock after it is closed.

*[FV18601(BEF )04/95] Illuminated Entry System (If equipped)

[FV18701(BEF )04/95] This system will provide illumination of thevehicle’s interior courtesy lamps when eitheroutside front door handle is pulled or when theRemote Entry System is used to unlock the dooror sound the Personal Alarm. The system willautomatically turn off after approximately 25seconds or when the ignition is turned to theSTART or ACCESSORY position.

*[FV18801(BEF )04/94] NOTE: The inside lights will not turn off ifyou have turned them on with thedimmer knob or if any door is open.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 122: 1996 econoline

121

% [FV19103( E )04/95] Anti-theft system (If equipped)

*[FV19106( E )05/95] When armed, this system helps protect yourvehicle against break-ins or theft.

%*[FV19109( E )05/95] When an unauthorized entry occurs, the systemtriggers and will:

*[FV19112( E )05/95] ❑ flash the headlamps, parking lamps, andalarm indicator lamp

*[FV19115( E )06/95] ❑honk the horn

*[FV19118( E )05/95] ❑disable the starting circuit to prevent thevehicle from being started

%*[FV19121( E )05/95] Arming the system

*[FV19124( E )05/95] 1. Remove the key from the ignition.

*[FV19130( E )05/95] 2. Open any door. The alarm indicator lightwill start flashing to remind you to arm thesystem.

*[FV19133( E )05/95] 3. Lock the doors by using the power doorlock switch. The alarm indicator light willnow glow steadily.

*[FV19134( E )04/95] NOTE: The system can also be armed bypressing the LOCK button on theremote transmitter after the doors havebeen closed.

*[FV19136( E )04/95] 4. Close all doors. The alarm indicator lightwill then remain on steadily forapproximately 30 more seconds and then goout. When the light goes out the system isarmed.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 123: 1996 econoline

122

*[FV19139( E )06/95] NOTE: Be sure to close all doors completely. Ifnot, the alarm indicator light willremain on. Remember, your anti-theftsystem is armed only after the alarmindicator light remains on steadily forapproximately 30 seconds after the lastdoor is closed, and then goes out.

*[FV19154( E )04/95] The anti-theft system is designed to work withthe factory installed remote entry system. It maynot work with other remote entry systems.

%*[FV19157( E )05/95] Disarming an untriggered anti-theft system

[FV19160( E )03/93] You can disarm the system by unlocking eitherfront door or the rear door with your door key.Turn the key all the way to the end of travel orthe system will not disarm.

*[FV19163( E )04/95] You can also disarm the system by unlockingthe driver’s door by using the UNLOCK buttonof the remote entry transmitter.

*[FV19166( E )04/95] If the system is armed and you remain in yourvehicle, simply insert the key into the ignitionand turn it to ON. This disarms the system andallows you to open the door and exit withouttriggering the system.

%*[FV19187( E )05/95] Disarming a triggered system

*[FV19190( E )05/95] The alarm can be disarmed by:

*[FV19196( E )04/95] ❑unlocking any door with the key, or

*[FV19199( E )05/95] ❑using the UNLOCK button of the remoteentry transmitter

*[FV19202( E )05/95] NOTE: The flashing lights and honking hornwill shut off automatically within 2minutes 45 seconds after the system istriggered. It will trigger again ifanother intrusion occurs. However, thestarter circuit remains disabled untilthe system is disarmed.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 124: 1996 econoline

123

*[FV19250(BEF )02/95] Windows[FV19800( E )02/91] Side, cargo door and rear door window

controls (If equipped)

[FV19900( E )04/89] To open, press down on the window latches.Then depress the levers on each side of the latchand pull the latch upward. Move the latch outand depress into the open position. To close,depress the levers on each side of the latch. Liftthe latch and pull inward, then press down onthe latch to lock the levers.

[FV20000( E )04/89]

quarter page art:0020216-A

Window latch

[FV20100( E )05/95] RWARNING

Rear doors, rear door flipper windows,and van conversion windows, should beclosed while driving. This will preventexhaust fumes from being drawn intoyour vehicle.

[FV20200( E )03/95] If you can’t avoid leaving one or all of theabove windows open, you should pay carefulattention to the following precautions:

[FV20300( E )03/95] ❑Adjust your climate control system to forceoutside air into your vehicle.

[FV20400( E )03/95] ❑Completely open the outside air vents, if yourvehicle is so equipped.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 125: 1996 econoline

124

*[FV22901(BEF )03/91] Using the Power Windows (If equipped)

*[FV23001(BEF )06/95] Each door has a power control that opens andcloses the window on that door. The driver’sdoor has a master control switch that operatesboth front door windows. You must place theignition switch in the ON or ACC position touse your power window controls.

*[FV23501(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Do not let children play with the powerwindows. They may seriously hurtthemselves. Make sure occupants are clearof the window(s) before closing.

*[FV23800(BEF )05/95]

quarter page art:0020203-C

Master control switch

*[FV24101(BEF )01/95] Seats%*[FV24801(BEF )05/90] Adjusting the Front Seat Manually

*[FV24901(BEF )06/95] To move the front seat forward or rearward:

*[FV25001(BEF )06/95] 1. Find the adjustment lever at the lower leftcorner of the front seat.

*[FV25101(BEF )06/95] 2. Push the lever to the left to unlatch the seat.

*[FV25201(BEF )06/95] 3. Move the seat to the desired position.

*[FV25301(BEF )06/95] 4. Release the lever to latch the seat in its newposition. Make sure the seat locks securely inplace.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 126: 1996 econoline

125

*[FV26001(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Never adjust the driver’s seat or seatbackwhen the vehicle is moving.

*[FV26100(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Do not pile cargo higher than theseatbacks to avoid injuring people in acollision or sudden stop.

*[FV26200(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

To reduce the risk of serious injury in acollision, always drive and ride with yourseatback upright and the lap belt snugand low across the hips.

*[FV26300(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

To reduce the risk of serious injury in acollision, children should always ride withthe seatback upright.

%*[FV26400(BEF )06/95] Reclining Bucket Seats

*[FV27301(BEF )02/92] You can tilt the seat back of your bucket seatsbackward.

[FV27450( E )03/93] 1. On the right hand side of the seat, lift therecliner handle up and hold it in place.

*[FV27501(BEF )10/89] 2. Lean against the back of the seat and adjustit to the position you want.

*[FV27601(BEF )10/89] 3. Release the handle to lock the seat back inplace.

*[FV27701(BEF )10/89] 4. To return the seat back upright, lift thehandle and lean forward.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 127: 1996 econoline

126

[FV27901( E )12/91]

one third page art:0020224-C

Reclining bucket seat

%*[FV31201( E )12/91] Quick Release Rear Captain Chairs

[FV31301( E )12/91] Second row

*[FV31400( E )12/91] To remove:

[FV31700( E )12/91] 1. Disengage the lap/shoulder safety belt fromthe seat by inserting a key or similar deviceinto the slot in the detachable anchor andlifting upward. Stow the tongue end of thedetachable anchor as shown.

[FV31901( E )02/92] 2. Pull the seat latch handle, located on theright hand side of the seat base, and pullseat toward the right hand side of vehicle todisengage four pins from the floor mount.

[FV32001( E )12/91]

one third page art:0020915-A

Removing the quick release rear captains chair

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 128: 1996 econoline

127

[FV32101( E )12/91] 3. Remove the seat from the vehicle.

*[FV32200( E )12/91] To install the rear bucket seat:

[FV32400( E )12/91] 1. Lift the seat assembly into the vehicle andposition the seat to the floor mount.

[FV32600( E )02/92] 2. Engage the four seat pins into theirrespective floor mount holes and push theseat toward the left hand side of the vehicleto fully engage.

[FV32700( E )02/92]

one third page art:0020916-B

Installing the quick release rear captains chair

[FV33001( E )12/91] 3. Push the seat latch handle downward to afull stop. This locks the seat in position.

[FV33101( E )12/91] 4. Before you engage the safety belt, be sure itis not twisted. Remove any twist, then insertthe tongue end of the detachable anchor intothe detachable anchor until you hear a“snap” and feel the latch engage.

*[FV33201( E )05/95] RWARNING

Check to see that the seat is latchedsecurely in position. Keep floor area freeof objects that would prevent proper seatengagement. Never attempt to adjust theseat latch while the vehicle is in motion.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 129: 1996 econoline

128

[FV33400( E )12/91]

three fourths page art:0020783-B

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 130: 1996 econoline

129

[FV33501( E )05/95]

two third page art:0020856-C

Rear seat shoulder safety belt — stowage (with seatremoved)

% [FV36101( E )02/92] Quick Release Rear Passenger SeatAssembly

% [FV36201( E )02/95] Three Passenger and Four Passenger Benchand Bed Seats

[FV36300( E )01/89] To remove the seat assembly:

*[FV36400( E )06/92] 1. Disengage the lap/shoulder safety belt fromthe seat by inserting a key or screwdriverinto the slot in the detachable anchor andlifting upward. Stow the tongue end of thedetachable anchor as shown in theillustration.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 131: 1996 econoline

130

[FV36500( E )05/91]

three fourths page art:0020783-B

Location of the detachable anchor warning label on safetybelt

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 132: 1996 econoline

131

[FV36600( E )05/95]

two third page art:0020856-C

Rear seat shoulder safety belt — stowage (with seatremoved)

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 133: 1996 econoline

132

[FV36700( E )05/95]

three fourths page art:0020784-C

Location of the stowage hook caution label on safety belt

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 134: 1996 econoline

133

[FV36801( E )05/95]

two third page art:0020857-B

Rear seat shoulder safety belt — stowage (with seatremoved)

[FV36900( E )03/91] 2. Lift and rotate the LH/RH seat latch handlesrearward.

[FV37000( E )06/92] 3. Lift the LH/RH latch rod hook ends out ofthe locking holes in the front strikers.

[FV37101( E )06/92] 4. Move (slide) the seat rearward and lift theseat’s rear stanchion hooks away from therear latch strikers in the floor prior to liftingthe front stanchion hooks out from the frontlatch strikers in the floor. Refer to theillustration.

[FV37201( E )03/91] 5. Remove the seat assembly from vehicle.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 135: 1996 econoline

134

*[FV37301( E )05/89] To install the seat assembly:

[FV37401( E )06/92] 1. Place the seat assembly in the vehicle.

[FV37501( E )06/92] 2. Align the front stanchion hooks to the frontlatch strikers in the floor prior to loweringthe seat’s rear stanchion hooks and aligningthem with the rear latch strikers in the floor.

[FV37601( E )06/92] 3. Engage the LH/RH latch rod hook ends inthe front striker locking holes.

[FV37701( E )06/92] 4. Rotate the LH/RH latch handles forward,and at the same time, slide the seat assemblyforward to engage the floor strikers.Continue forward movement until it reachesthe end of its travel.

[FV37801( E )06/92] 5. Before you engage the lap/shoulder safetybelt to the seat, make sure the belt is nottwisted. A twisted belt may cause theretractor to not work properly. Remove anytwist, then insert the tongue end of thedetachable anchor into the detachable anchoruntil you hear a “snap” and feel the latchengage. Refer to the previous illustration.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 136: 1996 econoline

135

[FV37901( E )02/92]

two third page art:0020231-C

Quick seat release — bench seat

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 137: 1996 econoline

136

[FV38001( E )02/92]

two third page art:0020917-B

Quick seat release — bed seat

[FV38101( E )01/89] RWARNING

Keep striker area free of foreign objectsthat would prevent front and rearretainers from engaging the strikersproperly.

*[FV38201( E )05/93] RWARNING

Before using the seat, make sure that thelatch hooks are securely locked around thefloor pins.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 138: 1996 econoline

137

*[FV38301( E )05/95] RWARNING

Never adjust the driver’s seat or seatbackwhen the vehicle is moving.

*[FV38350( E )05/95] RWARNING

Always latch the vehicle seat to the floor,whether the seat is occupied or empty. Ifnot latched, the seat may cause injuryduring a sudden stop.

[FV38501( E )01/89] Floor Striker Removal

[FV38601( E )01/89] To remove striker:

[FV38701( E )12/89] 1. Remove striker attaching bolts and washers.

[FV38801( E )12/89] 2. Remove striker.

[FV38901( E )02/89] 3. Apply a bead of Ford Caulking Cord, PartNo. D6AZ-19560-A or an equivalent to thefloor pan side of the washers.

[FV39001( E )12/91] 4. Ensure proper sealing by installing the boltsand washers into the mounting holeswithout the striker. Tighten to 5-10 ft-lb(7-13 N.m). Do not over tighten.

[FV39101( E )05/89] To reinstall floor striker:

[FV39201( E )12/89] 1. Remove the bolts and washers.

[FV39301( E )12/91] 2. Install striker and bolts and washers. Tightenbolts to 34-46 ft-lb (47-63 N.m).

[FV39401( E )05/90] NOTE: Never substitute other than specifiedbolts and washers.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 139: 1996 econoline

138

%*[FV42101( E )12/89] Seat/bed conversion

*[FV42301( E )05/89] To convert the seat/bed to a bed:

[FV42501( E )12/91] 1. While in the rear of the vehicle, behind theseat, rotate the release lever on the right sideof the seat while pulling the seat backextension panel rearward and up until flat.

[FV42800( E )12/91] 2. Tuck the safety belts into the pockets on theseat cushion while in the bed position.

*[FV42900( E )01/89] To convert the bed to a seat:

*[FV43000( E )07/92] 1. While in front of the seat, pull the releaselever up and at the same time pull theseatback up. Raise the seatback to the fullupright and locked position.

*[FV43100( E )01/89] 2. Make sure the safety belts are free andavailable for use.

[FV43200( E )12/91] 3. Push the seat back extension forward,making sure the latch engages.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 140: 1996 econoline

139

*[FV43300( E )05/95] RWARNING

The seat/bed should not be occupiedwhile the vehicle is moving unless it is inthe upright, fully-latched position.

[FV43400( E )03/91]

half page art:0020237-B

Seat/bed conversion

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 141: 1996 econoline

140

*[FV46600( EF )05/95] Using the Power Seats (If equipped)

*[FV46700( EF )08/94] If your vehicle has the power seat option, youcan adjust it in several directions. The controlsare on the outboard side of the seat.

[FV46900( E )05/91]

half page art:0020889-A

The power controls on the driver’s seat

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 142: 1996 econoline

141

%*[FV47000(BEF )03/94] Using the Power Lumbar Support and SideBolsters

*[FV47400(BEF )12/91] If your vehicle is equipped with this option, youcan inflate a lumbar support pad in the seatback. To inflate the lumbar pad, push the (+)side of the rocker switch. To deflate push the (-)side of the switch.

*[FV47500(BEF )06/92]

quarter page art:0020860-B

Power lumbar switch

%*[FV47600(BEF )04/95] Cleaning the Seats

*[FV47620(BEF )05/95] Leather and vinyl

*[FV47625(BEF )05/95] For routine cleaning, wipe the surface with asoft, damp cloth. For more thorough cleaning,wipe the surface with a leather and vinyl cleaneror a mild soap.

*[FV47630(BEF )04/95] Wipe the surface with a damp, soft cloth, thendry and buff with a dry, soft cloth.

%*[FV47640(BEF )04/95] Fabric

*[FV47650(BEF )04/95] Remove dust and loose dirt with a whisk broomor a vacuum cleaner. Remove fresh spotsimmediately. Follow the directions that comewith the cleaner.

*[FV47660(BEF )04/95] NOTE: Before using any cleaner, test it on asmall, hidden area of fabric. If thefabric’s color or texture is adverselyaffected by a particular cleaner, do notuse it.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 143: 1996 econoline

142

%*[FV49400( E )03/91] Underseat stowage drawer(If equipped)

[FV49600( E )12/91] If your Econoline is equipped with the optionalfront passenger seat drawer, it can be opened bymoving the latch lever upward and pulling thedrawer toward the center of the vehicle. Thedrawer can be removed by pulling it to the fullopen position and lifting the tab on the topsurface, inside the drawer. The drawer is notlockable.

[FV49900( E )08/91]

half page art:0020861-A

Underseat stowage drawer — RH front passenger seat only

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 144: 1996 econoline

143

*[FV50000(BEF )01/95] Mirrors

*[FV50200(BEF )05/95] With the door closed and the seat adjusted forcomfort and proper vehicle control, move themirrors for best view by tilting up or down, leftor right. Do not adjust the mirrors while thevehicle is in motion.

[FV50300( E )05/95] NOTE: Models equipped without rear doorwindows are not equipped with arearview mirror.

*[FV50325(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Make sure you can see clearly through therearview mirror at all times. Do not allowanything to block your vision. If you can’tsee through the mirror, you could beinvolved in an accident and injureyourself or others.

*[FV52400( EF )06/95] Illuminated Vanity Mirror (If equipped)

%*[FV52500( EF )06/95] Your vehicle may feature illuminated vanitymirrors on the sun visors. You can turn on thelighted mirror by lifting the mirror door cover.

*[FV52600( EF )06/95]

quarter page art:0020251-A

Visor vanity mirror

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 145: 1996 econoline

144

%*[FV52900(BEF )06/95] Outside Mirrors (Manual Control)

*[FV53000(BEF )06/95] Adjust outside mirrors with the door closed andthe seat adjusted for comfort and proper vehiclecontrol. Move the mirrors for best view bytilting up or down, left or right.

*[FV53100(BEF )06/95] On vehicles equipped with fold-away mirrors,the mirrors should be folded rearward into thebody position before entering automatic carwash systems.

[FV53600( E )05/95]

one third page art:0020884-C

Outside mirrors — manual control

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 146: 1996 econoline

145

[FV53700( E )05/91]

half page art:0020885-A

Outside mirrors — manual control

*[FV53900( EF )05/90] On vehicles equipped with “non” folding(swing-out recreational) mirrors, automatic carwash systems are not recommended. Use specialtruck wash facilities for vehicles with this typeof mirror.

[FV54200( E )11/90] For the Econoline van without rear doorwindows and all Econolines equipped with theswing-out recreational mirrors, the right-handside mirror is a flat glass mirror. All otherright-hand side/view mirrors used on theEconoline are convex. Convex mirrors have acurved surface and will show a wider view ofthe lane next to and behind your vehicle.

*[FV54400(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

The side view mirror on the right makesobjects appear smaller and farther awaythan they actually are.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 147: 1996 econoline

146

*[FV54500(BEF )08/91] Dual Electric Remote Control Mirrors(If equipped)

*[FV54600(BEF )08/91] To adjust the remote controlled side mirrors:

*[FV54800(BEF )06/94] 1. Find the control switch in the driver’s doorpanel.

*[FV55000(BEF )06/94] 2. Select the right or left mirror by moving theselector switch to R or L.

*[FV55200(BEF )06/94] 3. Move the control knob in the direction youwant to move the mirror.

*[FV55400(BEF )06/94] 4. Return the selector switch to the middleposition to keep the mirror in place.

[FV55600( E )12/91]

quarter page art:0020908-A

Power mirror control

*[FV55900(BEF )12/91] Do not clean the plastic housing of any electricmirror with gasoline or other petroleum-basedcleaning products.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 148: 1996 econoline

147

*[FV59400(BEF )01/95] Console

*[FV59500(BEF )12/91] Your vehicle may have a full console. The fullconsole has the features shown in the illustrationbelow.

[FV60000( E )03/94]

half page art:0020682-D

The features on the console

[FV60050( E )03/94] 1. To install the table, locate the tabs into theslots on the engine cover and push.

[FV60055( E )03/94] 2. To store table, lift at handle.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 149: 1996 econoline

148

%*[FV69900(BEF )03/95] Power Point Electrical Outlet[FV70100( E )06/92] The power point outlet is located in the left

hand (driver’s side) quarter panel, next to therear ashtray. This outlet should be used in placeof the cigarette lighter for optional electricalaccessories.

*[FV70200(BEF )06/92] NOTE: Do not use the cigarette lighter inplace of the power point.

[FV70400( E )06/92]

quarter page art:0020930-A

Power point electrical outlet

[FV70600( E )07/92] To access the outlet, press down while rotatingthe cover counterclockwise.

File:08ltfve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:47:13 1996

Page 150: 1996 econoline

149

Electron

icS

oun

dS

ystems

*[AS01100(BEF)04/95]

fullpageart:0060648-B

Com

pact

Disc

Rad

io

File:09ltase.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 151: 1996 econoline

150

%*[AS01200(BEF )05/95] Compact Disc Radio

*[AS01250(BEF )05/95] The Compact Disc Radio combines the ElectronicStereo Radio with the Ford Compact Disc Player.

*[AS01300(BEF )04/95] Using the Controls on Your New Radio/CDPlayer

*[AS01400(BEF )04/95] Most of the features of this unit work for bothradio and CD operation. Also, some of the knobsand buttons control several different functions,so be sure to read all of the operatinginstructions carefully.

*[AS01500(BEF )06/95] How to turn the radio on and off

*[AS01600(BEF )06/95] Press the “POWER” button to turn the radio on.Press it again to turn it off.

*[AS01625(BEF )06/95] How to adjust the volume

*[AS01650(BEF )06/95] Press the +/S side of the “VOL” button toincrease/decrease the volume. Bars illuminate inthe display to show the relative volume level.

*[AS01675(BEF )06/95] NOTE: If the volume level is set above acertain listening level when theignition switch is turned off, when theignition switch is turned back on, thevolume will come back to a “nominal”listening level. However, if the radiopower is turned off (with the“POWER” button), the volume willremain in the position it was set atwhen radio power is switched back on.

*[AS01700(BEF )06/95] Selecting the AM or FM frequency band

*[AS01800(BEF )06/95] Push the “AM/FM” button to select the desiredfrequency band. When in the radio mode,pushing the button more than once will alternatebetween AM, FM1 and FM2. These functions areused with the station memory buttons describedunder How to tune radio stations.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 152: 1996 econoline

151

%*[AS01900(BEF )05/95] How to tune radio stations

*[AS02000(BEF )07/94] There are four ways for you to tune in aparticular station. You can manually locate thestation using the “SCAN/TUNE” button,“SEEK” the station, “SCAN” to the station orselect the station by using the memory buttons,which you can set to any desired frequency.These four methods are described below.

*[AS02100(BEF )04/95] ❑Using the “SCAN/TUNE” button to manuallytune

*[AS02200(BEF )06/95] You can change the frequency up or downone increment at a time (FM changes inincrements of 200kHz; AM changes inincrements of 10kHz) by first pressing the“SCAN/TUNE” button twice (display shows“TUNE”), then — within approximately fiveseconds — pressing and releasing either thetop a or bottom b half of the “SEEK”button. To change frequencies quickly, pressand hold down either the top or bottom halfof the “SEEK” button. While you aremanually tuning, the display will show ablinking “M”.

*[AS02300(BEF )04/95] Manual tuning adjusts your radio to anyallowable broadcast frequency, whether ornot a station is present on that frequency.(See All About Radio Frequencies in thissection.)

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 153: 1996 econoline

152

*[AS02400(BEF )04/95] ❑Using the “SEEK” function

*[AS02500(BEF )04/95] This feature on your radio allows you toautomatically select listenable stations up ordown the frequency band. Press the top ahalf of the “SEEK” button to select the nextlistenable station up the frequency band.Press the bottom b half of the button toselect the next listenable station down thefrequency band. By pressing and holding thebutton, listenable stations can be passed overto reach the desired station.

*[AS02600(BEF )06/95] ❑Using the “SCAN/TUNE” button to scanradio stations

*[AS02700(BEF )04/95] Pressing the “SCAN/TUNE” button onceenters the scan mode (display will indicate“SCN”). Pushing the top a half of the“SEEK” button will begin the scan mode upthe frequency band, stopping on eachlistenable station for approximately fiveseconds. Pushing the bottom b half of the“SEEK” button will begin the scan modedown the frequency band, again stopping oneach listenable station for approximately fiveseconds.

*[AS02800(BEF )06/95] To stop the scan mode on the presentlysampled station press the “SCAN/TUNE”button again.

*[AS03000(BEF )04/95] ❑Setting the Station Memory Preset buttons

%*[AS03100(BEF )06/95] Your radio is equipped with 5 stationmemory buttons. These buttons can be usedto select up to 5 preset AM stations and 10FM stations (5 in FM1 and 5 in FM2). Followthe easy steps below to set these buttons tothe desired frequencies.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 154: 1996 econoline

153

*[AS03200(BEF )06/95] 1. Select a band, then select a frequency.

*[AS03400(BEF )06/95] 2. Press one of the memory preset buttons andhold the button until the sound returns. Thatstation is now held in memory on thatbutton.

*[AS03500(BEF )06/95] 3. Follow the two steps above for each stationmemory preset button you want to set.

*[AS03510(BEF )04/95] NOTE: If the vehicle’s battery is disconnected,the clock and station memory presetbuttons (if programmed in auto mode)will need to be reset.

*[AS03520(BEF )04/95] ❑Using the Automatic Memory Load feature

*[AS03530(BEF )04/95] You can activate the Auto Memory Loadfeature by pressing and holding the “AUTOPRESET” button for approximately threeseconds. Auto Memory Load sets all memorybuttons in AM, FM1 and FM2 sequentially byseeking out the first five strong stations forthe respective band and storing them inmemory buttons 1-5. (FM2 will store thesecond set of strong stations from the FMband.)

*[AS03800(BEF )06/95] With Auto Memory Store, you cancontinually set strong stations into yourmemory buttons without losing your existingmemory presets, which is especially handywhile traveling. Your radio will automaticallyset your memory buttons to the strong localstations so you don’t have to continuallymanually tune to existing stations.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 155: 1996 econoline

154

*[AS03900(BEF )05/95] Activate Auto Memory Store by pushing the“AUTO PRESET” button once. Your radiowill set the first five strong stations of theband you are in (AM, FM1 or FM2) into thememory buttons. The display will show“AUTO”, then run through the frequencies,stopping momentarily on the stations beingset into the memory buttons. The radio isnow in the “AUTO” mode and this displaywill show “AUTO” each time a preset isactivated.

*[AS04000(BEF )05/95] NOTE: If there are fewer than five strongstations in the frequency band, theremaining unfilled buttons will storethe last strong station detected on theband.

*[AS04100(BEF )05/95] After all stations have been filled, the radiowill begin playing the station stored onmemory button 1.

*[AS04200(BEF )04/95] To deactivate the Auto Memory Store modeand return to the manually-set memorybutton stations (or those stations set usingAuto Memory Load), simply push the“AUTO PRESET” button. Display will show“AUTO” then “OFF”. The next time AutoMemory Store is activated on that band, theradio will store the next set of five strongstations.

*[AS04400(BEF )06/95] Using the “AUDIO” button to adjust thetone balance and speaker output

*[AS04500(BEF )06/95] ❑ Increasing or decreasing bass response

*[AS04600(BEF )06/95] Push the “AUDIO” button repeatedly untilthe display reads “BASS.” Push the “+” sideof the “VOL” button to increase bass (more“lows”), and push the “-” side to decreasebass (less “lows”).

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 156: 1996 econoline

155

*[AS04700(BEF )06/95] ❑ Increasing or decreasing treble response

*[AS04800(BEF )06/95] Push the “AUDIO” button repeatedly untilthe display reads “TREB.” Push the “+” sideof the “VOL” button to increase treble (more“highs”), and push the “-” side to decreasetreble (less “highs”).

*[AS05050(BEF )06/95] ❑Adjusting speaker balance

*[AS05100(BEF )06/95] Balance control allows you to adjust thesound distribution between the right and leftspeakers. Push the “AUDIO” buttonrepeatedly until the display reads “BAL.”Push the “+” side of the “VOL” button toshift the sound to the right speakers, andpush the “-” side to shift the sound to theleft speakers.

*[AS05150(BEF )06/95] ❑Adjusting speaker fader

*[AS05200(BEF )06/95] Fade control allows you to adjust the sounddistribution between the front and rearspeakers. Push the “AUDIO” buttonrepeatedly until the display reads “FADE.”Push the “+” side of the “VOL” button toshift the sound to the front speakers, andpush the “-” side to shift the sound to therear speakers.

*[AS05250(BEF )04/95] NOTE: Illuminated bars in the display showrelative levels of bass and treble andpositions of speaker balance and faderfunctions after adjustments are made,then revert to volume level set.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 157: 1996 econoline

156

%*[AS05300(BEF )04/95] Clock operation

*[AS05350(BEF )04/95] When in the radio mode, push the “CLOCK”button to switch from radio frequency to clock.Only the clock numerals will be displayed in theclock mode — there is no A.M./P.M. indication.When in the clock mode, the time will bedisplayed until the button is pushed again.However, if you retune the radio while it is inthe clock mode, the new radio frequency will bedisplayed for approximately ten seconds andthen change back to clock.

*[AS05400(BEF )04/95] When in the CD mode, push the “CLOCK”button to change the display from elapsed timemode to track number mode to clock mode. Ifthe CD track selection is changed when you arein the clock or elapsed time mode, the new tracknumber will be displayed for approximately tenseconds and then revert back to the previousmode.

*[AS05425(BEF )07/93] The clock can also be viewed with the ignitionoff. Push the “CLOCK” button and the time willbe displayed momentarily.

*[AS05450(BEF )04/95] To set the clock, simultaneously press the“CLOCK” button and either the bottom (b) halfof the “SEEK” button to set hours, or the top(a) half of the “SEEK” button to set minutes.

*[AS06050(BEF )04/95] Using the Controls on Your New CompactDisc Player

*[AS06150(BEF )04/95] Your new Ford Compact Disc Player is capableof playing 12 cm or 8 cm discs, without anadapter! The Player operates when the power ison and a disc is inserted (label side up). Handlethe disc by its edge only. (Be sure to read andfollow all of the care and cleaning instructionsunder How To Take Care of and Clean Your CDPlayer and Discs.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 158: 1996 econoline

157

*[AS06200(BEF )04/95] NOTE: If after you insert a disc, the disc isejected and “ERROR” begins scrollingin the display, remove the disc andreinsert it right side up (label side up).

*[AS06250(BEF )04/95] The digital display on your CD player willeither show the track (selection) number or theelapsed time. (The display mode can be selectedby pressing the “CLOCK” button.) Indicators forplay (a), stop (X) and compression on (“C”)are also in the display. (These features aredescribed later.)

*[AS06300(BEF )04/95] Once a disc is inserted, operation of the CDplayer will override that of the radio.

*[AS06350(BEF )04/95] NOTE: The volume, bass, treble, balance andfader controls on the radio are alsoused with the CD player. Refer toearlier operating instructions on thesecontrols.

*[AS06400(BEF )04/95] How to insert a disc and begin play

*[AS06450(BEF )04/95] Insert one disc, label side up into the discopening. When inserted, the disc automaticallyloads into the unit and play starts at thebeginning of the first track (selection).

*[AS06500(BEF )06/95] When the disc reaches the end, the disc playerautomatically returns to the beginning of thedisc and resumes playing.

*[AS06550(BEF )04/95] NOTE: Once a disc is inserted, the discopening is secured to prevent theaccidental insertion of a second disc.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 159: 1996 econoline

158

*[AS06600(BEF )04/95] NOTE: The CD player has heat protectioncircuitry to protect the laser diode. Ifthe temperature of the player reaches167˚F (75˚C), the heat detection circuitwill shut off the player and “TOOHOT” will scroll in the display forapproximately five seconds (radio willresume playing). When the temperaturereturns to normal operating range, theCD player will again be operational.

*[AS06650(BEF )06/95] How to stop and restart the CD player

*[AS06700(BEF )04/95] When a disc is loaded, the unit automaticallyenters the play mode and the play indicator ailluminates. To stop temporarily, press the“PLAY/STOP” button or the “AM/FM” button.The stop indicator X in the display illuminatesand operation returns to the radio mode. Toresume CD play, press the “PLAY/STOP”button once again.

*[AS06750(BEF )04/95] NOTE: If the ignition key is turned OFFduring play and then is set to the ONor ACCESSORY position, the CDplayer will resume playing in the modeit was in when ignition was turned off.

*[AS06760(BEF )04/95] Using the “SEEK” feature

*[AS06765(BEF )04/95] The “SEEK” feature allows you to quickly find aparticular selection on the disc.

*[AS06770(BEF )05/95] Press the bottom (b) half of the “SEEK” buttononce to repeat the current playing selection.Press the top (a) half of the “SEEK” button toadvance to the next selection.

*[AS06775(BEF )05/95] Pressing and holding the bottom (b) or top (a)half of the “SEEK” button will scroll backwardand forward respectively through the tracks.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 160: 1996 econoline

159

*[AS06800(BEF )06/95] How to fast forward or reverse your CDplayer

*[AS06850(BEF )06/95] To quickly search for a particular point in aselection, press the “FF” button (to fast forward)or the “REV” button (to reverse). While eitherbutton is pressed, the disc goes forward orbackward at two different speeds depending onhow long the button is held down. (Pressingeither button for more than three seconds willspeed up the process.) Release the button at thedesired point (found by watching the elapsedplaying time in the display or by listening to thesound during fast forward or reverse). Whenyou have reached the beginning of track 1, theCD player will begin playing.

*[AS06900(BEF )04/95] When you have reached the end of the disc bykeeping the fast forward button pressed, thedisplay will show “END” and the player will gointo pause mode. Push the “PLAY/STOP”button to begin playing the first track of thedisc, press the “REV” button to back up fromthe end of the disc, or use the “SEEK” functionto locate a desired track.

*[AS07000(BEF )04/95] Using the “SCAN” function

*[AS07050(BEF )04/95] Press the “SCAN/TUNE” button to enter thescan mode. Once in the scan mode, press the top(a) or bottom (b) half of the “SEEK” button toscan forward or reverse, respectively. The CDplayer will begin scanning the disc, stopping oneach listenable track for approximately eightseconds. This continues until you press the“SCAN/TUNE” button a second time. While inthe scan mode, the display shows the currentsampled track number.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 161: 1996 econoline

160

*[AS07100(BEF )04/95] Special features of your CD player

*[AS07150(BEF )04/95] ❑Compression

*[AS07200(BEF )04/95] The compression feature will bring soft andloud passages closer together for a moreconsistent listening level.

*[AS07250(BEF )04/95] To turn the compression on, press the“COMP” button. When on, the compressionindicator (“C”) will appear in the display.Press the button again to turn off.

*[AS07300(BEF )04/95] ❑Automatic Disc Storage

*[AS07350(BEF )04/95] If the disc is ejected from the CD player butis not removed from the disc opening withinapproximately 10 seconds, the player willautomatically reload the disc for storage,unless the disc is automatically ejected due toa “focus error” (disc inserted upside down).In this case, the disc will not be automaticallyreloaded.

*[AS07400(BEF )04/95] How to eject the disc

*[AS07500(BEF )04/95] Push the “EJECT” button to stop play, eject thedisc and resume radio operation of your audiosystem.

*[AS07600(BEF )04/95] NOTE: You can eject the disc while the radiopower and/or ignition is on or off.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 162: 1996 econoline

161

%*[AS08100(BEF )04/95] How To Take Care of and Clean Your CDPlayer and Discs

*[AS08200(BEF )06/95] To ensure the continued performance of yourFord Compact Disc Player, carefully read thefollowing precautions:

*[AS08300(BEF )04/95] ❑Always handle the disc by its edge. Nevertouch the playing surface.

*[AS08400(BEF )04/95] ❑Before playing, inspect the disc for anycontamination. If needed, clean the disc withan approved disc cleaner, such as theDiscwasherH Compact Disc Cleaner or theAllsop 3H Compact Disc Cleaner, by wipingfrom the center out to the edges. Do not usea circular motion to clean.

*[AS08500(BEF )04/95] ❑Do not clean discs with solvents such asbenzine, thinner, commercially availablecleaners or antistatic spray intended foranalog records.

*[AS08600(BEF )04/95] ❑Do not expose the disc to direct sunlight orheat sources such as defroster and floorheating ducts. Do not leave any discs in aparked car in direct sunlight where there maybe a considerable rise in temperature ordamage may result.

*[AS08700(BEF )04/95] ❑After playing, store the disc in its case.

*[AS08800(BEF )06/95] ❑ If a disc has already been inserted, do not tryto insert another disc. Doing so may damagethe disc player.

*[AS08900(BEF )06/95] ❑Do not insert anything other than a disc intothe disc player.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 163: 1996 econoline

162

*[AS09000(BEF )04/95] CAUTION: The use of optical instruments withthis product will increase eye hazard as the laserbeam used in this compact disc player isharmful to the eyes. Do not attempt todisassemble the case. Refer servicing to qualifiedpersonnel only.

*[AS09100(BEF )06/95] Common Operating Conditions of YourCD Player

*[AS09200(BEF )04/95] The following information is designed to helpyou recognize typical situations that could bemistakenly interpreted as mechanicalmalfunctions of the disc player.

*[AS09300(BEF )04/95] ❑A disc is already loaded.

*[AS09400(BEF )04/95] ❑The disc is inserted with the label surfacedownward.

*[AS09500(BEF )04/95] ❑The disc is dusty or defective.

*[AS09600(BEF )04/95] ❑The player’s internal temperature is above140˚F (60˚C). Allow the player to cool offbefore operating.

*[AS09700(BEF )04/95] ❑Different manufacturers of compact discs mayproduce discs with different dimensions ortolerances, some of which may not be withinindustry standards or in accordance with theCD format. Because of this, a new disc that isfree of dust and scratches could be defectiveand may not play on your Ford CompactDisc Player.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 164: 1996 econoline

163

*[AS09800(BEF )04/95] If play does not begin after the CD button ispushed:

*[AS09850(BEF )06/95] ❑The radio is not on.

*[AS09900(BEF )06/95] ❑The unit is in the stop mode.

*[AS10000(BEF )06/95] ❑Moisture may have condensed on the lenseswithin the unit. If this occurs, remove thedisc and wait approximately an hour until themoisture evaporates.

*[AS10100(BEF )04/95] If the sound skips:

*[AS10200(BEF )04/95] ❑Badly scratched discs or extremely roughroads will cause the sound to skip. Skippingwill not damage the disc player or scratch thediscs.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 165: 1996 econoline

164

%*[AS10300(E)06/95]

High

-Level

Au

dio

System

[AS10325(E)05/94]

fullpageart:0060631-B

High

-Level

Au

dio

System

File:09ltase.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 166: 1996 econoline

165

*[AS10400( E )06/95] Using the Controls on Your New Radio

*[AS10500( E )06/95] How to turn the radio on and off

*[AS10600( E )06/95] Press the “POWER” button to turn the radio on.Press it again to turn it off.

*[AS10800( E )06/95] How to adjust the volume

*[AS10900( E )06/95] Press the +/S side of the “VOL” button toincrease/decrease the volume. Bars illuminate inthe display to show the relative volume level.

*[AS10950( E )06/95] NOTE: If the volume level is set above acertain listening level when theignition switch is turned off, when theignition switch is turned back on, thevolume will come back to a “nominal”listening level. However, if the radiopower is turned off (with the“POWER” button), the volume willremain in the position it was set atwhen radio power is switched back on.

*[AS11000( E )06/95] Selecting the AM or FM frequency band

*[AS11100( E )07/92] Push the “AM/FM” button to select the desiredfrequency band. When in the radio mode,pushing the button more than once will alternatebetween AM, FM1 and FM2. These functions areused with the station memory buttons describedunder How to Tune Radio Stations.

%*[AS11200( E )05/95] How to tune radio stations

*[AS11300( E )04/95] There are four ways for you to tune in aparticular station. You can manually locate thestation using the “SCAN/TUNE” button,“SEEK” the station, “SCAN” to the station orselect the station by using the memory buttons,which you can set to any desired frequency.These four methods are described below.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 167: 1996 econoline

166

*[AS11400( E )05/95] ❑Using the “TUNE” function

*[AS11500( E )03/95] You can change the frequency up or downone increment at a time (FM changes inincrements of 200 kHz; AM changes inincrements of 10 kHz) by first pressing the“SCAN/TUNE” button twice (display shows“TUNE”), then — within approximately fiveseconds — pressing and releasing either theright (a) or left (b) side of the “SEEK”button. To change frequencies quickly, pressand hold down either the right or left side ofthe “SEEK” button.

*[AS11600( E )04/95] Manual tuning adjusts your radio to anyallowable broadcast frequency, whether ornot a station is present on that frequency.(See All About Radio Frequencies in thissection.)

*[AS11700( E )04/95] ❑Using the “SEEK” function

*[AS11800( E )06/95] This feature on your radio allows you toautomatically select listenable stations up ordown the frequency band. Press the right aside of the “SEEK” button to select the nextlistenable station up the frequency band.Press the left b side of the button to selectthe next listenable station down thefrequency band. By holding the button down,listenable stations can be passed over to reachthe desired station.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 168: 1996 econoline

167

*[AS12200( E )01/95] ❑Using the “SCAN” function

*[AS12300( E )03/95] Pressing the “SCAN/TUNE” button onceenters the scan mode (display will indicate“SCN”). Pushing the right (a) side of the“SEEK” button will begin the scan mode upthe frequency band, stopping on eachlistenable station for approximately afive-second sampling. Pushing the left (b)side of the “SEEK” button will begin the scanmode down the frequency band, againstopping on each listenable station forapproximately a five-second sampling.

*[AS12500( E )06/95] To stop the scan mode on the presentlysampled station press the “SCAN/TUNE”button again.

*[AS12700( E )04/95] ❑Setting the Station Memory Preset buttons

*[AS12800( E )05/95] Your radio is equipped with 5 stationmemory buttons. These buttons can be usedto select up to 5 preset AM stations and 10preset FM stations (5 in FM1 and 5 in FM2).

*[AS12900( E )06/95] Follow the easy steps below to set these buttonsto the desired frequencies:

*[AS13000( E )06/95] 1. Select a band, then select a frequency.

*[AS13200( E )06/95] 2. Press one of the memory preset buttons andhold the button until the sound returns. Thatstation is now held in memory on thatbutton.

*[AS13300( E )06/95] 3. Follow the two steps above for each stationmemory preset button you want to set.

*[AS13400( E )04/95] NOTE: If the vehicle’s battery is disconnected,the clock and station memory presetbuttons (if programmed in auto mode)will need to be reset.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 169: 1996 econoline

168

*[AS13510( E )04/95] ❑Using the Automatic Memory Load feature

*[AS13520( E )04/95] You can activate the Auto Memory Loadfeature by pressing and holding the “AUTOPRESET” button for approximately threeseconds. Auto Memory Load sets all memorybuttons in AM, FM1 and FM2 sequentially byseeking out the first five strong stations forthe respective band and storing them inmemory buttons 1-5. (FM2 will store thesecond set of strong stations from the FMband.)

*[AS13530( E )06/95] With Auto Memory Store, you cancontinually set strong stations into yourmemory buttons without losing your existingmemory presets, which is especially handywhile traveling. Your radio will automaticallyset your memory buttons to the strong localstations so you don’t have to continuallymanually tune to existing stations.

*[AS13580( E )05/95] Activate Auto Memory Store by pushing the“AUTO PRESET” button once. Your radiowill set the first five strong stations of theband you are in (AM, FM1 or FM2) into thememory buttons. The display will show“AUTO”, then run through the frequencies,stopping momentarily on the stations beingset into the memory buttons. The radio isnow in the “AUTO” mode and this displaywill show “AUTO” each time a preset isactivated.

*[AS13583( E )05/95] NOTE: If there are fewer than five strongstations in the frequency band, theremaining unfilled buttons will storethe last strong station detected on theband.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 170: 1996 econoline

169

*[AS13585( E )05/95] After all stations have been filled, the radiowill begin playing the station stored onmemory button 1.

*[AS13590( E )04/95] To deactivate the Auto Memory Store modeand return to the manually-set memorybutton stations (or those stations set usingAuto Memory Load), simply push the“AUTO PRESET” button. Display will show“AUTO” then “OFF”. The next time AutoMemory Store is activated on that band, theradio will store the next set of five strongstations.

*[AS13600( E )02/95] Adjusting the tone balance and speakeroutput of your radio

*[AS13800( E )06/95] ❑ Increasing or decreasing bass response

*[AS13900( E )06/95] Push the “AUDIO” button repeatedly untilthe display reads “BASS.” Push the “+” sideof the “VOL” button to increase bass (more“lows”), and push the “-” side to decreasebass (less “lows”).

*[AS14000( E )06/95] ❑ Increasing or decreasing treble response

*[AS14100( E )06/95] Push the “AUDIO” button repeatedly untilthe display reads “TREB.” Push the “+” sideof the “VOL” button to increase treble (more“highs”), and push the “-” side to decreasetreble (less “highs”).

*[AS14400( E )06/95] ❑Adjusting speaker balance

*[AS14500( E )06/95] Balance control allows you to adjust thesound distribution between the right and leftspeakers. Push the “AUDIO” buttonrepeatedly until the display reads “BAL.”Push the “+” side of the “VOL” button toshift the sound to the right speakers, andpush the “-” side to shift the sound to theleft speakers.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 171: 1996 econoline

170

*[AS14600( E )06/95] ❑Adjusting speaker fader

*[AS14700( E )06/95] Fade control allows you to adjust the sounddistribution between the front and rearspeakers. Push the “AUDIO” buttonrepeatedly until the display reads “FADE.”Push the “+” side of the “VOL” button toshift the sound to the front speakers, andpush the “-” side to shift the sound to therear speakers.

*[AS14750( E )04/95] NOTE: Illuminated bars in the display showrelative levels of bass and treble andpositions of speaker balance and faderfunctions after adjustments are made,then revert to volume level set.

%*[AS15600( E )02/95] Using the Controls of Your Cassette TapePlayer

*[AS15900( E )06/95] How to insert a tape

*[AS16000( E )02/95] Your cassette tape player is equipped withpower loading. Once you insert a tape and pushslightly (with the open edge to the right), theloading mechanism draws the tape the rest ofthe way in and play will begin after amomentary tape tightening process. Displayindicates “M” (for metal/CrO

2) while tape is

playing.

[AS16100( E )05/94] NOTE: A cassette tape can be loaded with theignition on whether or not the radiopower is one.

*[AS16300( E )02/95] How to locate a desired track on the tape

*[AS16325( E )02/95] There are four ways to quickly locate a desiredselection on the tape. You can use the fastforward, rewind, “SEEK” or “SCAN” function.Following are brief descriptions of each.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 172: 1996 econoline

171

*[AS16400( E )02/95] ❑Fast forwarding the tape

*[AS16500( E )05/94] To fast foward the tape, press the “FF”button. The radio will automatically beginplaying until fast forward is manuallystopped. At the end of the tape, the directionautomatically reverses and plays the otherside of the tape.

*[AS16600( E )02/95] ❑Rewinding the tape

*[AS16700( E )07/92] To rewind the tape, press the “REW” button.

[AS16750( E )05/94] The radio will automatically begin playinguntil rewind is manually stopped or thebeginning of the tape is reached.

*[AS17000( E )01/95] ❑Using the “SEEK” function with your cassettetape player

*[AS17125( E )03/95] While in the tape mode, push the right (a)side of the “SEEK” button to seek forward tothe next selection on the tape. Push the left(b) side to seek the previous tape selection.

*[AS17135( E )03/95] NOTE: If you want to restart a currentlyplaying tape selection, press the left(b) side of the “SEEK” button afterapproximately three seconds into thecurrent selection.

*[AS17145( E )03/95] Whirling sprockets in the display (l)indicate the direction of tape travel.

*[AS17200( E )01/95] ❑Using the “SCAN” function with yourcassette tape player

*[AS17325( E )03/95] Press the “SCAN/TUNE” button to enter thescan mode (display indicates “SCN”).Pushing the right (a) side of the “SEEK”button will begin the forward scan mode onthe tape currently playing, stopping on eachtape selection for approximately aneight-second sampling.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 173: 1996 econoline

172

*[AS17335( E )03/95] Pushing the left (b) side of the “SEEK”button will begin the reverse scan mode,stopping on each previous tape selection forapproximately an eight-second sampling.While scanning, the display indicates whirlingsprockets plus an “S” (m).

*[AS17345( E )02/95] To stop the scan mode on the presentlysampled tape selection press the“SCAN/TUNE” button again.

*[AS17380( E )02/95] ❑How to change the side of the tape beingplayed

*[AS17385( E )07/92] The alternate track of the tape can be selectedanytime by pressing the “PLAY/PROG”button.

*[AS17400( E )02/95] How to eject the tape

*[AS17525( E )06/95] To stop the tape and eject the cassette, press the“EJCT” button. The radio will resume playing ifthe radio power is on. The tape cartridge can beejected with radio power (and/or ignition) on oroff.

*[AS17550( E )06/95] How to store the tape

*[AS17575( E )03/95] Press the “AM/FM” button to stop the tapeplayer and resume radio play. The cassette willbe stored in the tape player and the X symbolin the display will be lit until you push the“PLAY PROG” button to resume tape play. Fastforward and fast rewind can be used while thetape is in storage mode without interruptingradio play.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 174: 1996 econoline

173

*[AS17600( E )02/95] Using the DolbyH B noise reduction feature

*[AS17700( E )02/95] NOTE: Noise reduction system manufacturedunder license from Dolby LabsLicensing Corporation. “Dolby” anddouble-D symbol are trademarks ofDolby Laboratories LicensingCorporation.

*[AS17800( E )05/95] Push the k button to activate. When on, thek symbol above the button will be lit.

%*[AS17810( E )03/95] Clock Operation

*[AS17820( E )07/90] How to view the clock mode

*[AS17830( E )06/95] Press the “CLOCK” button to alternate thefrequency and time in the display. In the clockmode, pressing any radio function willautomatically display the radio frequency forapproximately ten seconds before changing backto the clock mode.

*[AS17840( E )07/90] How to set the clock

*[AS17850( E )06/95] 1. Turn the radio on.

*[AS17860( E )06/95] 2. Press and hold in the “CLOCK” button,press the “SEEK” button left (b) to advancethe hours and right (a) to advance theminutes.

*[AS17870( E )07/90] NOTE: The clock displays 12-hour time withno AM/PM indications.

[AS17880( E )07/92] NOTE: On the High-Level Audio System, theclock can be set with the radio poweron or off

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 175: 1996 econoline

174

*[AS18260( E )06/95] Tape error messages

*[AS18280( E )06/95] Your cassette tape player is equipped todiagnose certain problems you may experience.Error codes are as follows:

*[AS18320( E )02/95] Error 0 — Communication error between theradio controller and the tape controller. Thecassette player will eject the tape. Insert the tapeagain. If the same error code appears, turn theignition off, then back on again and insert thetape.

*[AS18340( E )02/95] Error 1 — Possible problem cartridge. Thecassette tape player will eject the tape. Insert thetape again. If the same error code appears in thedisplay, try a different cartridge.

*[AS18360( E )02/95] Error 2 — Tape eject or load failure. Yourcassette tape player will go into the pause mode.Push “EJCT” to eject the tape. If the tape doesn’teject, refer the problem to qualified personnel forservice.

*[AS18500( E )02/95] Tips on Caring for the Cassette Player andTapes

*[AS18600( E )02/95] In order to keep your cassette tape playerperforming the way it was meant to, read andfollow these simple precautions:

*[AS18700( E )02/95] ❑Using a Ford Cassette Cleaning Cartridge toclean the tape player head after 10-12 hoursof play will help maintain the best playbacksound and proper tape operation.

*[AS18800( E )02/95] ❑Only cassettes that are 90 minutes long orless should be used. Tapes longer than 90minutes are thinner and subject to breakageor may jam the tape player mechanism.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 176: 1996 econoline

175

*[AS18900( E )02/95] ❑Protect cassettes from exposure to directsunlight, high humidity and extreme heat orcold. If they are exposed to extremeconditions, allow them to reach a moderatetemperature before playing.

*[AS19000( E )02/95] ❑ If a tape is loose inside the cassette, tighten itbefore playing by putting your finger or apencil into one of the holes and turning thehub until the tape is tight.

*[AS19100( E )01/95] ❑Loose labels on cassette tapes can becomelodged in the mechanism. Remove any looselabel material before inserting cassette.

*[AS19200( E )01/95] ❑Do not leave a tape in the cassette tapeplayer. High heat in the vehicle can cause thecassette to warp.

*[AS21050( E )12/93] Rear Seat Radio Controls

*[AS21055( E )12/93] Using the Rear Seat Radio Controls

[AS21060( E )07/93] Rear seat radio controls are available onEconoline models equipped with Compact DiscRadios or High-Level Audio Systems only.

*[AS21065( E )12/93] The rear seat radio controls are located behindthe driver on the left hand side of the vehicle.These controls duplicate several radio functionsof the radio and allow the use of headphones inthe vehicle.

[AS21068( E )05/94]

quarter page art:0060647-B

Rear Seat Radio Controls

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 177: 1996 econoline

176

*[AS21070( E )06/95] How to turn the rear seat radio controls onand off

*[AS21075( E )12/93] Press memory preset buttons “1” and “3”simultaneously on the face of your radio to turnthe rear seat radio controls on. A headphonessymbol (j) will appear in the display when therear seat controls are on. Press “1” and “3”simultaneously again to turn rear seat radiocontrols off.

*[AS21080( E )06/95] How to adjust the volume

*[AS21085( E )12/93] Press the right (+) side of the “VOLUME” rockerswitch to increase volume, and push the left (-)side to decrease the volume of the rear speakers.

[AS21090( E )07/93] NOTE: Rear seat control volume can be set nohigher than current radio setting unlessspeakers are turned off. See note underHow to turn speakers on and off.

*[AS21095( E )06/95] Setting the AM or FM frequency band

*[AS21100( E )06/95] Push the “BAND” button to change thefrequency band.

*[AS21105( E )06/95] Using the “MEMORY” button

*[AS21110( E )06/95] Push the “MEMORY” button to access thestation you have set into memory button 1 onthe face of the radio. Successively pushing thisbutton will access, numerically, all stations setinto the Station Memory Preset buttons (1through 5).

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 178: 1996 econoline

177

*[AS21115( E )06/95] How to turn the speakers on and off

*[AS21120( E )06/95] When the rear seat controls are on, push the“SPKRS ON-OFF” button to turn all speakersoff. Push again to turn all speakers on.

[AS21125( E )07/93] NOTE: Turning the ignition off, then on againwill not turn the speakers back on, ifpreviously turned off by the “SPKRSON-OFF” button on the rear seatcontrols.

*[AS21130( E )06/95] Using the “SEEK” function

*[AS21135( E )06/95] Press the right (a) side of the “SEEK” rockerswitch to seek to the next radio station. Press theleft (b) side of the “SEEK” rocker switch toseek to the previous radio station.

*[AS21140( E )06/95] NOTE: When using the rear seat controls witha High-Level Audio System, the“SEEK” function on the rear seatcontrols will also function withcassettes, seeking the next (“SEEK a”)or previous (“b SEEK”) selection onthe tape.

*[AS21145( E )06/95] Using headphones with the rear seatcontrols

*[AS21150( E )12/93] Two 3.5mm headphone jacks have beenprovided on the rear seat controls. Plugheadphone(s) into the provided jack(s) to operateheadphones.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 179: 1996 econoline

178

*[AS21300(BEF)05/95]

Electron

icS

tereoan

dS

tereoC

assetteR

adios

*[AS21400(BEF)06/95]

Usin

gth

eC

ontrols

onY

our

New

Rad

io

*[AS21415(BEF)04/95]

fullpageart:0060586-C

Electron

icS

tereoR

adio

File:09ltase.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 180: 1996 econoline

179

*[AS21420(BEF)04/95]

fullpageart:0032394-A

Electron

icS

tereoR

adio

with

Cassette

File:09ltase.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 181: 1996 econoline

180

*[AS22305(BEF )05/95] How to tune radio stations (Stereo Radio)

*[AS22310(BEF )05/95] There are three ways for you to tune in to aparticular station. You can manually locate thestation by using the “TUNE” button, “SEEK” thestation or select the station by using the memorypreset buttons, which you can set to any desiredfrequency.

%*[AS22320(BEF )05/95] How to tune radio stations (Stereo CassetteRadio)

*[AS22350(BEF )02/95] There are four ways for you to tune in to aparticular station. You can manually locate thestation by using Automatic Music Search(“AMS”), “SEEK” the station, “SCAN” to thestation or select the station by using the memorybuttons, which you can set to any desiredfrequency.

*[AS22450(BEF )05/95] ❑Using the “TUNE” function

*[AS22460(BEF )05/95] You can change the frequency up or downone increment at a time by pressing andreleasing either the right (+) or left (-) side ofthe “TUNE” button. To change frequenciesquickly, press and hold down either the rightor left side of the “TUNE” button.

*[AS22470(BEF )04/95] Manual tuning adjusts your radio to anyallowable broadcast frequency, whether ornot a station is present on that frequency.(See All About Radio Frequencies in thissection.)

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 182: 1996 econoline

181

*[AS22550(BEF )05/95] ❑Using the “AMS” function to manually tuneyour radio (Stereo Cassette Radio)

*[AS22650(BEF )06/95] You can change the frequency up or downone increment at a time by first pressing the“AMS” button (display shows “TUNE”) thenwithin approximately five seconds pressingand releasing either the right a or left bside of the “SEEK” button. To changefrequencies quickly, press and hold downeither the right or left side of the “SEEK”button.

*[AS22800(BEF )04/95] ❑Using the “SEEK” function

*[AS22900(BEF )06/95] This feature on your radio allows you toautomatically select listenable stations up ordown the frequency band. Press the right aside of the “SEEK” button to select the nextlistenable station up the frequency band.Press the left b side of the button to selectthe next listenable station down thefrequency band. By holding the button down,listenable stations can be passed over to reachthe desired station.

*[AS23125(BEF )02/95] ❑Using the “SCAN” function (Stereo CassetteRadio)

*[AS23150(BEF )06/95] Press the “SCAN” button to enter the scanmode. The radio will begin scanning up thefrequency band, stopping on each listenablestation for approximately a five-secondsampling. This continues until you press the“SCAN” button a second time.

*[AS23200(BEF )04/95] ❑Setting the Station Memory Preset buttons

*[AS23250(BEF )05/95] Your radio is equipped with 5 stationmemory buttons. These buttons can be usedto select up to 5 preset AM stations and 10preset FM stations (5 in FM1 and 5 in FM2).

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 183: 1996 econoline

182

*[AS23400(BEF )06/95] Follow the easy steps below to set these buttonsto the desired frequencies:

*[AS23500(BEF )06/95] 1. Select a band, then select a frequency.

*[AS23700(BEF )06/95] 2. Press one of the memory preset buttons andhold the button until the sound returns. Thatstation is now held in memory on thatbutton.

*[AS23800(BEF )06/95] 3. Follow the two steps above for each stationmemory preset button you want to set.

*[AS23900(BEF )04/95] NOTE: If the vehicle’s battery is disconnected,the clock and station memory presetbuttons (if programmed in auto mode)will need to be reset.

*[AS24000(BEF )02/95] Adjusting the tone balance and speakeroutput of your radio

*[AS24150(BEF )06/95] Push the “AUDIO” button repeatedly untilthe display reads “BASS.” Push the right (+)side of the “VOLUME” button to increasebass (more “lows”), and push the left (-) sideto decrease bass (less “lows”).

*[AS24300(BEF )06/95] ❑ Increasing or decreasing treble response

*[AS24350(BEF )05/95] Push the “AUDIO” button repeatedly untilthe display reads “TREB.” Push the right (+)side of the “VOLUME” button to increase thetreble (more “highs”), and push the left (-)side to decrease treble (less “highs”).

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 184: 1996 econoline

183

*[AS24500(BEF )08/89] Speaker features and operation

*[AS24600(BEF )06/95] ❑Adjusting speaker balance

*[AS24650(BEF )06/95] Balance control allows you to adjust thesound distribution between the right and leftspeakers. Push the “AUDIO” buttonrepeatedly until the display reads “BAL.”Push the right (+) side of the “VOLUME”button to shift the sound to the rightspeakers, and push the left (-) side to shiftthe sound to the left speakers.

*[AS24800(BEF )06/95] ❑Adjusting speaker fader

*[AS24850(BEF )06/95] Fade control allows you to adjust the sounddistribution between the front and rearspeakers. Push the “AUDIO” buttonrepeatedly until the display reads “FADE.”Push the right (+) side of the “VOLUME”button to shift the sound to the frontspeakers, and push the left (-) side to shiftthe sound to the rear speakers.

*[AS24950(BEF )05/94] NOTE: Illuminated bars show relative levels ofbass and treble and positions ofspeaker balance and fader functionsafter adjustments are made, then revertto volume level set.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 185: 1996 econoline

184

%*[AS25000(BEF )02/95] Using the Controls of Your Cassette TapePlayer

*[AS25500(BEF )06/95] How to insert a tape

*[AS25600(BEF )05/95] Insert a cassette (with the open edge to theright) firmly into the tape door opening, makingsure the cassette is completely in and “seated.”

*[AS25650(BEF )04/95] NOTE: A cassette tape can be loaded with theignition on whether or not the radiopower is on.

*[AS25700(BEF )02/95] How to locate a desired track on the tape

*[AS26265(BEF )02/95] ❑Using the Automatic Music Search (“AMS”)

*[AS26270(BEF )06/95] Press and hold the “AMS” button (“AMS”will appear in the display). Then, push theleft h button to rewind to the beginningof the current selection or press the rightg button to fast forward to the beginningof the next selection.

*[AS26900(BEF )02/95] ❑How to change the side of the tape beingplayed

*[AS27000(BEF )06/95] The alternate track (other side) of the tapecan be selected at any time by pushing bothfast-wind buttons (h and g) at thesame time. The number in the display willalternate between 1 and 2.

*[AS27100(BEF )02/95] How to eject the tape

*[AS27250(BEF )02/95] To stop the tape and eject the cassette, press the“EJECT” button. The radio will resume playing.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 186: 1996 econoline

185

*[AS27300(BEF )02/95] Using the DolbyH B noise reduction feature

*[AS27500(BEF )05/95] Push the k button to activate. Push again todeactivate.

*[AS27550(BEF )02/95] NOTE: Noise reduction system manufacturedunder license from Dolby LabsLicensing Corporation. “Dolby” anddouble-D symbol are trademarks ofDolby Laboratories LicensingCorporation.

*[AS27560(BEF )07/90] How to view the clock mode

*[AS27565(BEF )07/93] Press the “CLOCK” button to alternate thefrequency and time in the display. In the clockmode, pressing any radio function willautomatically display the radio frequency forapproximatedly ten seconds before changingback to the clock mode.

*[AS27570(BEF )07/90] How to set the clock

*[AS27575(BEF )06/95] 1. Turn the radio on.

*[AS27585(BEF )06/95] 2. Press and hold in the “CLOCK” button,press the “SEEK” button left (b) to advancethe hours and right (a) to advance theminutes.

*[AS27595(BEF )07/90] NOTE: The clock displays 12-hour time withno AM/PM indications.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 187: 1996 econoline

186

*[AS27600(BEF )02/95] Tips on Caring for the Cassette Player andTapes

*[AS27700(BEF )02/95] In order to keep your cassette tape playerperforming the way it was meant to, read andfollow these simple precautions:

*[AS27750(BEF )02/95] ❑Using a Ford Cassette Cleaning Cartridge toclean the tape player head after 10-12 hoursof play will help maintain the best playbacksound and proper tape operation.

*[AS27800(BEF )02/95] ❑Only cassettes that are 90 minutes long orless should be used. Tapes longer than 90minutes are thinner and subject to breakageor may jam the tape player mechanism.

*[AS27900(BEF )02/95] ❑Protect cassettes from exposure to directsunlight, high humidity and extreme heat orcold. If they are exposed to extremeconditions, allow them to reach a moderatetemperature before playing.

*[AS28001(BEF )02/95] ❑ If a tape is loose inside the cassette, tighten itbefore playing by putting your finger or apencil into one of the holes and turning thehub until the tape is tight.

*[AS28101(BEF )02/95] ❑Loose labels on cassette tapes can becomelodged in the mechanism. Remove any looselabel material before inserting a cassette.

*[AS28200(BEF )03/95] ❑Do not leave a tape in the cassette tapeplayer when not in use. High heat in thevehicle can cause the cassette to warp.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 188: 1996 econoline

187

%*[AS32400(EF)07/90]

Electron

icA

MR

adio

*[AS32450(EF)05/94]

fullpageart:0060508-C

Electron

icA

MR

adio

File:09ltase.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 189: 1996 econoline

188

*[AS32500( EF )06/95] Using the Controls on Your New Radio

*[AS32600( EF )02/95] How to turn the radio on and adjust thevolume

*[AS32700( EF )05/95] Press the “ON/VOL-PUSH-CLOCK” control toturn the radio on. Press again to turn it off.Rotate the control clockwise to increase thevolume.

*[AS32900( EF )07/93] NOTE: If your radio has a clock feature, turnthe radio on by rotating the controlclockwise. Pushing the control in willchange the display from the radiofrequency to the clock (time) or fromthe clock to the radio frequency.

%*[AS33000( EF )05/95] How to tune radio stations

*[AS33100( EF )05/95] There are two ways for you to tune to aparticular station. You can manually locate astation using the “TUNE” button or select astation using the “MEMORY PRESET” buttons,which you can set to any desired frequency.

*[AS33200( EF )05/95] ❑Using the “TUNE” function

*[AS33300( EF )07/94] You can change the frequency up or downone increment at a time by pressing andreleasing either the right (a) or left (b) sideof the “TUNE” button. To change frequenciesquickly press and hold down either the rightor left side of the “TUNE” button.

*[AS33400( EF )08/04] The “TUNE” control adjusts your radio toany allowable broadcast frequency regardlessof whether or not a station is present on thatfrequency. (See All About Radio Frequencies inthis section.)

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 190: 1996 econoline

189

*[AS33500( EF )04/95] ❑Setting the Station Memory Preset buttons

*[AS33600( EF )05/95] Your radio is equipped with 6 stationmemory preset buttons. These buttons can beused to select up to 6 preset AM stations.Follow the easy steps below to set thesebuttons to the desired frequencies:

*[AS33800( EF )05/94] 1. Tune to the desired frequency.

*[AS33900( EF )05/95] 2. Press one of the memory preset buttons andhold the button in until the sound returns.That station is now held in memory on thatbutton.

*[AS34000( EF )08/89] 3. Follow the two steps above for each stationmemory preset you want to set.

*[AS34100( EF )04/95] NOTE: If the vehicle’s battery is disconnected,the clock and station memory presetbuttons (if programmed in auto mode)will need to be reset.

*[AS34200( EF )02/95] Adjusting the tone balance and speakeroutput of your radio

*[AS34300( EF )08/89] The “TONE” button on the right side of yourradio controls the bass and treble balance. Rotatethe control clockwise to increase the trebleresponse (more highs) and counterclockwise toincrease the bass response (more lows).

%*[AS34400( EF )03/95] Clock Operation

*[AS34500( EF )07/90] How to view the clock mode

*[AS34600( EF )06/95] Press the “CLOCK” button to alternate thefrequency and time in the display. In the clockmode, pressing any radio function willautomatically display the radio frequency forapproximately ten seconds before changing backto the clock mode.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 191: 1996 econoline

190

*[AS34700( EF )07/90] How to set the clock

*[AS34710( EF )06/95] 1. Turn the radio on.

*[AS34720( EF )05/95] 2. Press and hold in theON/VOL-PUSH-CLOCK control.

*[AS34730( EF )05/95] 3. While holding the“ON/VOL-PUSH-CLOCK” button in, pressthe “TUNE” button left (S) to advance thehours and right (+) to advance the minutes.

*[AS34740( EF )07/90] NOTE: The clock displays 12-hour time withno AM/PM indications.

*[AS35200(BEF )06/95] Common Radio Reception Conditions

*[AS35300(BEF )02/95] Several conditions prevent FM reception frombeing completely clear and noise-free, such asthe following:

*[AS35400(BEF )04/95] 1. Distance/Strength

*[AS35500(BEF )02/95] The strength of the FM signal is directly relatedto the distance the signal must travel. Thelistenable range of an average FM signal isapproximately 25 miles (40 kilometers). Beyondthis distance, the radio is operating in a fringearea and the signal becomes weaker.

*[AS35575( EF )07/90] NOTE: Always make sure your antenna(Whether you have a power antenna ora manually adjustable antenna) is fullyextended to its maximum length forproper reception. If your antenna is notfully extended, you may experiencesignal loss while traveling in fringereception areas.

*[AS35600(BEF )04/95] 2. Terrain

*[AS35700(BEF )02/95] The terrain (hilly, mountainous, tall buildings) ofthe area over which the signal travels mayprevent the FM signal from being noise-free.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 192: 1996 econoline

191

*[AS35900(BEF )01/95] If there is a building or large structure betweenthe antenna and station, some of the signal“bends” around the building, but certain spotsreceive almost no signal. Moving out of the“shadow” of the structure will allow the stationto return to normal.

*[AS36000(BEF )01/95] When the radio waves are reflected off objects orstructures, the reflected signal cancels the normalsignal, causing the antenna to pick up noise anddistortion. Cancellation effects are mostprominent in metropolitan areas, but also canbecome quite severe in hilly terrain anddepressed roadways.

*[AS36100(BEF )01/95] To minimize these conditions, a stereo/monoblend circuit has been incorporated into thissystem. This feature automatically switches aweak stereo signal to a clearer monaural signal,which improves the quality of reception.

*[AS36200(BEF )01/95] Several sources of static are normal conditionson AM frequencies. These can be caused bypower lines, electric fences, traffic lights andthunderstorms.

*[AS36300(BEF )01/95] Another reception phenomenon is Strong SignalCapture and Overload. This can occur whenlistening to a weak station and when passinganother broadcast tower. The close station maycapture the more distant station, although thedisplayed frequency does not change. Whilepassing the tower, the station may switch backand forth a few times before returning to theoriginal station.

*[AS36400(BEF )01/95] When several broadcast towers are present(common in metropolitan areas) several stationsmay overload the receiver, resulting inconsiderable station changing, mixing anddistortion.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 193: 1996 econoline

192

*[AS36500(BEF )01/95] Automatic gain control circuitry for both AMand FM bands has been incorporated into thissystem to reduce strong signal capture andoverload.

%*[AS36600(BEF )08/89] All About Radio Frequencies

*[AS36700(BEF )06/95] The Federal Communications Commission (FCC)and the Canadian Radio TelecommunicationsCommission (CRTC) establish the frequenciesAM and FM radio stations may use for theirbroadcasts. The allowable frequencies are, AM:530, 540...1600, 1610 kHz in 10 kHz steps; FM:87.9, 88.1...107.7, 107.9 MHz in 0.2 MHz steps.

*[AS36800(BEF )06/95] Not all frequencies will be assigned to a givenarea. This radio will tune to each of thesefrequencies using manual tune and no finetuning is necessary as radio stations may not useother frequencies.

*[AS36900(BEF )02/95] Some FM radio stations advertise a“rounded-off” frequency which is not thefrequency they actually broadcast on. Forexample, a radio station that is assigned afrequency of 98.7 MHz may call itself “Radio 99”even though 99.0 MHz is not an allowable FMbroadcast frequency.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 194: 1996 econoline

193

*[AS37000(BEF )01/95] Important Warranty and ServiceInformation

*[AS37050(BEF )07/90] Warranty

*[AS37100(BEF )03/95] Your sound system is warranted for three yearsor 36,000 miles (60,000 kilometers), whichevercomes first. Consult your vehicle warrantybooklet for further information. Ask your dealerfor a copy of this limited warranty.

*[AS37300(BEF )10/92] Service

*[AS37400(BEF )01/95] At Ford Electronics, we stand behind our audiosystems with a comprehensive service and repairprogram. If anything should go wrong withyour Ford audio system, return to your dealerfor service. There is a nationwide network ofqualified Ford authorized repair centers to assistyou.

File:09ltase.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:51 1996

Page 195: 1996 econoline

195

Driving Your Econoline

Procedures for driving your vehicle will varydepending on which type of transmission yourvehicle has.

❑an Automatic Transmission (C-6)

❑an Electronic 4-speed Automatic Transmission(E4OD)

❑an Electronic 4-speed Automatic Transmission(4R7OW)

Your vehicle is equipped with an ElectronicPowertrain Control Module that limits engineand/or vehicle speeds with a cut-out mode topromote durability.

Automatic TransmissionOperation (C-6)

Putting Your Vehicle in Gear

Your vehicle’s gearshift is on the steeringcolumn. You can put the gearshift in any ofseveral positions.

NOTE: Do not rest your hand on the gearshiftlever while driving your vehiclebecause you could cause the gearshiftlever to move out of position.

Page 196: 1996 econoline

196

*[DR01000( EF )06/93]

one third page art:0020129-C

The positions of the column-mounted gearshift

*[DR01100( EF )05/95] RWARNING

Hold the brake pedal down while youmove the gearshift lever from position toposition. If you do not hold the brakepedal down, your vehicle may moveunexpectedly and injure someone.

*[DR01200( EF )01/95] Once you place the gearshift securely intoposition, gradually release the brake pedal anduse the accelerator as necessary.

%*[DR01210( EF )01/95] NOTE: Your vehicle is equipped with abrake-shift interlock feature. Thisfeature prevents you from shiftingfrom P (Park) unless you have thebrake pedal depressed. (The ignitionmust be in the ON position.) If youcannot shift from P (Park) with thebrake pedal depressed:

*[DR01220( EF )01/95] 1. Apply the parking brake.

*[DR01230( EF )01/95] 2. Remove the key.

*[DR01240( EF )01/95] 3. Insert the key and rotate one positionclockwise (ignition in the OFF position).

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 197: 1996 econoline

197

*[DR01250( EF )01/95] 4. Apply the brake pedal and shift to N(Neutral). (If the vehicle is shifted to P(Park), you must repeat the previous steps.)

*[DR01260( EF )01/95] 5. Start the vehicle.

*[DR01265( EF )06/95] If you need to shift out of P (Park) by using thealternate procedure described above, it ispossible that a fuse has blown and that yourbrakelamps may also not be functional. Pleaserefer to the chapter titled Servicing Your Econolinein this Owner Guide for instructions on checkingand replacing fuses.

*[DR01270( EF )05/95] RWARNING

DO NOT DRIVE YOUR VEHICLE UNTILYOU VERIFY THAT THE BRAKELAMPSARE WORKING.

%*[DR01300( EF )01/95] R (Reverse)

*[DR01400( EF )02/95] With the gearshift in the R (Reverse) position,the vehicle will move backward. You shouldalways come to a complete stop before shiftinginto or out of R (Reverse).

*[DR01500( EF )01/95] Driving

*[DR01600( EF )06/95] When to use D (Drive)

*[DR01700( EF )12/91] This is the normal driving position. As thevehicle picks up speed, automatic upshifts fromFirst gear to Second and Second to Third willoccur. The transmission automatically downshiftsas speed decreases.

*[DR01800( EF )01/95] When to use 2 (Second)

*[DR01900( EF )12/91] Use 2 (Second) to drive up moderately steepgrades, to start-up on slippery roads or toprovide engine braking on downgrades.

*[DR02000( EF )12/91] Do not go faster than 55 mph (88 km/h) in thisgear.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 198: 1996 econoline

198

*[DR02100( EF )01/95] When to use 1 (Low)

*[DR02200( EF )06/92] Use 1 (Low) to drive up steep grades and toprovide maximum engine braking on hilly roads.Upshifts from 1 (Low) can be made by manuallyshifting to 2 (Second) or D (Drive). Selection of 1(Low) gear provides only First gear operation atstart-up. When driving, manually shifting to 1(Low) will result in downshifts to Second gearor First gear depending on vehicle speed.

*[DR02250( EF )12/91] NOTE: Do not drive faster than 30 mph(48 km/h) in this gear.

*[DR02300( EF )01/95] P (Park)

*[DR02400( EF )03/94] Always come to a complete stop before you shiftinto P (Park). This position locks thetransmission and prevents the rear wheels fromturning. To securely latch the gearshift in the P(Park) position, pull it toward you, push itcompletely counterclockwise against the stop,and then push it toward the instrument panel.

*[DR02450( EF )03/94] The gearshift is securely latched in P (Park) ifyou cannot rotate it in a clockwise directionwithout lifting it toward you.

*[DR02500( EF )06/95] RWARNING

Always set the parking brake fully andmake sure the gearshift is securely latchedin P (Park).

*[DR02600( EF )06/95] RWARNING

Never leave your vehicle unattendedwhile it is running.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 199: 1996 econoline

199

*[DR02900( EF )06/94] Forced Downshifts

*[DR03000( EF )06/92] To gain added acceleration in D (Drive) (whenpassing another vehicle) push the accelerator tothe floor. The transmission will downshift toSecond gear at speeds from about 35 to 55 mph(56 to 88 km/h) or to either First or Second gearat speeds under 35 mph (56 km/h).

*[DR03040( EF )03/94] Power Braking

*[DR03075( EF )03/93] Increasing the engine speed above idle withoutvehicle movement (such as holding the brake) ina forward or reverse gear causes transmissionstall. Continued operation in the stall conditioncan result in transmission overheat, malfunctionor fluid expulsion.

*[DR08650(BEF )03/93] Automatic TransmissionOperation (E4OD and 4R70W)

*[DR08710(BEF )03/94] The E4OD and 4R70W transmissions areelectronically controlled four speed automatictransmissions with overdrive. Transmissionoperation is controlled by the Powertrain ControlModule (PCM).

*[DR08720( ALL)08/94] The PCM will automatically adjust transmissionoperation to make up for varying conditions.Several sensors located on the engine andtransmission such as Throttle Position, EngineSpeed, Vehicle Speed and TransmissionTemperature are used by the PCM to shift thetransmission into a higher or lower gear whenrequired for the best performance and fueleconomy. For example, you may notice that thetransmission will upshift to a higher gear morequickly when the vehicle is first driven and hasnot reached normal operating temperature.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 200: 1996 econoline

200

*[DR08730( ALL)07/94] The PCM also controls the transmission’s TorqueConverter Clutch to further raise vehicleperformance and fuel economy. The TorqueConverter Clutch will engage when thetransmission operating temperature and otherconditions determined by the PCM have beenmet. Engagement of the clutch may be noted asa decrease in engine speed after an upshift hascompleted or when the driver has depressed thethrottle while driving at a steady road speed.

[DR08740( ALL)04/95] To help in troubleshooting, the PCM continuallyperforms self-tests on the electronic controlsystem and if any faults are detected, will storethem in memory. The Transmission ControlIndicator Light (TCIL), which is located on thegearshift lever, may flash steadily if amalfunction has been detected. If the TCIL isflashing, contact your Ford dealer as soon aspossible. If this condition persists, damage to thetransmission could occur.

[DR08745( ALL)04/95] NOTE: The word “OFF” located on the end ofthe gearshift lever is the transmissioncontrol indicator light (TCIL).

*[DR08750( ALL)01/95] Putting Your Vehicle in Gear

*[DR08800( ALL)03/94] Your vehicle’s gearshift is on the steeringcolumn. The Transmission Control Switch andindicator light are located on the end of thegearshift lever. You can put the gearshift in anyof the several positions.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 201: 1996 econoline

201

*[DR08915(BEF )06/94]

one third page art:0021081-A

The positions of the column-mounted gearshift

%*[DR08925( ALL)05/95]

quarter page art:0020771-C

Transmission Control Switch and indicator light (locatedon the gearshift lever)

*[DR09000( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Hold the brake pedal down while youmove the gearshift lever from position toposition. If you do not hold the brakepedal down, your vehicle may moveunexpectedly and injure someone.

*[DR09100( ALL)01/95] Once you place the gearshift securely intoposition, gradually release the brake pedal anduse the accelerator as necessary.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 202: 1996 econoline

202

%*[DR09110( ALL)01/95] NOTE: Your vehicle is equipped with abrake-shift interlock feature. Thisfeature prevents you from shiftingfrom P (Park) unless you have thebrake pedal depressed. (The ignitionmust be in the ON position.) If youcannot shift from P (Park) with thebrake pedal depressed:

*[DR09120( ALL)01/95] 1. Apply the parking brake.

*[DR09130( ALL)01/95] 2. Remove the key.

*[DR09140( ALL)01/95] 3. Insert the key and rotate one positionclockwise (ignition in the OFF position).

*[DR09150( ALL)01/95] 4. Apply the brake pedal and shift to N(Neutral). (If the vehicle is shifted to P(Park), you must repeat the previous steps.)

*[DR09160( ALL)01/95] 5. Start the vehicle.

*[DR09165( ALL)06/95] If you need to shift out of P (Park) by using thealternate procedure described above, it ispossible that a fuse has blown and that yourbrakelamps may also not be functional. Pleaserefer to the chapter titled Servicing Your Econolinein this Owner Guide for instructions on checkingand replacing fuses.

*[DR09170( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

DO NOT DRIVE YOUR VEHICLE UNTILYOU VERIFY THAT THE BRAKELAMPSARE WORKING.

%*[DR09200( ALL)01/95] R (Reverse)

*[DR09300( ALL)02/95] With the gearshift in the R (Reverse) position,the vehicle will move backward. You shouldalways come to a complete stop before shiftinginto or out of R (Reverse).

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 203: 1996 econoline

203

*[DR09400( ALL)01/95] Driving

%*[DR09500( ALL)04/95] When to use j (Overdrive)

*[DR09600( ALL)04/95] This is the normal driving position. As thevehicle picks up speed, automatic upshifts tosecond, third and fourth gears will occur whenj Overdrive is chosen on the selector and thetransmission control switch has not beenpressed. The transmission will shift into thecorrect gear when the right speed is achieved,for the accelerator pedal position you havechosen.

*[DR09700( ALL)03/94] When to use Drive

*[DR09800( ALL)05/95] You will note that there isn’t a drive position onyour gearshift indicator. However, you will finda Transmission Control Switch and an indicatorlight labeled “Overdrive” located on the end ofthe gearshift lever. Press this switch and theword “OFF” will illuminate on the shift leverknob. With the word “OFF” illuminated, thetransmission will operate in gears one throughthree. Operating in the Overdrive “OFF” modegives more engine braking than Overdrive andis useful for descending hills or when towing.

[DR09850( ALL)04/95]

quarter page art:0020771-C

Transmission Control Switch and indicator light (locatedon the gearshift lever)

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 204: 1996 econoline

204

*[DR09900( ALL)05/95] To return the transmission to the normal jOverdrive operation, press the transmissioncontrol switch again. The Transmission ControlIndicator Light will not be illuminated whenOverdrive operation resumes. This switch maybe used to select O/D ON or O/D OFF anytime the vehicle is being driven.

*[DR09950( ALL)05/94] When starting your vehicle, the overdrive systemwill automatically be in the normal overdrivemode.

*[DR10000( ALL)03/94] If the Transmission Control Indicator Light isflashing on and off steadily, a transmissionsystem malfunction was detected. Thetransmission will operate in a failuremanagement mode and may have harshengagements, firm shift feel, or abnormal shiftschedule. If this condition persists, damage tothe transmission could occur. Contact yourdealer as soon as possible.

*[DR10100( ALL)01/95] When to use 2 (Second)

*[DR10200( ALL)01/95] Use 2 (Second) to start-up on slippery roads orto provide additional engine braking ondowngrades. This position provides 2 (Second)gear operation only.

*[DR10300( ALL)01/95] When to use 1 (Low)

*[DR10400( ALL)04/95] Use 1 (Low) to provide maximum enginebraking on steep downgrades. Upshifts from 1(Low) can be made by manually shifting to 2(Second) or j (Overdrive). Selection of 1 (Low)gear provides only low gear operation fromstart-up. Selection of 1 (Low) while at higherspeeds provides a shift to second gear, and ashift to first gear will occur after the vehicledecelerates to the proper speed.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 205: 1996 econoline

205

*[DR10500( ALL)01/95] P (Park)

*[DR10600( ALL)03/94] Always come to a complete stop before you shiftinto P (Park). This position locks thetransmission and prevents the rear wheels fromturning. To securely latch the gearshift in the P(Park) position, pull it toward you, push itcompletely counterclockwise against the stop,and then push it toward the instrument panel.

*[DR10650( ALL)03/94] The gearshift is securely latched in P (Park) ifyou cannot rotate it in a clockwise directionwithout lifting it toward you.

*[DR10700( ALL)06/95] RWARNING

Always set the parking brake fully andmake sure the gearshift is securely latchedin P (Park).

*[DR10800( ALL)06/95] RWARNING

Never leave your vehicle unattendedwhile it is running.

*[DR11100( ALL)06/94] Forced Downshifts

*[DR11200( ALL)04/95] To gain extra acceleration in j Overdrive orDrive (O/D OFF), push the accelerator to thefloor. The transmission will automaticallydownshift to the appropriate gear: third, secondor first.

*[DR11235( ALL)03/94] Power Braking

*[DR11275( ALL)03/94] Increasing the engine speed above idle withoutvehicle movement (such as holding the brake) ina forward or reverse gear causes transmissionstall.

*[DR11285( ALL)03/94] NOTE: Continued operation in the stallcondition can result in transmissionoverheat, malfunction or fluidexpulsion.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 206: 1996 econoline

206

*[DR15915( ALL)01/95] Steering Your Vehicle%*[DR15945( ALL)01/95] Your vehicle comes with power steering. Power

steering uses energy from the engine to helpsteer your vehicle.

%*[DR15950( ALL)04/95] If the amount of effort needed to steer yourvehicle changes at a constant vehicle speed, havethe power steering system checked. If the powersteering system breaks down (or if the engine isturned off), you can steer the vehicle manuallybut it takes more effort.

*[DR15960( ALL)01/95] Never hold the steering wheel to the extremeright or left for more than five seconds if theengine is running. This can damage the powersteering pump.

*[DR15985( ALL)05/90] NOTE: After any severe impact such asstriking large potholes, sliding intocurbs on icy roads, or a collisioninvolving the front end, observe thesteering wheel alignment. If the spokesof the steering wheel seem to be in adifferent position while going straightdown the road, have the frontsuspension and steering checked forpossible damage.

*[DR21400( ALL)03/95] Brakes

*[DR21500( ALL)01/93] Front Disc Brakes

*[DR21600(BEF )06/95] The front disc brakes are self-adjusting. They donot require service other than periodic inspectionfor pad wear.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 207: 1996 econoline

207

*[DR21900(BEF )10/94] Rear Drum Brakes

*[DR22000(BEF )03/95] The rear drum brakes are self-adjusting.Automatic adjustment occurs when the brakesare applied while “backing up.” If normaloperation does not include much backing, adjustthe brakes when they seem “low,” using theprocedure under If Brakes Do Not Grip Well orPedal is Low in this chapter.

[DR22010( E )04/95] Rear Disc Brakes (Econoline Super DutyOnly)

*[DR22050( EFM)04/95] The rear disc brakes are self-adjusting. They donot require service other than periodiclubrication of the caliper slide rails andinspection for pad wear.

*[DR22100( ALL)11/89] Hydraulic Power Brakes

*[DR22200(BEF )08/94] The hydraulic brake system is made up of twoindependent hydraulic circuits. One hydrauliccircuit supplies fluid to the front disc brakes andthe other hydraulic circuit supplies fluid to therear drum brakes. These two circuits aresupplied by a common hydraulic brake fluidreservoir, with a fluid level sensor.

*[DR22300( ALL)11/89] The brake light in the instrument cluster willlight for low brake fluid in the common brakefluid reservoir.

*[DR22400( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

An increase in pedal travel will result inreduced braking capability. The brakesystem should be checked immediately.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 208: 1996 econoline

208

[DR22430( E M)04/95] Hydraulic Brake Booster System(Hydro Boost)

[DR22460( E M)04/95] The Hydro Boost system receives its source ofpower from the power steering system pump.

% [DR22550( E )03/93] Rear Anti-lock Brakes (If equipped)

*[DR22750( E )10/94] Your vehicle may be equipped with a RearAnti-lock Brake System. This system prevents atleast one and often both rear wheels fromcompletely locking up when the brakes areapplied in a panic stop, for example.

*[DR22800( EF )07/94] Even with the Anti-lock Brake System, youshould be careful when braking. Front brakelock up on any surface, even on smoothpavement causes loss of steering control. Heavybraking on roads with loose surfaces such assnow or gravel, or severe pavement irregularitiescould also cause you to lose steering control ofyour vehicle.

*[DR22900( EF )05/95] RWARNING

If the anti-lock brake system warninglight remains on or comes on whiledriving, have the braking system checkedby a qualified service technician as soonas possible.

*[DR22902( EF )06/95] NOTE: If a fault occurs in the anti-locksystem, and the brake warning light isnot lit, the anti-lock system is disabledbut normal brake function remainsoperational.

[DR22908( E )03/93] Anti-lock Brake System (If equipped)

*[DR22912( E )08/94] Your vehicle may be equipped with a FourWheel Anti-lock Braking System (4WABS). The4WABS helps the driver to maintain vehiclecontrol by preventing wheel lockup during hardbraking.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 209: 1996 econoline

209

*[DR22915(BE )03/94] The 4WABS operates with a computer that isable to optimize vehicle control during brakingon varying tire and road conditions bymodulating the brake pressure at each of thefront wheels and the rear axle. This “pumpingaction” is similar to the driver “pumping” thebrakes but happens at a much faster rate.

*[DR22920(BE )05/95] RWARNING

The Anti-lock system does NOT assist thevehicle in stopping quickly on wet or icysurfaces. Heavy braking combined withpoor road conditions could cause you tolose steering control of your vehicle.

*[DR22925(BE )10/94] Using anti-lock brakes

*[DR22930(BE )05/94] The operation of a vehicle with 4WABS is notsimilar to the operation of normal brakes. Somedifferences exist and are listed below:

*[DR22935(BE )10/94] ❑Apply the brake steadily. In the event of apanic stop, do NOT “pump” the brakes.“Pumping” the brakes during an Anti-lockstop will diminish braking effectiveness.

%*[DR22940(BE )10/94] ❑During an Anti-lock stop, the driver willnotice a brake pedal pulsation and hear somenoise from the engine compartment. This isan indication that the 4WABS system isworking correctly and is normal.

*[DR22945(BE )05/95] RWARNING

The Anti-lock system does NOT decreasethe time necessary to apply the brakes.Always leave enough room between thevehicle in front of you and your vehicle.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 210: 1996 econoline

210

*[DR22950(BE )05/95] 4WABS driver warning light

[DR22955(BE )08/94] The 4WABS computer continuously monitors thesystem while driving for any electrical faults orsystem malfunctions. In addition, the 4WABScomputer performs an initial system check calledbulb proveout when the vehicle ignition isswitched on. During bulb proveout, the amber“ABS” light on the instrument cluster willmomentarily illuminate and then go out.

*[DR22960(BE )03/93] NOTE: After starting the vehicle and uponinitial drive-off, the driver may noticea single pulse of the brake pedal and anoise from the engine compartment.This is part of the initial system checkand is normal.

[DR22965(BE )08/94] Should a malfunction in the 4WABS systemoccur, the amber “ABS” light on the instrumentcluster will come on and stay on indicating thatthe antilock system has been shut down and thevehicle needs to be serviced. Normal braking isnot affected unless the red brake warning lightis also illuminated.

*[DR22970(BE )10/94] NOTE: It is important to note that when theABS Warning Light is illuminated theABS system is disabled. The vehiclemust be serviced immediately torestore the benefits of the Anti-locksystem.

*[DR22975(BE )10/94] NOTE: Mobile phones or radio transmittersnot installed by Ford Motor Companymay interfere with the Anti-lockSystem. Should the Anti-lock systemactivate unexpectedly or the Anti-lockWarning Light illuminate afterinstallation of such a unit, have theinstallation of the unit checked.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 211: 1996 econoline

211

*[DR23000(BE M)12/89] If Brakes Do Not Grip Well or Pedal is“Low”

%*[DR23200(BEF )11/89] If brakes do not grip well, it may indicate therear drum brakes need adjustment. To do this,drive the vehicle in reverse at 5 mph (8 km/h)on level, dry pavement. Stop the vehicle byfirmly applying the brakes. Repeat thisprocedure four or five times.

*[DR23250( ALL)11/89] If during normal operation the brake pedalseems “low”, it may indicate the need for abrake system inspection and/or service. Youshould have your brakes checked as soon aspossible.

*[DR23300( ALL)02/95] Occasional brake squeal during light to moderatestops does not affect the function of the brakesystem and is normal. However, if the squealbecomes annoyingly loud or increasessignificantly in frequency of occurrence, returnthe vehicle to your dealer for inspection.

*[DR23400(BEF )11/89] RWARNING

Modifications to the suspension springrates and/or vehicle ride height mayadversely affect vehicle stopping ability.

*[DR23500(BEF )07/92] If Brakes Pull

*[DR23600(BEF )05/95] ❑Check tire pressure.

*[DR23700(BEF )07/92] ❑Perform the self-adjustment proceduredescribed under If Brakes Do Not Grip Well orPedal is “Low.”

*[DR23800(BEF )05/95] If pull occurs during the first 500 miles(800 km), make 10 moderately fast stops from40 mph (65 km/h) and then perform theself-adjustment procedure above. It may benecessary to repeat this operation to properlyseat new brake linings and pads.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 212: 1996 econoline

212

%*[DR24000( ALL)01/93] Stopping Distances

*[DR24100( ALL)11/89] Stopping distances vary with different loads anddriving conditions. Use caution whenencountering new conditions and acquaintyourself with vehicle performance. Take fulladvantage of engine braking power whenslowing down.

%*[DR24200( ALL)01/95] Applying the Brakes

*[DR24300( ALL)05/95] Apply the brake pedal gradually. Use the“squeeze” technique — push on the brake pedalwith a steadily increasing force. This allows thewheels to continue to roll while you are slowingdown, which lets you steer properly.

*[DR24400( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Do not drive with your foot resting on thebrake pedal. This will increase yourvehicle’s stopping distance and may alsocause brake damage.

*[DR24500( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

If you are driving down a long or steephill, shift to a lower gear. Do not applyyour brakes continuously, as they mayoverheat and become less effective.

*[DR24600( ALL)03/95] Using the Parking Brake

*[DR24650(BEF )01/95] The parking brake should be used whenever youpark your vehicle.

[DR24830( E M)06/95] The parking brake pedal is suspended just belowthe bottom of the instrument panel to the left ofthe service brake. To set the parking brake whileparking your vehicle, press the brake pedal withyour right foot and hold it while you push theparking brake pedal down firmly with your leftfoot.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 213: 1996 econoline

213

[DR24940( E )03/91]

one third page art:0020836-A

Parking Brake

[DR24942( E )03/91] To release the parking brake, press the servicepedal with your right foot and hold it while youpush the parking brake pedal down firmly withyour left foot.

[DR24945( E )04/94]

one third page art:0020893-A

Parking brake (Commercial stripped chassis only)

[DR24946( E )04/94] To release the parking brake for CommericalStripped Chassis vehicles, press the service brakepedal with your right foot and pull the parkingbrake release lever.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 214: 1996 econoline

214

*[DR24960( E M)05/95] RWARNING

Always set the parking brake fully andmake sure the gearshift is latched in P(Park). Turn off the ignition whenever youleave your vehicle.

*[DR25050( ALL)01/93] RWARNING

If the parking brake is fully released, butthe Brake System light remains on, havethe brakes checked immediately. Theymay not be working properly.

*[DR25100(BEF )06/95] The parking brake is not designed to stop amoving vehicle, but you can use the parkingbrake to stop your vehicle in an emergency ifthe normal brakes fail. However, since theparking brake applies only the rear brakes, thestopping distance will increase greatly and thehandling of your vehicle will be adverselyaffected.

%*[DR25200( ALL)01/95] Driving Under Special Conditions

*[DR25250( ALL)01/95] Tips for Safe Driving

*[DR25301( ALL)05/95] As with any new vehicle, yours may drive andhandle differently from your previous vehicle.Use care until you become accustomed to itsvarious features and driving characteristics.

*[DR25350( ALL)03/95] Operate your vehicle within reasonable limits.Sudden acceleration, deceleration, turning, orcombinations of these maneuvers can cause avehicle to behave differently than anticipated.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 215: 1996 econoline

215

*[DR25501( ALL)02/95] Wheel Spin

*[DR25550( ALL)11/92] ❑Extreme acceleration can cause the rearwheels to spin, perhaps resulting in reducedsteering control.

*[DR25601( ALL)05/90] If the wheels spin during vehicle start-up, shiftto a different gear:

*[DR25800( ALL)03/93] ❑Electronic 4-Speed Automatic TransmissionE4OD: use 2 (Second)

*[DR26050( EF )05/90] ❑3-Speed Automatic (C6): use 2 (Second)

*[DR26301( ALL)01/89] Move forward slowly and evenly. If this doesnot work, try rocking the vehicle.

%*[DR26550( ALL)05/90] High Speed Driving

*[DR26575( ALL)06/95] Ford Motor Company recommends obeyingposted speed limits.

*[DR26601( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Driving too fast for conditions creates thepossibility of loss of vehicle control.Driving at very high speeds for extendedperiods of time may result in damage tovehicle components.

*[DR26625(BEF )12/91] Speed limiter

*[DR26652(BEF )05/95] All models are equipped with an ElectronicEngine Control (EEC) system which limits themaximum engine speed and thus road speed intop gear. Vehicle operation is normal since thecontrolled maximum speed is above postedhighway speeds in North America.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 216: 1996 econoline

216

%*[DR26701( ALL)01/95] Driving in Bad Weather

%*[DR26750( ALL)01/95] Slippery roads

*[DR26801( ALL)03/95] Drive cautiously on wet or snowy roads:

*[DR26850( ALL)03/95] ❑Do not quickly move the steering wheelunless necessary.

*[DR26901( ALL)01/95] ❑Drive slower than you normally would.

*[DR26951( ALL)01/95] ❑Give your vehicle more distance to stop.

*[DR27025(BEF )06/95] ❑To stop on ice, shift to N (Neutral) below10 mph (16 km/h) and gently pump brakes.(Except with 4WAL)

*[DR27050( ALL)02/93] ❑Consider using one of the lower gears.

*[DR27201( E M)06/95] RWARNING

To avoid skidding and losing control onslippery roads, do not downshift into 1(First) when you are moving faster than20 mph (32 km/h).

*[DR27401( E )01/93] RWARNING

The Anti-Lock Brake System may notprevent brake lock-up on extremelyslippery surfaces.

*[DR27450(BEF )03/95] Traction-Lok Rear Axle (If equipped)

*[DR27501(BEF )03/95] This axle provides added drive away traction onslippery surfaces, particularly when one or morewheels are on a surface with poor traction.

*[DR27550(BEF )03/93] Extended use of other than matching size tireson a Traction-Lok rear axle could result in apermanent reduction in effectiveness. This loss ofeffectiveness does not affect normal driving andshould not be noticeable to the driver.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 217: 1996 econoline

217

*[DR27601(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

To avoid injury, never run the enginewith one wheel off the ground, such aswhen changing a tire.

%*[DR27651( ALL)01/95] High water

*[DR27675( ALL)06/92] Never attempt to cross water that is fast flowingor of unknown depth.

*[DR27701( ALL)05/90] Do not drive through flooded areas unless youare sure that the water is below the bottom ofthe wheel hubs.

*[DR27750( ALL)04/94] If you must drive through high water, driveslowly. You may have limited traction or wetbrakes, so allow extra stopping distance becauseyour vehicle will not stop as quickly as usual.

*[DR27801( ALL)01/95] After you drive through the standing water,apply your brakes gently several times as yourvehicle moves slowly. This helps to dry thebrakes.

*[DR27820(BEF )06/95] NOTE: If the transmission and transfer case issubmerged in water, their fluids shouldbe checked and changed, if necessary.

*[DR27825( ALL)03/93] NOTE: All rear axle lube quantities must bereplaced every 100,000 miles(160,000 km) or if the axle has beensubmerged in water. Otherwise, thelube should not be checked or changedunless a leak is suspected or repairrequired.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 218: 1996 econoline

218

*[DR27850( ALL)11/89] Rocking the vehicle

*[DR27950( ALL)05/95] If your vehicle gets stuck (for example, in mudor snow), you may rock it out of the spot. Shiftin a steady rhythm between forward and reversegears. Allow the transmission to fully engage,then press lightly on the accelerator. Do not rockthe vehicle for more than a few minutes. Thismay overheat the engine and transmission,causing damage to both. In addition, othervehicle systems and components may also bedamaged.

*[DR27975( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph(55 km/h). The tires may fail and injure apassenger or bystander.

*[DR28050(BEF )03/95] Driving With a Heavy Load

*[DR28101(BEF )01/95] There are limits to the amount of weight yourvehicle can carry or tow. The total weight ofyour vehicle, plus the weight of the passengersand cargo, should never be more than the GrossVehicle Weight Rating (GVWR). Also, the weightthat your vehicle carries over the front axle andrear axle should never be more than the GrossAxle Weight Rating (GAWR) for the respectiveaxle.

*[DR28150(BEF )01/95] The weight limits of your vehicle’s tires affectthe GVWR or GAWR limitations. Usage ofreplacement tires with higher weight limit thanoriginals does not increase GVWR or GAWR.Usage of lower capacity replacement tires maylower GVWR and GAWR limitations.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 219: 1996 econoline

219

*[DR28201(BEF )02/95] RWARNING

If the GVWR or the GAWR specified onthe Safety Compliance Certification Labelis exceeded, your vehicle may be damagedor you may lose control and injuresomeone.

*[DR28750( ALL)01/93] Vehicle/Trailer Loads

*[DR28801( ALL)06/92] All vehicles may tow a Class I trailer providedthe Gross Combined Weight (GCW) is less thanor equal to the GVWR shown on the SafetyCompliance Certification Label. For heaviertrailer applications, refer to the towinginformation found later in this chapter.

*[DR28950(BEF )02/95] Trailer Towing (may require trailer towoption package)

*[DR29001( ALL)03/91] Towing a trailer puts additional loads on yourvehicle’s engine, transmission, axle, brakes, tiresand suspension. For your safety and for thegood of your vehicle, use the right equipmentfor the type of trailer you tow.

*[DR29025( ALL)09/92] Your trailer towing capability will vary based onthe standard and optional equipment on yourvehicle. Refer to the following VehicleLoading/Towing Information and the TrailerTowing Tables to determine the specific towingcapability of your vehicle.

*[DR29050( ALL)02/92] ❑Stay within the load limits when you tow.

*[DR29101( ALL)01/95] ❑Carefully and thoroughly prepare yourvehicle for towing, making sure to use theright equipment and to attach it properly.(See Preparing to Tow in this chapter.)

*[DR29151( ALL)01/95] ❑Use extra caution when driving your vehiclewhile you tow. (See Driving while you tow inthis chapter.)

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 220: 1996 econoline

220

*[DR29201( ALL)01/95] ❑Service your vehicle more frequently if youtow a trailer. (See Servicing your vehicle if youtow in this chapter.)

*[DR29350( ALL)05/94] Do not tow a trailer until your vehicle has beendriven at least 500 miles (800 km).

%*[DR29401( ALL)06/92] Vehicle Loading/TowingInformation

*[DR29450(BEF )03/91] Your vehicle’s load capacity is designated byweight, not volume, so you cannot necessarilyuse all available space with large or heavy loads.Maximum safe vehicle weights as well as tire,rim sizes and inflation pressures are specified foryour vehicle at the assembly plant on the SafetyCompliance Certification Label. The CertificationLabel is located on the left front door lock facingor the door latch post pillar.

*[DR29501( ALL)12/91] Trucks, unlike passenger cars, are basicallycustom vehicles designed to carry a load. Mostowners start with a base vehicle and addproduction and dealer installed and/oraftermarket components to suit their tastes andpurposes. Even trucks that are purchased forpersonal transportation only are likely to haveconsiderable optional equipment, such as stepbumpers and light bars, for example.

*[DR29525( ALL)06/95] RWARNING

Passengers should not be allowed to ridein the cargo area. Persons not riding in aseat with a fastened seat belt are muchmore likely to suffer serious injury in acollision. Cargo should always be securedto prevent it from shifting and causingdamage to the vehicle or harm topassengers.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 221: 1996 econoline

221

*[DR29551( ALL)03/91] Each additional item of equipment affects howmuch cargo a vehicle can carry. If a vehicle isoverloaded, performance will suffer and serviceconcerns may arise.

*[DR29601(BEF )04/95] The following is a typical example of a SafetyCompliance Certification Label and anexplanation of how this information should beused:

[DR29801( E )12/91]

half page art:0020151-E

Safety Compliance Certification Label

*[DR29950(BEF )06/92] Do not use the sample numbers on the SafetyCompliance Certification Label shown. Use theactual numbers from your vehicle certificationlabel.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 222: 1996 econoline

222

*[DR30001( ALL)06/92] Understanding Loading/TowingInformation

*[DR30050( ALL)03/94] The following terms are used to describe theability to carry or tow a load:

*[DR30101( ALL)01/93] ❑Base Curb Weight

*[DR30150( ALL)01/93] ❑Payload

*[DR30200( ALL)01/93] ❑GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)

*[DR30250( ALL)01/93] ❑GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)

*[DR30301( ALL)01/93] ❑GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)

*[DR30310( ALL)06/92] ❑GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)

*[DR30320( ALL)06/92] ❑Maximum Trailer Weight Rating

*[DR30330( ALL)06/92] ❑Maximum Trailer Weight

*[DR30340( ALL)06/92] ❑Trailer Weight Range

*[DR30351( ALL)03/91] Base Curb Weight

*[DR30401( ALL)03/94] The Base Curb Weight is the weight of thevehicle including fuel, coolants, lubricants,emergency tools, spare wheel and tire. It alsoincludes any equipment that is standard on thatmodel. It does not include passengers, cargo oroptional equipment installed by factory, dealer,aftermarket supplier or customer.

*[DR30451( ALL)03/91] Payload

*[DR30501( ALL)03/91] Payload is the combined, maximum allowableweight of cargo, occupants and optionalequipment that the truck is designed to carry. Itis Gross Vehicle Weight Rating minus the basecurb weight.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 223: 1996 econoline

223

*[DR30550( ALL)03/91] Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW)

*[DR30601( ALL)05/95] If you add base curb weight and the weight of aload (including passengers, cargo and optionalequipment) being carried at a particular time,you get the Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW).

*[DR30650( ALL)10/94] It is important to remember that GVW is not alimit or a specification. If an owner loads up avehicle and weighs it, that’s the GVW at thatmoment. If the owner piles on more of a loadand weighs it again, that becomes theGVW...until such time as the vehicle is unloaded.

%*[DR30701( ALL)03/91] Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)

*[DR30750( ALL)10/94] To avoid overloading a vehicle, the ownershould observe the manufacturer’s specifiedGross Vehicle Weight Rating. The GVWR is themaximum total weight of base vehicle,passengers, optional components and cargo thata particular vehicle was designed to carry.

%*[DR30801( ALL)01/93] Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)

*[DR30850( ALL)03/91] We have all seen a car or a truck that is loadeddown in the rear and riding high in the front.This is a dangerous condition that usually meansthat the rear suspension components are undersevere strain and that vehicle handling isimpaired. There is more to carrying a load thanjust payload or GVWR.

*[DR30901( ALL)03/91] Your Safety Compliance Certification Label notonly gives the GVWR, it also gives the GrossAxle Weight Rating (GAWR) which is thecarrying capacity for each axle system. Fortrucks, the rear axle will be designed to carrymore weight than the front.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 224: 1996 econoline

224

*[DR30950( ALL)06/92] The rating is based on the carrying capacity ofthe lowest rated axle and suspension componentas well as other factors. This is why it’s soimportant to observe vehicle loading ratings.Overloading a vehicle punishes components andcan lead to shortened service life or outrightfailure.

*[DR31001( ALL)06/92] The capacity of the tires is included as part ofthe axle and suspension system, which is to beconsidered when determining the lowest ratedcomponent. Tires are rated to carry a specificmaximum load at a specific maximum tirepressure.

*[DR31050( ALL)06/92] Passenger car type tires when installed on lighttrucks and multipurpose passenger vehicles arerated at 10% lower load carrying capacity due tothe differences in vehicle usages.

*[DR31101(BEF )05/95] The vehicle must not be loaded to both the frontand rear GAWR because the GVWR will beexceeded. The GAWR of the front and rear axlesexceeds the GVWR when added together toallow flexibility in fore and aft loading of cargo.

*[DR31110( ALL)06/92] With the tires inflated to the specified pressurethe total weight of your vehicle must not exceedthe GVWR and GAWR specified on the SafetyCompliance Certification Label. This includes fullfuel tank(s), vehicle equipment, and occupants aswell as the cargo load.

*[DR31120( ALL)06/92] GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)

*[DR31130( ALL)06/92] GCWR is the maximum combined weight of thetowing vehicle (including passengers and cargo)and the loaded trailer. The GCWR is specifiedby the manufacturer to indicate the combinedmaximum loaded weight that the vehicle isdesigned to tow.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 225: 1996 econoline

225

*[DR31140( ALL)06/92] Maximum Trailer Weight Rating

*[DR31150( ALL)05/95] The maximum trailer weight rating is themaximum weight of a trailer the vehicle ispermitted to tow. It is specified by themanufacturer and is determined by subtractingthe vehicle curb weight for eachengine/transmission combination, any requiredoption weight for trailer towing and the weightof the driver from the GCWR for the towingvehicle.

*[DR31160( ALL)06/92] Maximum Trailer Weight

*[DR31170( ALL)05/95] The maximum trailer weight is the maximumweight of a trailer the loaded vehicle ispermitted to tow. It is determined by subtractingthe weight of the loaded towingvehicle (including passengers and cargo) fromthe GCWR for the towing vehicle.

*[DR31180( ALL)06/92] Trailer Weight Range

*[DR31190( ALL)06/92] The trailer weight range is a specified range byweight, which the trailer must fall within,ranging from zero to the maximum trailerweight rating.

*[DR31301( ALL)03/91] Calculating The Load

*[DR31350( ALL)03/91] To know how much weight your vehicle cancarry:

*[DR31401( ALL)12/91] ❑Obtain ratings from your Safety ComplianceCertification Label, and the Trailer towingspecifications in the owner guide (refer to theIndex)

*[DR31450( ALL)09/93] — Refer to the following sample illustrationto locate the various ratings on yourSafety Compliance Certification Label.

*[DR31501( ALL)03/91] — If you do not plan on pulling a trailer, donot include these ratings into yourcalculations.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 226: 1996 econoline

226

*[DR31550( ALL)03/91] ❑Weigh your vehicle as you customarilyoperate the vehicle without cargo.

*[DR31601( ALL)03/91] ❑Subtract the total weight of passengers, driverand optional equipment added by the factory,dealer or aftermarket supplier to determinehow much cargo weight you can carry.

[DR31660( E )03/94]

half page art:0021097-A

Sample label

*[DR31702( ALL)03/91] If you suspect that your payload is excessive,have your vehicle weighed at a highway weighstation or appropriate commercial facility. Weighthe total vehicle and trailer (if applicable), thenseparately weigh the vehicle at the front andrear wheels. And finally, weigh the trailerseparately if applicable.

*[DR31751( ALL)03/91] Use this chart to perform your calculations.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 227: 1996 econoline

227

[DR31805( E )02/95]

twenty-six pica chart:0021098-B

*[DR31851( ALL)03/91] NOTE: The Truck Safety ComplianceCertification Label has two weightrelated entries that sometimes causeconfusion.

*[DR31901( ALL)06/95] Front Axle Reserve Capacity in Pounds (kgs): Onthe sample label, this value is given as 83pounds (38 kgs). Does this mean that you arelimited to adding only 83 pounds (38 kgs) ofaccessories to the front end capacity? Notexactly. This says that you can load 83 pounds(38 kgs) of options on the front axle, add 150

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 228: 1996 econoline

228

pound (68 kgs) passengers to all seatingpositions, and add evenly distributed cargo inthe box without exceeding the GAWR F.

*[DR31950( ALL)06/92] It is possible to hang heavier equipment on thefront as long as the vehicle owner/operatorcompensates. This can be accomplished, ifnecessary, by carrying fewer passengers, lesscargo or positioning cargo more toward the rear,which has the effect of reducing the load on thefront. Keep in mind that the GAWR F, GAWRR, nor the GVWR should ever be exceeded.

*[DR32001( ALL)06/95] Total Accessory Reserve Capacity in Pounds(kgs): On the sample label this value is given as112 pounds (51 kgs). This is a number that isrelated to government crash test standards, andonly indirectly reflects on the amount ofaccessory weight that can be carried.

*[DR32050( ALL)06/94] In the case of both these numbers (83 and 112pounds) (38 and 51 kgs), the important thing toremember is that for safe operation, anowner/operator should calculate the amount andthe distribution of all weights (passengers,accessory equipment and cargo). These combinedweights should fall below the vehicle’s GVWRand GAWR.

*[DR32201( ALL)01/93] Trailers

*[DR32251( ALL)10/94] Towing a trailer safely means having the properweight on the tongue (usually 10% of the trailerweight). Load-equalizing hitches on large rigsmay transfer weight to each of the vehicle’saxles. This weight must be included in capacitycalculations when determining if the vehicle isloaded within safe limits.

*[DR32301( ALL)01/95] If your vehicle exceeds the GVWR, remove cargofrom your vehicle accordingly. If your vehicleexceeds the GAWR for either axle, shift the loador remove cargo accordingly.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 229: 1996 econoline

229

*[DR32350( ALL)02/95] RWARNING

If the GVWR or the GAWR specified onthe Safety Compliance Certification Labelis exceeded, your vehicle may be damagedor you may lose control and injuresomeone.

*[DR32401( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Towing trailers beyond the maximumrecommended gross trailer weight couldresult in engine damage, transmission/axledamage, structural damage, loss of control,and personal injury.

*[DR32450( ALL)05/95] Use the Safety Compliance Certification Label tofind the axle code number and the engine typefor your vehicle.

*[DR32500( ALL)03/91] Use the appropriate Maximum Gross CombinedWeight Rating (GCWR) chart to find theMaximum GCWR for your type engine and rearaxle ratio.

*[DR32551( ALL)03/91] Subtract your Loaded Vehicle Weight from theMaximum GCWR found in the chart. This is themaximum trailer weight your vehicle can towand must fall below the maximum shown underTrailer Weight on the chart.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 230: 1996 econoline

230

[DR34300( E )04/95]

thirty-four pica chart:0020165-K

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 231: 1996 econoline

231

[DR34325( E )02/95]

eighteen pica chart:0020925-E

[DR34350( E )02/89]

fourteen pica chart:0020472-A

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 232: 1996 econoline

232

*[DR34480( E )06/94] Automatic Transmissions

[DR34500( E )05/95]

thirty-four pica chart:0020167-K

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 233: 1996 econoline

233

[DR34550( E )05/95]

thirty-four pica chart:0020498-L

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 234: 1996 econoline

234

[DR34600( E )05/95]

thirty-four pica chart:0020168-H

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 235: 1996 econoline

235

[DR34630( E )04/95]

twenty-two pica chart:0020941-D

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 236: 1996 econoline

236

[DR34660( E )04/95]

thirty-two pica chart:0020942-D

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 237: 1996 econoline

237

*[DR35500(BEF )02/91] Required equipment

*[DR35700(BEF )01/89] ❑Super Cooling is required with trailers over2,000 lb (907 kg).

*[DR35800(BEF )06/92] ❑Super Cooling and Handling/SuspensionPackage or trailer towing package is requiredwith trailers over 3,500 lb (1587 kg).

*[DR36500( ALL)01/95] Preparing to Tow

*[DR36550( ALL)01/95] For your safety and for the good of yourvehicle, use the right equipment for the type oftrailer you tow. Also, make sure that all towingequipment is properly attached to your vehicle.If you are not certain that you are using theright equipment in the proper manner, see yourFord or Lincoln-Mercury dealer.

%*[DR36600( ALL)01/93] Hitches

*[DR36650( E M)01/95] For towing trailers up to 2,000 lb (907 kg), use aweight carrying hitch and ball which uniformlydistributes the trailer tongue loads through theunderbody structure. Use a frame-mountedweight distributing hitch for trailers over 2,000lb (907 kg).

[DR36900( E M)12/91] Do not use single clamp bumper hitches orhitches which attach to the axle. Provisions formulti-clamp type temporary bumper hitch havebeen provided (Class I, max. loading), if installedproperly. Follow towing instructions of areputable rental agency.

*[DR37000( ALL)12/92] Whenever a trailer hitch and hardware areremoved, make sure all mounting holes in theunderbody are properly sealed to preventnoxious gases or water from entering.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 238: 1996 econoline

238

[DR37100(BE )03/93] Trailer Tow/Step bumper

[DR37225( E )06/93] The step bumper has a built-in hitch and onlyrequires a ball with a one inch shank diameter.The step bumper has a limited Class IIIcapability (5000 lb/2270 kg) trailer weight and500 lb/227 kg tongue weight.

*[DR37800( ALL)11/89] Safety Chains

*[DR37900( ALL)12/92] Always use safety chains between your vehicleand trailer. Cross chains under the trailer tongueand allow slack for turning corners. Connectsafety chains to the vehicle frame or hookretainers. Never attach chains to the bumper.

[DR37935( E )03/93] Located near the step bumper hitch ball positionare two holes in the hitch plate for a Class IIItrailer (max). These holes may be used for safetychain attachment when towing with a stepbumper. Always use safety chains when towing.Safety chains are used to retain connectionbetween the towing and towed vehicle in theevent of separation of the trailer coupling orball. Cross the chains under the trailer tongueand allow slack for turning corners. Connect thechain to the hitch plate using a positivecoupling, such as “Quick Links”, with a strengthrating of at least that of the safety chain rating.

*[DR38000( ALL)01/93] Trailer Brakes

*[DR38100( ALL)03/95] Separate trailer brakes are required on mosttowed vehicles weighing over 1,500 lb (680 kg).

*[DR38200( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Do not connect a trailer’s hydraulic brakesystem directly to your vehicle’s brakesystem. Your vehicle may not haveenough braking power and your chancesof having a collision greatly increase.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 239: 1996 econoline

239

[DR38300( ALL)06/95] Trailer lamps

*[DR38400( ALL)11/89] Make sure your trailer lamps conform to Federaland local regulations.

*[DR38425(BEF )03/91] Class I and Class II Trailer Tow electrical wiringprovides two circuits (right hand and left hand)to operate trailer stop/turn tail lamps. Eachstop/turn circuit will operate one combinationstop/turn light bulb (#1157, 3157, 2357, or 3357)on the trailer. Never add more than one trailerlight bulb to one circuit.

*[DR38450( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Always replace a fuse with one that hasthe specified amperage rating. Using afuse with a higher amperage rating cancause severe wire damage and could starta fire.

[DR38500( ALL)06/95] Driving While You Tow

*[DR38520( ALL)05/95] Be especially careful when driving while youtow a trailer. Never drive faster than 45 mph(70 km/h) when you tow in hilly country onhot days. Also, anticipate stops so that you canbrake gradually.

%*[DR38540( ALL)01/95] If you use the speed control while you aretowing on very long, steep grades, the speedcontrol may shut off.

*[DR38700(BEF )06/95] If your vehicle is equipped with an Electronic4-Speed Automatic (E4OD or 4R70W)transmission, operate in Overdrive. Refer to theautomatic transmission operation earlier in thischapter.

*[DR38800( ALL)06/95] When descending a steep grade with a trailer,operate in Drive rather than Overdrive. Ifadditional braking is needed, shift the automatictransmission gearshift into 2 (Second) gear or 1(Low).

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 240: 1996 econoline

240

*[DR38925( ALL)05/95] Servicing your vehicle if you tow

*[DR38950( ALL)08/93] If you tow a trailer for a long distance, yourvehicle will need to be serviced more frequentlythan usual. Refer to the Maintenance Schedule andRecord booklet for additional information.

*[DR39000( ALL)01/93] Trailer towing tips

*[DR39100( ALL)11/89] Before starting on a trip, practice turning,stopping and backing in an area away fromheavy traffic. Get to know the “feel” of thevehicle/trailer combination.

*[DR39200( ALL)05/90] Practice backing up. Back up very slowly, withsomeone outside at the rear of your trailer toguide you. Place your hand at the bottom of thesteering wheel and move it in the direction youwant the rear of the trailer to swing. Slightmovement of the steering wheel results in amuch larger movement of the rear of the trailer.

*[DR39300( ALL)11/89] Allow more room for stopping with a trailerattached. Trailer brakes should be applied first,whether manually or automatically controlled,when approaching a stop.

*[DR39400( ALL)11/89] For a good handling truck-trailer combination,the trailer tongue load should be approximately10-15% of the loaded trailer weight.

*[DR39500( ALL)05/95] Make a thorough check of your equipmentbefore starting out on the road. After you havetraveled about 50 miles (80 km) stop in aprotected area and double-check your hitch andelectrical connections. Also check trailer wheellug nuts for tightness.

*[DR39600( ALL)11/89] When turning, drive slightly beyond the normalturning point so the trailer wheels will clearcurbs or other obstructions.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 241: 1996 econoline

241

[DR39700( E M)06/95] When stopped in traffic for long periods of timein hot weather, place the gearshift selector leverin P (Park) to increase the engine idle speed.This aids in engine cooling and air conditionerefficiency. If the engine overheats, move theFunction Selector Lever to VENT to stop thecompressor and increase the engine speed for ashort time.

*[DR39900( ALL)05/90] Vehicles with trailers should not be parked on agrade. However, if you must park on a grade,place wheel chocks under the trailer’s wheels asfollows:

*[DR40000( ALL)05/95] ❑Apply the brake pedal and hold.

*[DR40100( ALL)11/89] ❑Have another person place the wheel chocksunder the trailer wheels.

*[DR40200( ALL)11/89] ❑With the chocks in place, release the footservice brakes, making sure the chocks areholding.

*[DR40350( E M)03/91] ❑Apply the parking brake by pressing theservice brake pedal down firmly with yourright foot while applying the parking brakepedal with your left foot.

*[DR40575( E M)06/95] ❑Shift the gearshift lever into P (Park).

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 242: 1996 econoline

242

*[DR40600( ALL)01/93] To start, after being parked on a grade:

*[DR40700( ALL)11/89] ❑Apply the foot service brakes and hold

*[DR40800( ALL)11/89] ❑Start the engine

*[DR40900( ALL)11/89] ❑Shift transmission into gear and release theparking brake

*[DR41000( ALL)11/89] ❑Release the foot service brakes and move thevehicle uphill to free the wheel chocks

*[DR41100( ALL)05/95] ❑Apply the brake pedal and hold whileanother person retrieves the chocks.

*[DR41550( EF )03/94] NOTE: Diesel equipped vehicles notrecommended for snow plowing.

File:10ltdre.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:44:07 1996

Page 243: 1996 econoline

243

Roadside Emergencies

*[RE00400( ALL)03/95] Jump-Starting Your Vehicle

*[RE00450( EF )04/94] NOTE: Read the 7.3L Diesel Engine Owner’sGuide Supplement for information onjump-starting your diesel-powered lighttruck.

*[RE00500( ALL)01/95] Your vehicle’s battery may die if you leave thelights on or any electrical equipment on afteryou turn the engine off. If this happens, youmay be able to jump-start from a booster batteryto start your vehicle.

*[RE00600( ALL)02/95] RWARNING

The gases around the battery can explodeif exposed to flames, sparks, or litcigarettes. An explosion could result ininjury or vehicle damage.

*[RE00700( ALL)02/95] RWARNING

To protect yourself when charging abattery, always shield your face and eyes.Make sure that you can breathe fresh air.

%*[RE00800( ALL)06/95] RWARNING

Applying too much pressure on the endswhen lifting a battery could cause acid tospill. Lift the battery with a carrier orwith your hands on the opposite corners.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 244: 1996 econoline

244

%*[RE00900( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Batteries contain sulfuric acid which burnsskin, eyes, and clothing.

*[RE00925( ALL)06/95] If the acid touches someone’s skin, eyes, orclothing, immediately flush the area with waterfor at least 15 minutes. If someone swallows theacid, have him or her drink lots of milk or waterfirst, then Milk of Magnesia, a beaten egg, orvegetable oil. Call a doctor immediately.

*[RE00950(BEF )06/95] RWARNING

Do not push-start your vehicle. You coulddamage the catalytic converter. For furtherinformation, see Jumper Cables in theIndex.

*[RE01000( ALL)03/95] To avoid damaging your vehicle or your battery,and to avoid injury to yourself, follow thesedirections for preparing your vehicle tojump-start and connecting the jumper cables inthe order they are given. If in doubt, call forroad service.

*[RE01100( ALL)03/95] Preparing Your Vehicle

*[RE01200( ALL)03/95] 1. Your vehicle has a 12-volt starting system, soyou need to use a 12-volt jumper system.You will damage your starting motor,ignition system, and other electrical parts ifyou connect them to a 24-volt power supply(either two 12-volt batteries in series or a24-volt generator set).

*[RE01300( ALL)03/95] 2. Do not disconnect the battery of the disabledvehicle. You could damage the vehicle’selectrical system.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 245: 1996 econoline

245

*[RE01400( ALL)04/95] 3. Park the booster vehicle close to the hood ofthe disabled vehicle. Make sure the vehiclesdo not touch each other. Set the parkingbrake on both vehicles and stay clear of theengine cooling fan and other moving parts.

*[RE01500( ALL)03/95] 4. Check all battery terminals and remove anyexcessive corrosion before you attach thejumper cables.

*[RE01600( ALL)02/95] 5. Turn on the heater fan in both vehicles.Turning on the fan helps protect theelectrical system from voltage surges. Turnoff all other switches and lights in bothvehicles to prevent possible damage to eithervehicle’s electrical systems.

%*[RE01700( ALL)05/95] Connecting the jumper cables

*[RE01800( ALL)03/95] 1. Connect one end of the first jumper cable tothe positive (+) terminal of the dischargedbattery. (You can connect either jumper cableto the positive (+) terminal, as long as youuse the same cable for both positiveterminals.) Most jumper cables have a redcable and a black cable. The red cable isgenerally used for the positive terminals andthe black for the negative ones.

[RE01850( E )05/91] NOTE: DO NOT jump-start your auxilliarybattery.

*[RE01900( ALL)04/95] 2. Connect the other end of the first cable tothe positive (+) terminal of the boosterbattery.

*[RE02000( ALL)05/95] 3. Connect one end of the second cable to thenegative (-) terminal of the booster battery— NOT to the discharged battery.

*[RE02100( ALL)04/95] 4. Connect the other end of the second cable toa good metallic surface on the engine orframe of the disabled vehicle.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 246: 1996 econoline

246

*[RE02200( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Do not connect the end of the secondcable to the negative (-) terminal of thebattery to be jumped. A spark may causean explosion of the gases that surroundthe battery.

*[RE02300( ALL)06/93]

one third page art:0020262-C

Attaching jumper cables

*[RE02500( ALL)03/95] Jump-Starting

*[RE02600( ALL)03/95] 1. Make sure that the jumper cables are not inthe way of moving engine parts, then startthe booster vehicle. Run the engine at amoderate speed.

*[RE02700( ALL)03/95] 2. Let the discharged battery charge for a fewminutes and then start the disabled vehicle.It may take a couple of tries before thevehicle starts. If the vehicle does not startafter several attempts, there may be adifferent problem.

*[RE02800( ALL)03/95] 3. When both vehicles are running, let themidle for a few minutes to charge thedischarged battery.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 247: 1996 econoline

247

*[RE02900( ALL)03/95] Removing jumper cables

*[RE03000( ALL)03/95] 1. Always remove the jumper cables in thereverse order. Remove the negative (S) endof the jumper cable from the metallic surfaceon the engine or frame of the disabledvehicle.

*[RE03100( ALL)06/95] 2. Remove the negative (S) cable from thebooster battery.

*[RE03200( ALL)06/95] 3. Remove the positive (+) cable from thebooster battery.

*[RE03400( ALL)05/95] 4. Remove the other end of the positive (+)cable from the discharged battery.

*[RE03500( ALL)04/95] After the vehicle is started, let it idle for a whileto let the engine “relearn” its idle conditions.Drive it around for a while with all electricalaccessories turned off to let the battery recharge.You may need to use a battery charger to fullyrecharge the battery.

*[RE03550( ALL)03/95] If you need to replace your battery, see Batteryin the Servicing Your Vehicle chapter.

*[RE03600( ALL)03/95] Changing a Tire

*[RE03700( ALL)01/95] If you get a flat tire while you are driving, donot apply the brake heavily. Instead, graduallydecrease the speed. Hold the steering wheelfirmly and slowly move to a safe place on theside of the road. Park on a level spot, turn offthe ignition, set the parking brake, and turn onthe hazard flashers.

%*[RE03800( ALL)03/95] The Conventional Spare Tire

*[RE03900(BEF )01/95] If you have the conventional spare tire, you canuse it as a spare or as a regular tire. This sparetire is identical to the other tires that come withyour vehicle, although the wheel may not match.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 248: 1996 econoline

248

*[RE04275(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

To avoid injury, never run the enginewith one wheel off the ground, such aswhen changing a tire.

*[RE04280(BEF )10/94] Extended use of other than matching size sparetires on a Traction-Lok axle could result in apermanent reduction in effectiveness. This loss ofeffectiveness does not affect normal driving andshould not be noticeable to the driver.

*[RE05100(BEF )03/95] Spare Tire Location

*[RE05250( E )06/94] The spare tire for your vehicle is stowed at therear under the frame (except cutaway andstripped chassis models).

*[RE05550( E )03/91] To remove the spare tire:

[RE05625( E )03/93] 1. Open both of the rear doors. Remove theaccess cover from the rubber strip foundbehind the left door. Insert tapered end oflug wrench or tip of jack handle through theaccess hole. Turn counterclockwise until thecable extends enough to allow the spare tireto be pulled rearward from under thevehicle.

*[RE05700( E )10/94] 2. Slide the spare tire to the rear and removethe retainer from the wheel.

*[RE05850( E )10/94] 3. To stow the cable/retainer with spareremoved, turn jack handle wrench clockwiseuntil slack is removed.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 249: 1996 econoline

249

[RE05975( E )02/95]

three fourths page art:0020839-C

The spare tire location and assembly

*[RE06050( E )03/91] To stow spare tire:

*[RE06150( E )10/94] 1. Insert the jack handle or lug nut wrench intothe actuator hole and turn counterclockwiseuntil the cable/retainer is extended forinsertion into the wheel.

*[RE06200( E )10/94] 2. Install the retainer through wheel centerwith valve stem facing up.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 250: 1996 econoline

250

*[RE06250( E )12/91] NOTE: Stow aluminum wheel and tire withvalve stem down.

*[RE06350( E )10/94] 3. Rotate the handle clockwise to secure tire.Continue until the lift mechanism “slips”.

*[RE06400( E )03/91] 4. Check for proper seating against underbodysupports and retighten if necessary.

*[RE15100(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Make sure the spare tire and jackingequipment are stowed and secured in theproper storage location.

*[RE15200( ALL)03/95] Preparing to Change the Tire

*[RE15250( ALL)12/91] NOTE: To lift your vehicle by other than thefront or rear jacking points, be sure touse only hoist adapters with a widecontact surface.

*[RE15325( E M)03/95] 1. Make sure that your vehicle will not moveor roll. Put the gearshift in P (Park). Set theparking brake and block the wheel that isdiagonally opposite the tire that you arechanging.

*[RE15377( E )06/95] When one of the back wheels is off the ground,the transmission alone will not prevent thevehicle from moving or slipping off the jack,even if the vehicle is in P (Park). To prevent thevehicle from moving when you change a tire, besure the parking brake is set, then block thewheel (both directions) that is diagonallyopposite (other side and end of the vehicle) tothe tire being changed.

[RE15430(E )10/95] RWARNING

If the vehicle slips off the jack, you orsomeone else coule be seriously injured.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 251: 1996 econoline

251

[RE15445(E )05/95] RWARNING

On E-Super Duty vehicles, the parkingbrake is on the transmission. Therefore,the vehicle will not be prevented frommoving when a rear wheel is lifted, evenif the vehicle is in Park and the parkingbrake is applied. Be sure to block bothdirections of the wheel that is diagonallyopposite to the wheel that is being lifted.If the vehicle slips off the jack, someonecould be seriously injured.

*[RE15550(BEF )05/95] 2. Get out the spare tire and jack.

[RE16300( E )01/89] The jack, jack handle and lug nut wrench arestowed as shown below.

[RE16400( E )05/91]

one third page art:0020289-D

Jack handle and wrench stowage

*[RE16800(BEF )12/91] 3. Use the tapered end of the lug nut wrenchto unscrew wheel ornaments attached byretaining screws. Remove any wheel trim.Insert the tapered end of the lug nut wrenchbehind wheel covers or hubcaps and twistoff.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 252: 1996 econoline

252

*[RE16900(BEF )10/89] 4. Loosen the wheel nuts by pulling up on thehandle of the lug nut wrench about one-halfturn (counterclockwise). Do not remove thewheel lug nuts until you raise the tire off theground.

*[RE16950(BEF )05/95] Removing and Replacing the Tire

[RE17000( E )02/95] 1. Unfold the jack handle and lock into thejack. Use the jack handle to slide the jackunder the vehicle.

*[RE17175(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

To avoid injury, never run the enginewith one wheel off the ground, such aswhen changing a tire.

*[RE17200(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

To lessen the risk of personal injury, donot put any part of your body under thevehicle while changing a tire. Do not startthe engine when your vehicle is on thejack. The jack is only meant for changingthe tire.

[RE17300(BEF )06/95] 2. Positioning the jack

[RE18501( E )01/89] a. To raise a front or rear wheel, place thejack as shown in the followingillustrations.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 253: 1996 econoline

253

[RE18551(E )11/89]

one third page art:0020296-A

Jacking point (All models except E-Super Duty)

[RE18600(BE )11/89]

one third page art:0021527-A

Jacking point (E-Super Duty)

[RE18900( E )12/91]

one third page art:0020298-B

Instructions for jacking a wheel — All models

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 254: 1996 econoline

254

*[RE19100( E )08/91] b. Turn the jack handle clockwise until thewheel is completely off the ground.

*[RE21151(BEF )10/92]

one third page art:0020939-B

[RE21400(BEF )06/95] 3. Remove the lug nuts with the lug nutwrench.

[RE21500(BEF )06/95] 4. Replace the flat tire with the spare tire.

*[RE21600( EF )06/95] If your vehicle has dual rear wheels, there arelocating pins on the hubs and wheels withcorresponding holes. When you put the wheelback on, make sure the pins are lined up withthe proper holes.

[RE21800( EF )06/95] If your vehicle has single rear wheels, thread thelug nuts on the wheel studs with the beveledface toward the wheel. Use the lug nut wrenchto screw the lug nut snugly against the wheelbut do not tighten.

*[RE21900( EF )01/89] If your vehicle has dual rear wheels, thread thetwo-element swiveling lug nut on the wheelstuds with the flange face toward the wheel. Usethe lug nut wrench to screw the lug nut snuglyagainst the wheel but do not tighten.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 255: 1996 econoline

255

*[RE22000( EF )05/90]

quarter page art:0020310-A

Single rear wheel nut

*[RE22100( EFM)05/90]

quarter page art:0020311-A

Dual rear wheel nut

*[RE22200(BEF )01/95] 5. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack handlecounterclockwise.

[RE22300(BEF )06/95] 6. Remove the jack and fully tighten the lugnuts in the order shown in the followingillustration.

%*[RE22425( EF )05/90]

quarter page art:0020317-A

Lug nut tightening sequence

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 256: 1996 econoline

256

*[RE23400(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Use of wheels or lug nuts other thanoriginal equipment could cause damage tothe wheel or mounting system and allowthe wheels to come off while the vehicleis in motion.

[RE23500(BEF )06/95] 7. Replace any wheel covers, ornaments, or hubcaps that your vehicle has. Make sure thatthey are screwed or snapped into place.

[RE23615(BEF )06/95] 8. Put the tire, jack, and wrench away. (Makesure jack is securely fastened so it doesn’trattle when you drive.) The carrier isdesigned to hold the temporary spare whichcomes with your vehicle. The stowage of afull size tire in the spare tire carrier maydamage the tire or the vehicle. The flat fullsize tire should be stowed securely in thevehicle until it can be repaired.

[RE23700(BEF )06/95] 9. Unblock the wheels.

*[RE24100( EF )06/95] On vehicles equipped with dual rear wheelsretighten the wheel lug nuts to the specifiedtorque at 100 miles (160 km), and again at 500miles (800 km) of new vehicle operation and atthe intervals specified in the Maintenance Scheduleand Record booklet.

*[RE24200( ALL)10/89] Also retighten to the specified torque at 500miles (800 km) of operation after any wheelchange or any time the lug nuts are loosened.

*[RE24301( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Failure to retighten wheel lug nuts atmileages specified could allow wheels tocome off while the vehicle is in motion.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 257: 1996 econoline

257

% [RE24375( E )02/89]

ten pica chart:0020318-B

*[RE24397(BEF )02/95] If the Engine Cranks But DoesNot Start or Does Not Start Aftera Collision

*[RE24400(BEF )04/95] The Fuel Pump Shut-off Switch

*[RE24500(BEF )03/95] If the engine cranks but does not start or if youhave had a collision, the fuel pump shut-offswitch may have been triggered. The shut-offswitch is a device that stops the fuel pumpwhen your vehicle has been involved in asubstantial jolt.

*[RE24600(BEF )01/95] For information on how to check and reset thefuel pump shut-off switch, see Fuel pump shut-offswitch in the Index.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 258: 1996 econoline

258

*[RE24700( ALL)05/95] Towing Your Vehicle[RE24875( ALL)06/95] The recommended method to tow your

Econoline is with flatbed or wheel liftequipment. However, slingbelt towing isacceptable. On vehicles equipped with an airdam, the towbar will deform the rubber air dam.

*[RE27500(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Never use a tow bar that attaches to thebumper when you tow your vehicle. Thiscould damage the bumper and cause anaccident.

File:11ltree.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:42:44 1996

Page 259: 1996 econoline

259

Customer Assistance

*[HS00205( ALL)06/94] Roadside Assistance

*[HS00210( ALL)06/95] Ford Motor Company has set up a 24-hour,seven-day-a-week hotline with trained operatorsthat put you in touch with the help you need ifyou experience a problem with your vehicle.This complimentary service is provided to youthroughout your warranty period of 3 years or36,000 miles (60,000 km), whichever comes first.To purchase Roadside Assistance coveragesbeyond this period (available through Ford AutoClub in the United States or Ford andLincoln-Mercury dealers in Canada), contactyour Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer.

*[HS00215( ALL)06/94] Roadside Assistance will cover the following:

*[HS00220( ALL)06/94] ❑Mount your spare if you have a flat tire.

*[HS00225( ALL)06/94] ❑ Jump-start your battery if it is dead.

*[HS00230( ALL)06/94] ❑Unlock your vehicle if you are locked out.

*[HS00235( ALL)06/94] ❑Bring you fuel if you run out.

*[HS00240( ALL)06/94] ❑Tow your vehicle if you are stranded. Evennon-warranty related tows, like accidents orgetting stuck in mud or snow, are covered(some exclusions apply, such as impoundtowing and repossession).

File:12lthse.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:20 1996

Page 260: 1996 econoline

260

*[HS00245( ALL)06/94] How to use Roadside Assistance

*[HS00250( ALL)06/94] Your Roadside Assistance identification card canbe found in the Owner Guide portfolio in yourglove compartment. Complete the card and placeit in your wallet for quick reference.

*[HS00255( ALL)04/95] To receive roadside assistance in the UnitedStates call 1-800-241-FORD (in Canada call1-800-665-2006).

*[HS00260( ALL)04/95] Should you need to arrange for roadsideassistance yourself, Ford Motor Company willreimburse the reasonable cost. To obtaininformation about reimbursement call1-800-241-FORD (in Canada call 1-800-665-2006).

*[HS00300( ALL)01/95] If You Have a Service Problem

*[HS00400( ALL)01/95] Ford Motor Company has authorized Ford andLincoln-Mercury dealerships that can serviceyour vehicle for you. This chapter tells you howto get service or maintenance for your vehicle.

%*[HS00525( ALL)03/95] Service/Maintenance Concerns(U.S. or Canada)

*[HS00600(BEF )04/95] Ford recommends taking your vehicle to yourselling dealer who wants to ensure yourcontinued satisfaction. You may, however, takeyour vehicle to any authorized Ford orLincoln-Mercury dealer. In most cases, yourdealer will be able to resolve your concern.

*[HS00700( ALL)03/95] If you are not satisfied with the service youreceived from your dealership’s servicedepartment, talk to the service manager at thedealership. If you still are not satisfied, talk tothe owner or general manager of the dealership.In most cases, you will have your concernresolved at this level.

File:12lthse.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:20 1996

Page 261: 1996 econoline

261

*[HS01000( ALL)03/95] If you are away from home when your vehicleneeds to be serviced, or if you need more helpthan the dealer gave you, contact the FordCustomer Assistance Center to find anauthorized dealership that may be able to help.

*[HS01010( ALL)04/95] In the U.S., contact:

%*[HS01025( ALL)03/95]

one inch art:0060100-E

*[HS01050( ALL)03/95] If you live in Canada and have any questions orconcerns that the dealership cannot answer,contact the Customer Assistance Centre.

%*[HS01075( ALL)04/95]

one inch art:0060101-C

*[HS01200( ALL)04/95] Please have the following information availablewhen contacting Ford Customer Assistance:

*[HS01300( ALL)04/95] ❑your telephone number (both business andhome)

*[HS01400( ALL)04/95] ❑ the name of the dealer and the city where thedealership is located

*[HS01500( ALL)03/95] ❑ the year and make of your vehicle

*[HS01550( ALL)03/95] ❑ the date purchased

*[HS01600( ALL)03/95] ❑ the current mileage on your vehicle

*[HS01700( ALL)03/95] ❑your Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)(listed on your owner card)

File:12lthse.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:20 1996

Page 262: 1996 econoline

262

*[HS02200( ALL)03/95] If you still have a service or product complaint,you may wish to contact the Dispute SettlementBoard (U.S. only) or the Canadian Motor VehicleArbitration Plan (CAMVAP) in Canada.

*[HS02300( ALL)02/95] The Dispute Settlement Board(U.S. Only)

*[HS02400( ALL)03/95] The Dispute Settlement Board is a voluntary,independent dispute-settlement programavailable free to owners or lessees of qualifyingFord Motor Company vehicles.

*[HS02500( ALL)01/95] The Dispute Settlement Board may not beavailable in all states. Ford Motor Companyreserves the right to change eligibilitylimitations, modify procedures and/or todiscontinue this process at any time withoutnotice and without incurring obligations.

*[HS02600( ALL)01/95] What Kind of Cases Does the BoardReview?

*[HS02700( ALL)03/95] The Board reviews all product performance andservice complaints on Ford, Mercury and LincolnCars and Ford and Mercury Light Trucks underwarranty that have not been resolved by adealer or Ford Motor Company.

*[HS02750( ALL)03/95] The Board does not review issues involving:

*[HS02800( ALL)01/95] ❑A non-Ford product

*[HS02900( ALL)01/95] ❑A non-Ford dealership

*[HS03100( ALL)01/95] ❑A vehicle sales transaction

*[HS03200( ALL)01/95] ❑A request for reimbursement of consequentialexpenses unless incidental to a service orproduct complaint being reviewed

*[HS03300( ALL)01/95] ❑ Items not covered by your warranty

*[HS03400( ALL)01/95] ❑Alleged liability claims

File:12lthse.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:20 1996

Page 263: 1996 econoline

263

*[HS03450( ALL)01/95] ❑Property damage where such damage issignificant when compared to the economicloss alleged under the warranty dispute

*[HS03500( ALL)01/95] ❑Cases currently in litigation

*[HS03600( ALL)01/95] ❑Vehicles not used primarily for personal,family, or household purposes

*[HS03650( ALL)01/95] NOTE: Complaints involving vehicles onwhich applicable express written newvehicle warranties have expired atreceipt of your application are noteligible. Eligibility may differaccording to state law. For example, seethe unique brochure for Californiapurchasers/lessees.

*[HS03700( ALL)04/95] How Does the Board Work?

*[HS03800( ALL)04/95] The Board has four members:

*[HS03900( ALL)04/95] ❑ three consumer representatives

*[HS04000( ALL)04/95] ❑a Ford or Lincoln-Mercury dealer

*[HS04200( ALL)04/95] Consumer candidates for Board membership arerecruited and trained by an independentconsulting firm. Dealers are chosen because oftheir business leadership qualities.

*[HS04300( ALL)04/95] If the involved vehicle is within 36 months and36,000 miles of the date of delivery (warrantystart date), you have a right to make an oralpresentation before the Board by indicating yourchoice on the application. Also, oralpresentations may be requested by the Board. Adecision is made by the Board by simplemajority vote.

File:12lthse.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:20 1996

Page 264: 1996 econoline

264

*[HS04350( ALL)04/95] Board members review all the materials relatedto each complaint and, based on the availableinformation, arrive at a fair and impartialdecision. Decisions are based on the writtenstatements and any oral presentations made byeach of the involved parties.

*[HS04400( ALL)04/95] Because the Board usually meets only once amonth, some cases will take longer than 30 daysto be reviewed. The Board will make everyeffort to resolve each case within 40 days after itreceives the customer application form.

*[HS04500( ALL)04/95] After your case has been reviewed, the Boardwill mail you its decision in writing. It will alsoprovide you with a form to indicate youracceptance or rejection of an award decision. Thedecisions of the Board are binding on the dealerand Ford, but customers may have other optionsavailable to them under state or federal law.

*[HS04600( ALL)04/95] The decisions of the Board, however, may beintroduced into evidence by any party insubsequent legal proceedings that may beinitiated.

*[HS04700( ALL)01/95] How Do You Contact the Board?

*[HS04800( ALL)04/95] Write to the Board at the following address torequest a brochure/application. You will be senta brochure and a one-page customer applicationform. The form should be completed and mailedto the same address.

*[HS04900( ALL)02/93]

one inch art:0060102-B

File:12lthse.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:20 1996

Page 265: 1996 econoline

265

*[HS05100( ALL)04/95] What is the Review Process?

*[HS05200( ALL)04/95] Your application will be reviewed and if it isdetermined to be eligible, you will receive anacknowledgment indicating the file numberassigned to your application and the local Boardaddress. At the same time, your dealer and FordMotor Company representative are asked tosubmit statements.

*[HS05300( ALL)04/95] To review your case properly, the Board needsthe following information:

*[HS05400( ALL)04/95] ❑ legible copies of all documents andmaintenance or repair orders that relate tothe case

*[HS05500( ALL)04/95] ❑ the year, make, model, and vehicleidentification number

*[HS05600( ALL)04/95] ❑ the date you bought your vehicle

*[HS05700( ALL)04/95] ❑ the date of repair and the mileage at the timeof repair

*[HS05800( ALL)04/95] ❑ the current mileage

*[HS05900( ALL)04/95] ❑ the name of the dealer who sold you thevehicle or who serviced your vehicle

*[HS06000( ALL)04/95] ❑a brief description of your unresolvedcomplaint

*[HS06100( ALL)05/95] ❑a brief summary of actions that were takenwith the dealer and Ford Motor Company

*[HS06200( ALL)05/95] ❑ the names (if known) of all people youcontacted at the dealership

*[HS06300( ALL)04/95] ❑a description of the action you want done toresolve your concern.

*[HS06305( ALL)06/95] Should your application NOT qualify for review,an explanation will be mailed to you.

File:12lthse.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:20 1996

Page 266: 1996 econoline

266

*[HS06310( ALL)04/95] Ford of Canada does not have a DisputeSettlement Board. If you have a problem thatcannot be resolved by an agreement among you,Ford of Canada, and the Ford dealer, contact theCanadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan(CAMVAP). In many areas of Canada, CAMVAPwill help resolve the problem and, if necessary,will arrange for the matter to be arbitrated.

*[HS06320( ALL)04/95] Reporting Safety Defects(U.S. Only)

*[HS06340( ALL)01/95] If you believe that your vehicle has a defectwhich could cause a crash or could cause injuryor death, you should immediately inform theNational Highway Traffic Safety Administration(NHTSA) in addition to notifying Ford MotorCompany.

*[HS06360( ALL)01/95] If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it mayopen an investigation, and if it finds that asafety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it mayorder a recall and remedy campaign. However,NHTSA cannot become involved in individualproblems between you, your dealer, or FordMotor Company.

*[HS06380( ALL)01/95] To contact NHTSA, you may either call the AutoSafety Hotline toll-free at 1-800-424-9393 (or366-0123 in the Washington, D.C. area) or writeto: NHTSA, U.S. Department of Transportation,400 Seventh Street, Washington D.C. 20590. Youcan also obtain other information about motorvehicle safety from the Hotline.

File:12lthse.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:20 1996

Page 267: 1996 econoline

267

*[HS06400( ALL)06/95] Getting Help Outside the U.S.and Canada

*[HS06500( ALL)06/95] Before you export your vehicle to a foreigncountry, contact the appropriate foreign embassyor consulate to make sure local regulations donot prevent you from registering your vehicle.Officials at the embassy can also help you decidewhether you should import your vehicle to thatcountry.

*[HS06600( ALL)06/95] Officials at the embassy or consulate can tell youwhere to get unleaded fuel. If you cannot getunleaded fuel or can get only fuel with ananti-knock index that is lower than your vehicleneeds, contact a district or owner relations officebefore you leave the U.S. or Canada.

*[HS06700( ALL)06/95] Use of leaded fuel in your vehicle without aproper conversion may damage the effectivenessof your emissions control system and may causeengine knocking or serious engine damage. FordMotor Company is not responsible for anydamage that is caused by use of improper fuel.

*[HS06800( ALL)06/95] You may also have difficulty importing yourvehicle back into the U.S. if you use leaded fuel.

*[HS06900( ALL)06/95] If your vehicle must be serviced while you aretraveling or living in Central or South America,the Caribbean, or the Middle East, contact thenearest Ford dealership. If the dealership cannothelp you, write to:

*[HS07000( ALL)06/95]

one inch art:0095024-A

File:12lthse.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:20 1996

Page 268: 1996 econoline

268

*[HS07100( ALL)06/95] If you are in other foreign countries, contact thenearest Ford dealership. If the dealership cannothelp you, they can direct you to the appropriateFord affiliate office.

*[HS07200( ALL)06/95] If you buy your vehicle in North America andthen relocate outside of the U.S. or Canada,register your Vehicle Identification Number andnew address with Ford Motor Company ExportOperations.

*[HS07700( ALL)05/95] Ford of Canada CustomerAssistance

*[HS07800( ALL)06/95] Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited

*[HS07850( ALL)03/95] If you live in Canada and have any questions orconcerns that the dealership cannot answer,contact the Customer Assistance Centre.

*[HS07950( ALL)03/95]

one inch art:0060101-C

File:12lthse.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:20 1996

Page 269: 1996 econoline

269

%*[HS08100( ALL)03/95] Mediation/Arbitration Program(Canada Only)

*[HS08200( ALL)03/95] In those cases where you continue to feel thatthe efforts by Ford and the dealer to resolve afactory-related vehicle service concern have beenunsatisfactory, Ford of Canada participates in animpartial third party mediation/arbitrationprogram administered by the Canadian MotorVehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP).

*[HS08300( ALL)05/95] The CAMVAP program is a straight-forward andrelatively speedy alternative to resolve adisagreement when all other efforts to produce asettlement have failed. This procedure is withoutcost to you and is designed to eliminate theneed for lengthy and expensive legalproceedings.

*[HS08400( ALL)05/95] In the CAMVAP program, impartial third-partyArbitrators conduct hearings at mutuallyconvenient times and places in an informalenvironment. These impartial Arbitrators reviewthe positions of the parties, make decisions and,where appropriate, render awards to resolvedisputes. CAMVAP decisions are fast, fair andfinal as the arbitrator’s award is binding on bothyou and Ford of Canada.

*[HS08450( ALL)05/95] CAMVAP services are available in all territoriesand provinces, except Quebec. For moreinformation, without charge or obligation, callyour CAMVAP Provincial Administrator directlyat 1-800-207-0685.

File:12lthse.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:20 1996

Page 270: 1996 econoline

271

Accessories

*[AC00400( ALL)03/95] Ford Accessories for Your Vehicle

*[AC00500( ALL)04/95] A wide selection of accessories is availablethrough your local authorized dealer. These fineaccessories have been engineered specifically tofulfill your automotive needs. They are customdesigned to complement the style andaerodynamic appearance of your Ford-builtvehicle. In addition, each accessory is made fromhigh quality materials and meets or exceedsFord’s rigid engineering and safety specifications.That is why Ford brand accessories arewarranted for up to 3 years or 36,000 miles(60,000 km), whichever comes first. See yourdealer for complete warranty information andaccessory availability.

File:13ltace.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:05 1996

Page 271: 1996 econoline

272

*[AC00600(BEF )06/95] Safety, Comfort, and Convenience

[AC01300( E )04/95]

twenty-eight pica chart:0020762-H

*[AC01900( ALL)01/95] NOTE: When adding accessories, equipment,passengers, and luggage to yourvehicle, do not exceed the total weightcapacity of the vehicle or of the frontor rear axle (GVWR, GAWR as shownon the Safety Compliance CertificationLabel). Consult your dealer for specificweight information.

File:13ltace.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:05 1996

Page 272: 1996 econoline

273

*[AC02000( ALL)05/95] NOTE: The Federal CommunicationsCommission (FCC) or the CanadianRadio Telecommunications Commission(CRTC) regulates the use of mobilecommunications systems — such astwo-way radios, telephones, and theftalarms — that are equipped with radiotransmitters. Any such equipmentinstalled in your vehicle should complywith FCC or CRTC regulations andshould be installed only by a qualifiedtechnician.

*[AC02100( ALL)01/95] NOTE: Mobile communications systems mayharm the operation of your vehicle,particularly if they are not properlydesigned for automotive use or are notproperly installed. For example, whenoperated, such systems may cause theengine to stumble or stall. In addition,such systems may themselves bedamaged or their operation affected byoperating your vehicle. (Citizens band[CB] transceivers, garage door openers,and other transmitters whose poweroutput is 5 watts or less will notordinarily affect your vehicle’soperation.)

*[AC02200( ALL)05/95] NOTE: Because we have no control over theinstallation, design, or manufacture ofsuch systems, Ford cannot assumeresponsibility for any adverse effects ordamage that may result if you use thisequipment.

File:13ltace.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:05 1996

Page 273: 1996 econoline

274

*[AC02400( ALL)02/89]

ten pica chart:0020464-A

File:13ltace.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:05 1996

Page 274: 1996 econoline

276

% [AC03500( E )02/95]

thirty-four pica chart:0021239-B

File:13ltace.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:05 1996

Page 275: 1996 econoline

277

[AC03600( E )02/95]

thirty-six pica chart:0021240-B

File:13ltace.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:05 1996

Page 276: 1996 econoline

278

[AC03700( E )02/95]

thirty-six pica chart:0021241-B

File:13ltace.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:41:05 1996

Page 277: 1996 econoline

279

Servicing Your Econoline

%*[SV00300( ALL)03/95] Service Made Easy

*[SV00400(BEF )01/95] Ford has two goals for servicing your vehicle.

*[SV00500(BEF )01/95] 1. When we can, we design parts that do notneed to be serviced.

*[SV00600(BEF )01/95] 2. We want to make servicing your vehicle aseasy as possible. To help you:

*[SV00700(BEF )01/95] ❑We highlight do-it-yourself items in yellow inthe engine compartment so that you can findthem easily.

*[SV00800(BEF )01/95] ❑When possible, we design parts — such asthe headlamp bulbs — that can be replacedwithout tools.

*[SV00900(BEF )05/94] ❑We give you a Maintenance Schedule thatmakes tracking routine service for yourvehicle easy. The maintenance schedule islocated in the Maintenance Schedule and Recordbooklet.

*[SV01000( ALL)01/95] This chapter tells you about the basic parts thatyou need to check and service regularly.

*[SV01100( ALL)02/95] If your vehicle needs professional servicing, yourdealership can provide the parts and servicerequired. Check your Warranty Information Bookletto find out which parts and services are covered.Also see the Customer Assistance chapter of thisOwner Guide.

*[SV01300( ALL)03/95] Ford Motor Company recommends that theOwner Maintenance Checks listed in theMaintenance Schedule and Record booklet beperformed for the proper operation of your

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 278: 1996 econoline

280

vehicle. In addition to the conditions listed inthe Owner Maintenance Checklist, be alert for anyunusual noise, vibration, or other indication thatyour vehicle may need service. If you do noticesomething unusual, see that your vehicle isserviced promptly.

*[SV01600( ALL)06/95] Precautions When Servicing YourVehicle

*[SV01700( ALL)06/95] Be especially careful when inspecting orservicing your vehicle. Here are some generalprecautions for your safety:

*[SV01900( ALL)06/95] ❑ If you must work with the engine running,avoid wearing loose clothing or jewelry thatcould get caught in moving parts. Takeappropriate precautions with long hair.

*[SV02000( ALL)06/95] ❑Do not work on a vehicle in an enclosedspace with the engine running, unless you aresure you have enough ventilation.

*[SV02100( ALL)06/95] ❑Never get under a vehicle while it issupported by a jack only. If you must workunder a vehicle, use safety stands.

*[SV02200( ALL)06/95] ❑Keep all lit cigarettes and other smokingmaterials away from the battery and allfuel-related parts.

*[SV02500( ALL)03/95] If you disconnect the battery, the engine must“relearn” its idle conditions before your vehiclewill drive properly. To find out how the enginedoes this, see Battery in this chapter.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 279: 1996 econoline

281

*[SV02600( ALL)03/95] Working with the engine off:

*[SV02650( E M)03/95] 1. Set the parking brake fully and make surethat the gearshift is securely latched in P(Park).

[SV02700( ALL)06/95] 2. Remove the key from the ignition after youturn the engine off.

[SV02725( ALL)06/95] 3. Block the wheels. This will prevent yourvehicle from moving unexpectedly.

*[SV02750( ALL)03/95] Working with the engine on:

*[SV02785( E M)03/95] 1. Set the parking brake fully and make surethat the gearshift is securely latched in P(Park).

*[SV02795( E M)03/95] 2. Block the wheels. This will prevent yourvehicle from moving unexpectedly.

*[SV02900( ALL)02/95] RWARNING

Do not start your engine with the aircleaner removed and do not remove itwhile the engine is running.

*[SV02950(BEF )03/95] Opening the Hood

[SV03025( E )05/89] 1. Pull the hood release handle, located on theleft kick panel near the parking brake releasehandle.

*[SV03050(BEF )12/91] 2. While applying downward pressure on thehood, push the hood latch handle locatedbehind the grille near the center front of thevehicle to the left.

*[SV03100( E )08/94] 3. Disconnect the hood support from theretaining clip on the radiator support andplace it into the slot marked PROP in theunderside of the hood.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 280: 1996 econoline

282

*[SV03300(BEF )03/91]

one third page art:0020333-A

Hood release handle

[SV03500( E )02/92]

quarter page art:0020336-D

Hood and support

*[SV03800( E )08/94] To close the hood, raise it so that the supportrod comes away from the slotted hole in thehood. Place the support rod in its retaining clipand close the hood with enough force to make itlatch. Be sure to oil the hood latch every sixmonths to maintain smooth operation.

*[SV03900(BEF )05/90] Always attempt to lift the hood after closing tobe sure it is securely latched.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 281: 1996 econoline

283

*[SV04500(BEF )04/95] Engine Compartment

*[SV04600(BEF )05/94] Your vehicle has one of the following types ofengines:

*[SV04700( EF )06/92] ❑A 4.9 Liter EFI, I-6 engine, or

*[SV04750(BEF )05/89] ❑A 5.0 Liter EFI, V-8 engine, or

*[SV05000( EF )05/89] ❑A 5.8 Liter EFI, V-8 engine, or

*[SV05100( EF )05/89] ❑A 7.5 Liter EFI, V-8 engine.

*[SV05475( EF )05/94] NOTE: Read the 7.3L Diesel Engine OwnerGuide Supplement for informationregarding correct service points foryour diesel-powered vehicle.

*[SV05500(BEF )11/94] The following pages show diagrams of eachengine type and where to find items that youshould regularly service.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 282: 1996 econoline

284

[SV05650(E)05/94]

fullpageart:0020341-H

4.9Len

gine

comp

artmen

tservice

poin

ts

File:14ltsve.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 283: 1996 econoline

285

[SV05700(E)04/95]

fullpageart:0020342-H

5.0L/5.8L

engin

ecom

partm

ent

servicep

oints

File:14ltsve.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 284: 1996 econoline

286

[SV05750(E)05/94]

fullpageart:0020343-G

7.5Len

gine

comp

artmen

tservice

poin

ts

File:14ltsve.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 285: 1996 econoline

287

%*[SV05900(BEF )04/95] Cleaning the Engine

*[SV05920(BEF )04/95] A clean engine is more efficient because abuildup of grease and dirt acts as an insulator,keeping the engine warmer than usual.

*[SV05940(BEF )05/95] ❑Extreme care must be used if a power washeris used to clean the engine. The high pressurefluid could penetrate sealed parts andassemblies causing damage or malfunctions.

*[SV05960(BEF )04/95] ❑ In order to avoid possible cracking of theengine block or fuel injection pump, do notspray a hot engine or injection pump withcold water.

*[SV05980(BEF )06/95] ❑The alternator, distributor and air intake mustbe covered. Covering these components willhelp prevent water damage.

*[SV06000(BEF )04/95] ❑Never wash or rinse the engine while it isrunning. Water getting into the engine maycause internal damage.

*[SV06100( ALL)03/95] Filling the Fuel Tank[SV06400( E )12/91]

one third page art:0020350-D

Fuel filler door

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 286: 1996 econoline

288

%*[SV06550(BEF )02/91] Opening the Fuel Filler Door

*[SV06600(BEF )10/94] To open the fuel filler door of your vehicle, justinsert your finger in the divot and pull the dooropen all the way.

[SV06675( E )03/91] NOTE: For Stripped Chassis vehicles, see yourBody Builders manual for the properlocation of the fuel filler door.

%*[SV06700( ALL)01/95] Removing the fuel cap

*[SV06750( ALL)01/95] The proper instructions for removing the fuelcap are as follows:

*[SV06800( ALL)03/90] ❑Unscrew the fuel cap by exerting pressure onthe plastic lock bar and rotating the fuel capcounterclockwise.

*[SV06850( ALL)12/91] ❑Turn the fuel cap 1/2 to 3/4 of a turn until ahissing sound is heard. Wait until the hissingsound stops and then continue rotatingcounterclockwise to remove the fuel cap.

*[SV06900( ALL)03/93] ❑Make sure that you follow the above fuel capremoval instructions and use caution. Suchcaution will minimize the possibility of fuelspraying during removal of the fuel cap.

*[SV06950( ALL)03/91] To replace and secure the fuel cap; place it inposition and rotate it clockwise until it clicks(ratchets). Doing so will not damage or breakthe fuel cap. The ratcheting mechanism allowsthe fuel cap to be sealed without overtightening.

*[SV06975( ALL)06/95] If you lose the fuel cap, replace it with anauthorized Motorcraft or equivalent part.

%*[SV07000( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

If you do not use the proper fuel cap, thepressure in the fuel tank can damage thefuel system or cause it to work improperlyin a collision.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 287: 1996 econoline

289

*[SV07025( ALL)05/95] NOTE: If you replace your fuel cap with anaftermarket fuel filler cap, the customerwarranty may be void for any damageto the fuel tank and/or fuel system.

*[SV07050( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

If the fuel cap is venting vapor or if youhear a hissing sound, wait until it stopsbefore completely removing the cap.

*[SV07060(BEF )11/89] A venting fuel tank is not an abnormalcondition. It may be caused by:

*[SV07061(BEF )03/90] ❑Too volatile a fuel for the weather conditions.The service stations sometimes sell wintergrade fuel in the summer.

*[SV07062(BEF )11/89] ❑Pulling a heavy load on hot days, or at highaltitudes.

*[SV07063(BEF )11/89] ❑Extended periods of idling with the engineRPM increased above the normal idle range.

*[SV07064(BEF )11/89] ❑Parking vehicle in full sunlight for extendedperiods on extremely hot days.

*[SV07500( ALL)06/95] Choosing the Right Fuel

*[SV07550( EF )05/94] NOTE: Read the 7.3L Diesel Engine OwnerGuide Supplement for informationregarding correct fuel requirements foryour diesel-powered vehicle.

*[SV07600( ALL)06/95] Use only UNLEADED FUEL in your vehicle.Using leaded fuel is prohibited by federal law.Your warranty may not apply if your vehicle isdamaged because you used the wrong fuel.

*[SV07700( ALL)06/95] Vehicle inspection programs may detectmisfueling. Under these circumstances, you maybe required by law to make costly repairs atyour own expense.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 288: 1996 econoline

290

%*[SV08710( ALL)04/95] Octane recommendations

*[SV08725( ALL)06/95] Your engine is designed to use regularunleaded fuel with an octane rating of 87. Inmost cases, it is not necessary to use a fuel withan octane rating higher than 87. At servicestations, the octane rating is displayed on a labelon the pumps.

*[SV08900( ALL)06/95]

one inch art:0060001-C

Typical octane rating label

*[SV09050( ALL)06/95] In some parts of the country, “regular” gradefuels are sold with octane ratings of 86 or evenless, especially in high altitude areas. Werecommend that you do not use these fuels.Always use a fuel with an octane rating of 87,even if it is sold as a “midgrade” or “premium.”

%*[SV09200( ALL)06/95] Do not be concerned if your vehicle sometimesknocks lightly when you drive up a hill or whenyou accelerate. However, see your dealer or aqualified service technician if persistent, heavyknocking occurs because this can damage theengine.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 289: 1996 econoline

291

%*[SV09435( ALL)05/95] Fuel quality

*[SV09450( ALL)06/95] If you are experiencing starting, rough idle orhesitation problems when the engine is cold, itmay be caused by fuel with low volatility. Try adifferent brand of fuel. If the condition persists,see your dealer or a qualified service technician.

*[SV09452( ALL)06/95] Using a high-quality fuel makes your vehiclemore responsive and maintains its good fueleconomy and emissions by:

*[SV09455( ALL)06/95] ❑protecting your fuel system from rusting.

*[SV09460( ALL)06/95] ❑preventing the fuel lines from freezing.

*[SV09465( ALL)06/95] ❑ improving vehicle starting and warm-up.

*[SV09470( ALL)06/95] ❑protecting the fuel system from vapor lock invery hot weather, which causes the engine tohesitate or stall and makes restarts difficult.

*[SV09475( ALL)06/95] ❑minimizing deposits in fuel injectors,combustion chambers, and on intake valves.

*[SV09480( ALL)06/95] ❑preventing your fuel system from “gummingup” when your vehicle is not used for longperiods of time.

*[SV09485( ALL)06/95] ❑preventing your engine from knocking andpinging.

*[SV09500( ALL)06/95] It should not be necessary to add anyaftermarket products to your fuel tank if youcontinue to use a high-quality fuel.

%*[SV09875( ALL)04/95] Gasolines for clean air

*[SV09900( ALL)06/95] Fuels in certain areas of the country are requiredto contain oxygenates to improve air quality.Common oxygenates are ethanol or grain alcohol(blended at no more than 10%), methanol orwood alcohol (blended at no more than 5% withcosolvents and additives), and MTBE or methyltertiary butyl ether (blended at no more than15%).

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 290: 1996 econoline

292

[SV09950( ALL)04/95] Reformulated gasoline is also required in certainareas of the U.S. These fuels are designed tofurther reduce the emissions from your vehicle.

[SV10000( ALL)04/95] Generally, you should not experience difficultiesoperating your vehicle on reformulated gasolineor on fuels containing oxygenates. We encourageyou to use these fuels.

*[SV10185( ALL)06/95] Safety Information Relating to AutomotiveFuels

*[SV10195( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Automotive fuels can cause serious injuryor death if misused or mishandled.

*[SV10200( ALL)06/95] Gasoline and other automotive fuels areextremely flammable. Turn your vehicle off anddo not smoke while refueling your vehicle. Keepsparks and other sources of ignition away fromfuels.

*[SV10205( ALL)05/95] Automotive fuels can be harmful or fatal ifswallowed. Further, gasoline may be blendedwith methanol. Even small amounts of methanolcan cause blindness and possibly death whenswallowed. Therefore, never attempt to siphonany fuel by mouth.

*[SV10210( ALL)05/95] If any fuel is swallowed, call a physician orpoison control center immediately. Do not delaycalling a physician merely because no adverseeffects are noticed at first; the toxic effects of agasoline-methanol blend, including blindness,may not become apparent for many hours. Ifgasoline is swallowed, do not induce vomiting.If a gasoline-methanol blend is swallowed,induce vomiting under the direction of aphysician or poison control center.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 291: 1996 econoline

293

*[SV10215( ALL)03/95] Gasoline and gasoline-methanol blends maycontain small amounts of carcinogens, such asbenzene. Long-term exposure to unleadedgasoline vapors has caused cancer in laboratoryanimals. Further, excessive inhalation of fuelvapors can cause headache, dizziness, nausea,loss of coordination, and other symptoms whichcould interfere with your ability to safelyoperate your vehicle. To the extent possible,avoid breathing vapors while refueling. If fuelvapors are inhaled in excessive quantities, movethe victim to fresh air and seek medicalattention.

*[SV10220( ALL)03/95] Fuels can also be harmful if absorbed throughthe skin. When refueling, be careful not tosplash fuel on yourself or your clothing. If fuelis splashed on the skin, promptly removecontaminated clothing and wash the skinthoroughly with soap and water.

*[SV10225( ALL)05/95] Fuels can cause severe eye irritation and possiblyeye damage. If fuel is splashed in the eyes,remove contact lenses (if worn), flush with largeamounts of water for 15 minutes, and seekmedical attention.

*[SV10230( ALL)06/95] You should be particularly careful if you aretaking the medication “Antabuse” or other formsof disulfiram for the treatment of alcoholism.There is a possibility that breathing the vaporsof a gasoline-methanol blend, or skin contactwith such a blend, may cause the same kind ofadverse reaction as drinking an alcoholicbeverage. In sensitive individuals, seriouspersonal injury or sickness could result. Consulta physician promptly if you experience anadverse reaction.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 292: 1996 econoline

294

*[SV10300( ALL)02/95] Filling the fuel tank

*[SV10400( ALL)04/94] RWARNING

Do not overfill the fuel tank. The pressurein an overfilled tank may cause leakageand lead to fuel spray and fire.

*[SV10500( ALL)01/95] To fill the fuel tank properly:

*[SV10550( ALL)01/95] NOTE: Extinguish all lit cigarettes, othersmoking materials, and any openflames before fueling your vehicle.

*[SV10600( ALL)01/95] 1. Remove the fuel cap by following theinstructions above under Removing the FuelCap in this chapter. Proceed to add fuel tothe tank only if your vehicle is on levelground.

*[SV10700( ALL)05/95] 2. Make sure that you pump unleaded fuel andput the nozzle all the way inside the fuelfiller pipe.

*[SV10800( ALL)06/95] NOTE: If you spill any fuel on the body ofyour vehicle, clean it off immediately.The fuel may dull or soften the paintif you do not wash it off.

%*[SV10900( ALL)06/95] 3. Replace the fuel cap completely when youare finished. Turn it clockwise 1/4 turn untilit is tight. It will click when it is fullytightened.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 293: 1996 econoline

295

%*[SV11300( ALL)05/95] Running Out of Fuel

*[SV11400( ALL)05/95] If your vehicle runs out of fuel, try to stop onlevel ground away from traffic. Add at least twogallons (8 liters) of fuel to start your vehicleagain. If your vehicle is not on level ground,you may need as much as five gallons (20 liters)of fuel to start it.

*[SV11500( ALL)05/95] You may need to crank the engine several timesbefore the fuel system starts to pump fuel fromthe tank to the engine.

%*[SV11600( ALL)05/95] Fuel Economy

*[SV11700( ALL)06/95] Fuel economy is an estimate of the efficiency ofyour vehicle and can be calculated as Miles PerGallon (MPG) or Liters Per 100 Kilometers(L/100K).

*[SV11750( ALL)05/95] Do not calculate fuel economy during yourvehicle’s break-in period. This would not be anaccurate estimate of how much fuel your vehiclewill normally use.

*[SV11800( ALL)05/95] To calculate fuel economy:

*[SV11900( ALL)06/95] 1. Fill the tank completely and record theinitial odometer reading.

*[SV12000( ALL)06/95] 2. Every time you buy fuel record theamount (in gallons or liters) purchased.

*[SV12200( ALL)05/95] 3. After at least three to five tankfuls, fill thefuel tank and record the final odometerreading.

*[SV12225( ALL)05/95] 4. Use these equations to calculate your fueleconomy.

*[SV12250( ALL)05/95] ❑English: MPG = (total miles)/(gallons used).

*[SV12275( ALL)05/95] ❑Metric: L/100K = (liters used) x 100/(totalkilometers)

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 294: 1996 econoline

296

%*[SV12300(BEF )05/95] Comparisons With EPA Fuel EconomyEstimates

*[SV12400(BEF )05/95] EPA fuel economy figures are obtained fromlaboratory tests under simulated road conditionsand may not reflect the actual conditions youexperience or your style of driving. The EPAfuel economy estimate is not a guarantee thatyou will achieve the fuel economy shown.

%*[SV12500( ALL)06/95] Improving Fuel Economy

*[SV12600( ALL)05/95] Fuel economy is affected by a number ofvariables which can reduce efficiency. You canimprove fuel economy by understanding thesevariables and minimizing their effect.

*[SV12700( ALL)05/95] The following decrease fuel economy:

*[SV12800( ALL)05/95] ❑Lack of regular, scheduled maintenance

*[SV12900( ALL)05/95] ❑Driving with your foot on the brake

*[SV13000( ALL)05/95] ❑Sudden stops

*[SV13100( ALL)05/95] ❑Excessive speed

*[SV13200( ALL)05/95] ❑Extended engine idling

*[SV13300( ALL)05/95] ❑Heavy loads

*[SV13400( ALL)05/95] ❑Underinflated tires

*[SV13500(BEF )05/95] ❑Extended use of the A/C, defroster, rearwindow defroster and other accessories

*[SV13550(BEF )05/95] ❑Aftermarket add-ons such as bike, ski orluggage racks, bug deflectors, etc.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 295: 1996 econoline

297

*[SV13600( ALL)02/95] Engine Oil Recommendations

*[SV13610( ALL)05/95] We recommend using Motorcraft oil or anequivalent oil meeting Ford SpecificationWSS-M2C153-F and displaying the AmericanPetroleum Institute CERTIFICATION MARK onthe front of the container.

*[SV13655( ALL)03/95]

one third page art:0060020-D

The API Certification Mark

*[SV13670( ALL)01/95] Never use:

*[SV13680( ALL)01/95] ❑“Non-Detergent” oils

*[SV13690( ALL)04/95] ❑Oils labeled API SA, SB, SC, SD, SE, SF or SG

%*[SV13700( ALL)01/95] ❑Additional engine oil additives, oil treatmentsor engine treatments

[SV13705( EF )04/95] For vehicles with 5.8L engines

%*[SV13710( ALL)06/95] Engine oils with an SAE 5W-30 viscosity arePREFERRED for your vehicle. They provide thebest engine performance, fuel economy andengine protection for all climates down to -15˚F(-25˚C).

%*[SV13725( ALL)03/95] Synthetic engine oils which are CERTIFIED andof the preferred viscosity may be used in yourengine. The engine oil and oil filter must still bechanged according to the maintenance schedule.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 296: 1996 econoline

298

*[SV13730( EF )01/93] For vehicles with 4.9L, 5.0L or 7.5L engines

[SV13740( ALL)04/95] Engine oils with an SAE 10W-30 viscosity arePREFERRED for your vehicle which provide thebest engine protection for all climates down to-5˚F (-20˚C). SAE 5W-30 enigne oils may also beused down to -15˚F (-25˚C).

[SV13745( ALL)02/95] Synthetic engine oils which are CERTIFIED andof the preferred viscosity may be used in yourengine. The engine oil and oil filter must still bechanged according to the maintenance schedule.

*[SV13775( ALL)01/95] Checking and Adding Engine Oil

*[SV13800( ALL)03/95] Since the proper amount of engine oil isimportant for safe engine operation, check the oilusing the dipstick each time you put fuel inyour vehicle. Remember the engine must be off,the oil must be warm and the vehicle must beparked on level ground.

*[SV13900( ALL)03/95] Checking the engine oil level:

*[SV14000( ALL)02/95] 1. Turn the engine off after it has warmed upand allow a few minutes for the engine oilto drain back into the oil pan.

*[SV14075( E M)03/95] 2. Set the parking brake, making sure thegearshift is securely latched in P (Park).

*[SV14100( ALL)02/95] 3. Open the hood. Protect yourself from engineheat.

*[SV14200( ALL)03/95] 4. Locate the engine oil dipstick (highlighted inyellow) and carefully pull it out of theengine.

*[SV14300( ALL)01/95] 5. Wipe the dipstick clean and put it back intoposition, making sure it is fully seated.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 297: 1996 econoline

299

*[SV14400( ALL)06/95]

quarter page art:0010364-D

Engine oil dipstick

*[SV14500( ALL)02/95] 6. Carefully, pull the dipstick out again. If theoil level is below the “ADD 1 QT.” line, addengine oil as necessary. If the oil level isbeyond the letter “F” in FULL, enginedamage or high oil consumption may occurand some oil must be removed from theengine.

*[SV14600( ALL)01/95] 7. Put the dipstick back in and make sure it isfully seated.

*[SV14800( ALL)01/95] It may be necessary to add some oil between oilchanges. Make sure you use a CERTIFIEDengine oil of the preferred viscosity. Yourvehicle’s warranty coverage may not apply ifengine damage is caused by the use of improperengine oil.

*[SV15000( ALL)03/95] Add engine oil through the oil filler caphighlighted in yellow. To add oil, remove thefiller cap and use a funnel to pour oil into theopening. Be careful not to overfill the engine.Recheck the oil level after you finish adding oil.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 298: 1996 econoline

300

*[SV16300( EFM)06/95] Changing the Engine Oil and the Oil Filter

*[SV16500( ALL)04/95] Change the engine oil and oil filter per thefollowing, whichever occurs first.

*[SV16600(BEF )04/95]

one third page art:0060618-C

Oil change intervals

*[SV16625( ALL)06/95] NOTE: Idling the engine for extended periodswill accumulate more hours of use onyour vehicles than is actually indicatedby the mileage odometer.Consequently, the odometer readingcan be often misleading whendetermining the right time to changeyour engine oil and filter.

*[SV16650(BEF )06/95] If you are using your Ford vehicle in a mannerwhich allows it to remain stationary while theengine is running for long periods (door todoor delivery, taxi, police, power/utilitycompany trucks, or similar duty), then Fordrecommends you increase the frequency of oiland filter changes to an interval equivalent to200 ENGINE HOURS of use. Since mostvehicles are not equipped with hourmeters, itmay be necessary for you to approximate youridle time and plan oil/filter changesaccordingly.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 299: 1996 econoline

301

*[SV16700( EF )06/93] If your vehicle is over 8500 GVWR and theabove conditions do not apply, change theengine oil and oil filter every 6 months or 5,000miles (8,000 km), whichever comes first.

*[SV16800( ALL)06/95] Refer to the Maintenance Schedule and Recordbooklet for additional information.

*[SV16900( EF )03/94] NOTE: Refer to the Power Stroke Diesel EngineOwner’s Guide Supplement for oilviscosity, filter application and oil andfilter change intervals.

%*[SV17250( ALL)04/95] NOTE: Always dispose of used automotivefluids in a responsible manner. Followyour community’s standards fordisposing of these types of fluids. Callyour local recycling center to find outabout recycling automotive fluids.

*[SV17275( ALL)06/95] RWARNING

Continuous contact with USED motor oilhas caused cancer in laboratory mice.

*[SV17280( ALL)06/95] Protect your skin by washing with soap andwater.

*[SV17300( ALL)03/95] Engine Coolant

*[SV17400( ALL)02/95] Checking the engine coolant

*[SV17700( ALL)10/89] Your vehicle’s engine coolant protects the enginefrom overheating in the summer and fromfreezing in the winter. Check the level of theengine coolant at least once a month, butpreferably each time you stop for fuel. Simplylook at the engine coolant recovery reservoirlocated in the engine compartment. To locatethis reservoir, see the diagram of your vehicle’sengine under Engine types in this chapter.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 300: 1996 econoline

302

*[SV17750( ALL)03/95] If the engine coolant has not been checked for along period of time the engine coolant reservoirmay eventually empty. If the engine coolantreservoir empties, check the engine coolant levelin the radiator. Read the following warningsbefore removing the radiator cap. If it isnecessary to fill the radiator, refer to the EngineCoolant Refill Procedure in this chapter forinstructions.

*[SV17950(BEF )01/95] Adding engine coolant

[SV18100( E )05/94]

quarter page art:0020355-C

Checking engine coolant radiator level

% [SV18300( E )07/92]

quarter page art:0020357-B

Adding engine coolant

*[SV18400( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Do not put engine coolant in the containerfor the windshield washer fluid.

*[SV18420( ALL)06/95] If sprayed to clean the glass, engine coolant orantifreeze could make it difficult to see throughthe windshield.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 301: 1996 econoline

303

*[SV18500( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Never remove the coolant recovery capwhile the engine is running or hot.

*[SV18600( ALL)06/95] RWARNING

Follow these steps to minimize risk ofpersonal injury.

*[SV18700( ALL)03/95] 1. Before you remove the cap, turn the engineoff and let it cool. Even when the engine iscool, be careful when you remove theradiator cap.

*[SV18800( ALL)05/95] 2. When the engine is cool, wrap a thick clotharound the cap and turn it slowlycounterclockwise to the first stop.

*[SV18900( ALL)03/95] 3. Step back while the pressure releases.

*[SV19000( ALL)05/95] 4. When you are sure that all the pressure hasbeen released, use the cloth to press, turn,and remove cap.

*[SV19100( ALL)03/95] 5. Stand away from the radiator opening. Hotsteam may blow out or hot engine coolantmay even splash out.

%*[SV19500( ALL)01/93] Freezing Protection

*[SV19600( ALL)03/91] The factory-installed solution of Ford PremiumCooling System Fluid and water will protectyour vehicle to S35˚F (S37˚C). Check the freezeprotection rating of the engine coolant at leastonce a year, just before winter.

*[SV19701( ALL)06/95] Add engine coolant only to the coolantreservoir. If the coolant level is low, add to thereservoir a 50/50 mixture of water and the typeof engine coolant that Ford specifies. You mayadd water by itself only in an emergency, butyou should replace it with a 50/50 mixture assoon as possible. Check the engine coolant againthe next few times you drive your vehicle.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 302: 1996 econoline

304

*[SV19801( ALL)02/95] Ford Premium Cooling System Fluid is anoptimized formula that will protect all metalsand rubber elastomers used in Ford engines forfour years or 50,000 miles (80,000 km). It is notnecessary and not recommended to usesupplemental coolant additives in your gasolinepowered vehicle. These additives may harmyour engine cooling system. Follow therecommended service interval for changing yourengine coolant.

*[SV19851( ALL)04/94] NOTE: When you change or add enginecoolant, it is important to maintainyour engine coolant concentrationbetween 40% (-11˚F [-24˚C]) and 60%(-62˚F [-52˚C]), depending on your localclimate conditions. Below 40% you willlose freeze protection and above 60%your engine may overheat on a warmday.

%*[SV19950( ALL)03/95] NOTE: Do not use an engine coolant that doesnot meet all 14 requirements of FordSpecification ESE-M97B44-A. The useof an improper coolant may void yourwarranty for the engine cooling system.Use only a premium nationallyrecognized brand name engine coolant.

*[SV19960( ALL)05/95] Ford Motor Company expressly authorizes theFord Rotunda engine coolant recycling processand chemicals. Use only Ford Rotunda recycledengine coolant or an equivalent recycled enginecoolant that is certified by the supplier to meetFord specification ESE-M97B44-A.

%*[SV19980( ALL)04/95] NOTE: Always dispose of used automotivefluids in a responsible manner. Followyour community’s standards fordisposing of these types of fluids. Callyour local recycling center to find outabout recycling automotive fluids.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 303: 1996 econoline

305

%*[SV20001( ALL)01/95] Use Ford Premium Cooling System Fluid or anequivalent engine coolant that meets FordSpecification ESE-M97B44-A. Do not use alcoholor methanol antifreeze and do not use enginecoolant mixed with alcohol or methanolantifreeze. If you do not use the proper coolant,the aluminum radiator on your vehicle willcorrode.

*[SV20100( ALL)01/95] Leave the engine coolant in all year. Make surethat the coolant will not freeze at thetemperature level in which you drive duringwinter months. Keep a mixture of engine coolantin your engine that has a protection rating of atleast -34˚F (-37˚C), or whatever protection ratingis appropriate for the climate in which you live.

*[SV20125( ALL)03/95] To find out how much engine coolant mixtureyour vehicle’s coolant system can hold, see Refillcapacities for fluids in the Index.

*[SV20151( ALL)01/95] You may add water by itself only in anemergency, but you should replace it with a50/50 or appropriate mixture as soon aspossible.

*[SV20200( ALL)01/95] Have your dealer check the engine coolingsystem for leaks if you have to add a quart(liter) of engine coolant more than once a month.

%*[SV20500( ALL)11/94] Checking hoses

*[SV20600( ALL)10/89] Inspect all engine and heater system hoses fordeterioration, leaks and loose clamps beforeadding or replacing engine coolant. Makewhatever repairs or replacements that arenecessary using Motorcraft parts or theirequivalents.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 304: 1996 econoline

306

*[SV20700( ALL)05/95] Engine coolant drain and flush

*[SV20800( ALL)10/89] To drain your vehicle’s engine coolant:

*[SV20900( ALL)03/94] 1. Turn off the engine and let it cool. Fullydepressurize the engine cooling system bycovering the radiator cap with a thick clothand turning it slowly counterclockwise to thefirst stop. Step back while the pressurereleases.

*[SV20950( ALL)05/90] 2. Remove the cap.

[SV20955( E)06/95] 3. Open the radiator drain cock.

*[SV21200( ALL)05/90] 4. Let the engine coolant drain into a suitablecontainer. Disconnect the lower radiator hoseat the radiator connector and drain anyremaining engine coolant into a container.

*[SV21225( ALL)05/94] 5. Reconnect the lower radiator hose and closethe radiator drain cock.

*[SV21250( ALL)06/95] Proper procedures for flushing the coolingsystem can be found in the Truck Service Manual.

*[SV21300( ALL)02/95] Engine coolant refill procedure

*[SV21400( ALL)10/89] After you have drained the engine coolingsystem:

*[SV21500( ALL)01/89] 1. Fill the radiator with a 50/50 mixture of thespecified engine coolant concentrate andwater. Allow several minutes for trapped airto escape (bubble out) and for engine coolantto flow through the radiator.

*[SV21900( ALL)03/94] 2. Replace the radiator cap to its fully installedposition, then back off to the first stop. Thiswill prevent high pressure from building upin the cooling system during this part of thefill procedure.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 305: 1996 econoline

307

*[SV22100( ALL)10/89] 3. Start and idle the engine until the thermostatopens and the radiator upper hose becomeswarm.

*[SV22200( ALL)05/95] 4. Shut off the engine and allow the engine tocool. Cover the radiator cap with a thickcloth and cautiously remove it. Step backwhile the pressure releases.

*[SV22500( ALL)10/89] 5. Finally, check the radiator and add moreengine coolant if needed, following theprocedures noted above. Reinstall theradiator cap securely, when finished.

*[SV22525( ALL)05/90] 6. If more engine coolant is necessary, fill theoverflow reservoir to the appropriate levelmarked on the bottle.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 306: 1996 econoline

308

*[SV22700(BEF )03/95] Windshield Washer Fluid andWipers

*[SV22800(BEF )03/95] Washer Fluid

*[SV22900(BEF )01/95] Check the level of the windshield washer fluidevery time you stop for fuel. The reservoir forthe windshield washer fluid is located in theengine compartment.

*[SV23200(BEF )03/95] Adding washer fluid

*[SV23300(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Do not put windshield washer fluid in thecontainer for the engine coolant.

[SV23650( E )05/95]

one third page art:0020361-B

Windshield washer reservoir

%*[SV23850(BEF )01/95] Use specially formulated windshield washerfluid rather than plain water, because speciallyformulated washer fluids contain additives thatdissolve road grime. For safety reasons, washerfluids containing an appropriate antifreeze suchas methanol should be used in freezing weather(temperatures below 32˚F [0˚C]). State or localregulations on Volatile Organic Compounds(VOC’s) may restrict use of the most common

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 307: 1996 econoline

309

antifreeze, methanol. Washer fluids containingnon-methanol antifreeze agents should be usedonly if they provide cold weather protectionwithout damaging the vehicle’s paint finish,wiper blades, and windshield washer system.

*[SV23900(BEF )10/89] If you choose to use a windshield washingsolution that must be mixed, follow themanufacturer’s mixing instructions. Improperlymixed solutions may freeze unexpectedly.

[SV24000(BEF )04/95] NOTE: The addition of shields to the front ofthe vehicle, as used to deflect bugs,may also adversely affect the washersystem from delivering fluid to thewindshield. Devices such as bugshields are not recommended to beadded to your new Ford product.

*[SV24500(BEF )03/95] Wiper Blades

*[SV24600(BEF )03/95] Check the windshield wiper blades at least twicea year. Also check them whenever they seemless effective than usual. Such substances as treesap and some hot wax treatments used bycommercial car washes reduce the effectivenessof wiper blades.

*[SV24700(BEF )03/95] If the blades do not wipe properly, clean boththe windshield and the wiper blades. Useundiluted windshield washer solution or a milddetergent. Rinse thoroughly with clear water. Donot use fuel, kerosene, paint thinner, or othersolvents to clean your wiper blades. These willdamage your blades.

*[SV24800(BEF )02/95] To make reaching the wiper blades easy, simplyturn the ignition switch to ACC and turn yourwipers on. Wait for them to reach a verticalposition and turn the ignition to OFF. Do notmove the wipers manually. Moving the wipersmanually may damage them.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 308: 1996 econoline

310

*[SV24900(BEF )03/01] Wiper blade replacement

*[SV25000(BEF )03/95] If the wiper blades still do not work properlyafter you clean them, you may need to replacethe wiper blade assembly or the blade element.When replacing the wiper blade assembly, bladerefill, or wiper arm always use a Motorcraft partor equivalent. To replace the blades, follow theinstructions that come with them.

*[SV25200( ALL)03/95] Tires

*[SV25300( ALL)03/95] Look at your tires each time you fill your fueltank. If one tire looks lower than the others,check the pressure in all of them. Always followthese precautions:

*[SV25400( ALL)04/95] ❑Keep your tires inflated to the pressures thatare recommended. (See Checking the pressureof the tires later in this chapter.)

*[SV25500(BEF )02/95] ❑Stay within the recommended load limits (seeLoad limits in the Index).

*[SV25600( ALL)02/95] ❑Make sure the weight of your load is evenlydistributed.

*[SV25700( ALL)10/89] ❑Drive at safe speeds.

*[SV25800( ALL)01/95] If you do not take these precautions, your tiresmay fail or go flat.

*[SV25875( ALL)06/95] Ford Motor Company recommends obeyingposted speed limits.

*[SV25900( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Driving too fast for conditions creates thepossibility of loss of vehicle control.Driving at very high speeds for extendedperiods of time may result in damage tovehicle components.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 309: 1996 econoline

311

%*[SV26000( ALL)06/95] Checking the pressure of the tires

*[SV26100( ALL)11/89] At least once a month, check the pressure in allyour vehicle’s tires, including the spare. Use anaccurate tire pressure gauge. Check the tirepressure when tires are cold, that is, after thevehicle has been parked for at least one hour orhas been driven less than 3 miles (5 km). Youcan find the proper cold pressure on the SafetyCompliance Certification Label.

*[SV26150( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Improperly inflated tires can affect vehiclehandling and can fail suddenly, possiblyresulting in loss of vehicle control.

%*[SV26200( ALL)06/95] Tire inspection and maintenance

*[SV26300( ALL)02/95] Inspect the tire treads, and remove stones, nails,glass or other objects that may be wedged in thetread grooves. Check for holes or cuts that maypermit air to leak from the tire, and make thenecessary repairs.

*[SV26400( ALL)10/89] Inspect the tire side walls for cuts, bruises andother damage. If you suspect internal damage tothe tire, have it demounted and checked. Youmay need to repair or replace it.

*[SV26410( ALL)11/89] Wheel inspection and maintenance

*[SV26420( ALL)11/89] Check for damage that would affect the runoutof the wheels. Wobble or shimmy will eventuallydamage the wheel bearings.

*[SV26430( ALL)06/93] Front wheel bearings require periodic repackingand adjustment as specified in the MaintenanceSchedule and Record booklet. Loose or worn frontwheel bearings tend to let the vehicle wander orshimmy, and can eventually cause excessive tirewear.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 310: 1996 econoline

312

*[SV26435( ALL)06/95] Whenever a wheel is removed and thenre-installed, always remove any corrosion thatmay be present on the mounting surface of thewheel and/or the surface of the hub, drum orrotor that contacts the wheel.

*[SV26440( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Installing wheels without goodmetal-to-metal contact at the wheelmounting surface can cause the wheel lugnuts to loosen and could allow the wheelto come off while the vehicle is in motion.

*[SV26445( EFM)05/90] RWARNING

Also retighten at 500 miles (800 km) afterany wheel change or any time the lugnuts are loosened.

*[SV26450(BEF )03/95] Traction-Lok Rear Axle (If equipped)

*[SV26460(BEF )03/95] This axle provides added drive away traction onslippery surfaces, particularly when one or morewheels are on a surface with poor traction.

*[SV26470(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

To avoid injury, never run the enginewith one wheel off the ground, such aswhen changing a tire.

%*[SV26500( ALL)02/95] Tire Rotation

*[SV26600( ALL)03/95] Because your vehicle’s front and rear tiresperform different jobs, they often weardifferently. To make sure your tires wear evenlyand last longer, rotate them at the mileageshown in the Maintenance Schedule and Recordbooklet which came with your vehicle.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 311: 1996 econoline

313

[SV26650( E )03/93] For E-250 (over 8500 GVWR [3855 kg]), andE-350 vehicles, rotate the tires at 5,000 miles(8,000 km), then at 15,000 miles (24,000 km), andthen every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) thereafter.

*[SV26660( EF )03/94] If your light truck has dual rear wheels, you canrotate the front tires side to side withoutdisturbing the rear tires.

*[SV26700(BEF )07/92] Rotate the tires according to the followingdiagram. If you notice that the tires wearunevenly, have them checked. If your light truckhas a temporary spare tire, do not include it inthe tire rotation pattern.

*[SV26750(BEF )03/90] In situations where the tires differ from front torear (snow/traction), simply rotate using a sideto side pattern.

*[SV26800(BEF )06/93]

half page art:0020364-A

Tire rotation pattern

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 312: 1996 econoline

314

*[SV26900(BEF )10/89] After each rotation, adjust individual tirepressure as specified on the Safety ComplianceCertification Label. Tighten wheel lug nuts to therequired torque specification and retighten againafter 500 miles (800 km).

*[SV27000(BEF )10/94] If your vehicle has aluminum wheels, you maydemount the full size, non-temporary sparetire (if so equipped) and remount on analuminum wheel to rotate the spare tire intoyour vehicle’s rotation pattern.

*[SV27100( E )03/95] You may discover uneven outside shoulder wearon your vehicle’s front radial tires if you driveoften in the city and turn frequently aroundcurbs. You can extend the life of your front tiresby remounting them so the outside of the tirefaces inside on the wheel rim.

[SV27200( E )05/89] To extend the life of your tires even more, rotatethe tires from front to rear.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 313: 1996 econoline

315

*[SV27300( ALL)04/95] Replacing the Tires

*[SV27400( ALL)05/95] Replace any tires that show wear bands. Whenyour tire shows a wear band, it has only 1/16inch (2 mm) of tread left.

*[SV27500( ALL)10/89]

quarter page art:0060006-A

Wear band

*[SV27600( ALL)01/95] Because your vehicle’s tires may wear unevenly,you may need to replace them before a wearband appears across the entire tread. Some spotswear more heavily than others.

*[SV27700( ALL)03/90] Your wheels and tires are match-mounted forimproved ride. Before you begin to repair a tire,mark the wheel and tire so that they areproperly aligned when remounted. This willensure that the tires will continue to give youthe same ride level.

*[SV27851( ALL)01/95] RWARNING

When replacing full size tires, never mixradial, bias-belted, or bias-type tires. Useonly the tire sizes that are listed on thetire pressure decal. Make sure that all tiresare the same size, speed rating, andload-carrying capacity. Use only the tirecombinations recommended on the decal.If you do not follow these precautions,your vehicle may not drive properly andsafely.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 314: 1996 econoline

316

*[SV27860( ALL)03/90] RWARNING

Make sure that all replacement tires are ofthe same size, type, load-carrying capacity,and tread design (e.g. “All Terrain”, etc.),as originally offered by Ford.

*[SV27885( ALL)06/95] RWARNING

Do not replace your tires with “highperformance” tires or larger size tires.

*[SV27892( EF )05/95] RWARNING

Use of aftermarket wheel assemblies maydamage your vehicle or cause accidentsresulting in serious injuries.

*[SV27895( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Failure to follow these precautions mayadversely affect the handling of thevehicle and make it easier to lose controland roll over.

*[SV27900( ALL)01/95] Tires that are larger or smaller than yourvehicle’s original tires may also affect theaccuracy of your speedometer.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 315: 1996 econoline

317

[SV28400( E )05/89]

full page art:0020369-C

Tire identification chart

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 316: 1996 econoline

318

*[SV28750( EF )11/90] RWARNING

To avoid possible serious or fatal bodilyinjury while mounting tires, mount LTMetric 16-inch radial tires only on 16-inchrims and not 16.5-inch rims. In addition,mount radial tires only on wheelsapproved for radial tires.

*[SV28800( ALL)04/95] Wheel and Tire Matching

*[SV28900( ALL)03/95] See an authorized tire dealer for properservicing procedures. Wheels and tires must beproperly removed, matched and remounted tomaintain the best possible ride.

%*[SV31100(BEF )04/95] Snow Tires and Chains

*[SV31200(BEF )01/95] The tires on your vehicle have all-weather treadsthat provide traction in rain or snow. However,during the winter months in some climates, youmay need to use snow tires and occasionallychains for your tires.

*[SV31300(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Snow tires must be the same size andgrade as the tires you currently have onyour vehicle.

*[SV31400(BEF )02/95] Use chains on the tires only in an emergency orif the law requires them where you live. If youchoose to use chains on your vehicle’s tires, beaware of the following:

*[SV31500(BEF )01/95] ❑Make sure the chains are the right size foryour tires. Use only SAE Class “S” chains.Other types may damage your vehicle.

*[SV31600(BEF )01/95] ❑Put the chains on tightly with the ends helddown securely. Verify that no chain touchesany wiring, brake lines, or fuel lines. Followthe chain manufacturer’s instructions.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 317: 1996 econoline

319

*[SV31700(BEF )01/95] ❑Drive slowly. If you can hear the chains rubor bang against your vehicle, stop the vehicleand tighten the chains. If you continue tohear the chains rub or bang against yourvehicle, remove the chains to prevent damageto your vehicle.

*[SV31800(BEF )10/94] ❑Avoid fully loading your vehicle if possible.

*[SV31900(BEF )05/94] ❑Remove tire chains at the first opportunityafter using them on snow and ice. Do not usethe chains on dry roads.

*[SV31950(BEF )05/91] ❑Make sure your suspension insulation andbumpers are not missing or worn to avoiddamage to your vehicle.

%*[SV31975(BEF )04/95] Cleaning the Wheels

*[SV31980(BEF )05/95] Wash the wheels with the same detergent youuse to wash your vehicle’s body. Do not useacid-based wheel cleaners, steel wool, abrasives,fuel, or strong detergents. These substances willdamage protective coatings. Use tar and road oilremover to remove grease and tar.

*[SV31985(BEF )04/95] NOTE: Before going to a car wash, find out ifthe brushes are abrasive.

*[SV32100( ALL)03/95] Battery

*[SV32200( ALL)02/95] Your vehicle may have a Motorcraftmaintenance-free battery. When the originalequipment battery is replaced under warranty, itmay be replaced by a MotorcraftLow-Maintenance Battery.

*[SV32500( ALL)06/95] The Low-Maintenance Battery has removablevent caps for checking the electrolyte level andfor adding water, if necessary. The electrolytelevel should be checked at least every 24 monthsor 24,000 miles (40,000 km) in temperatures upto 90˚F (32˚C) and more often in temperatures

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 318: 1996 econoline

320

above 90˚F (32˚C). Keep the electrolyte level ineach cell up to the level indicator. Do notoverfill.

*[SV32700( ALL)02/95] If the level gets low, you can add tap water tothe battery, provided the water isn’t hard ordoesn’t have a high mineral or alkali content.However, if possible you should refill the batterywith distilled water. If the battery needs waterquite often, have the charging system checkedfor a possible malfunction.

*[SV32725( ALL)03/95] Help Us Protect Our Environment

*[SV32750( ALL)04/95] Ford Motor Company strongly recommends thatused lead-acid batteries be returned to anauthorized recycling facility for disposal.

*[SV32775( ALL)03/95]

one inch art:0000983-A

Battery recycling symbol

% [SV32800( E )03/91] Auxiliary Battery (Optional —Low-Maintenance)

% [SV32900( E )01/89] Checking the fluid level

*[SV33000( E )06/95] The Low-Maintenance Battery has removablevent caps for checking the electrolyte level andfor adding water, if necessary. The electrolytelevel should be checked at least every 24 monthsor 24,000 miles (40,000 km) in temperatures upto 90˚F (32˚C) and more often in temperaturesabove 90˚F (32˚C). Keep the electrolyte level ineach cell up to the level indicator. Do notoverfill.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 319: 1996 econoline

321

*[SV33100( E )02/95] If the level gets low, you can add tap water tothe battery, provided the water isn’t hard ordoesn’t have a high mineral or alkali content.However, if possible you should refill the batterywith distilled water. If the battery needs waterquite often, have the charging system checkedfor a possible malfunction.

*[SV33200( ALL)01/95] RWARNING

Batteries normally produce explosive gaseswhich can cause personal injury.Therefore, do not allow flames, sparks orlit tobacco to come near the battery. Whencharging or working near a battery, alwayscover your face and protect your eyes, andalso provide ventilation.

%*[SV33300( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Batteries contain sulfuric acid which burnsskin, eyes, and clothing.

*[SV33305( ALL)06/95] If the acid touches someone’s skin, eyes, orclothing, immediately flush the area with waterfor at least 15 minutes. If someone swallows theacid, have him or her drink lots of milk or waterfirst, then Milk of Magnesia, a beaten egg, orvegetable oil. Call a doctor immediately.

%*[SV33400( ALL)06/95] RWARNING

Applying too much pressure on the endswhen lifting a battery could cause acid tospill. Lift the battery with a carrier orwith your hands on the opposite corners.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 320: 1996 econoline

322

*[SV33500( ALL)01/95] Automatic Transmission Fluid

*[SV33601(BEF )06/95] Under normal driving conditions automatictransmission fluid should be changed every30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 21,000 miles(34,000 km) if under severe duty conditions.However, if the transmission is not workingproperly, for instance, the transmission may slipor shift slowly, or you may notice some sign offluid leakage, the fluid level should be checked.

[SV33605(BEF )06/95] NOTE: Except E4OD transmission, there is no30,000 mile (48,000 km) sheduledtransmission fluid change requirement.

[SV33615( ALL)05/95] Transmission fluid, filter and seal assemblyshould be changed every 21,000 miles(34,000 km) only under any of the followingconditions.

[SV33620( ALL)04/95] ❑Extended periods of high speed drivingduring hot weather at/or above +90˚F(+30˚C).

[SV33625( ALL)06/95] ❑Towing a trailer for distances over 1,000 miles(1,600 km) per trip.

[SV33630( ALL)04/95] ❑Accumulating 5,000 miles (8,000 km) or moreper month.

[SV33635( ALL)04/95] ❑Continuous operation and/or extensive idling(a delivery service as an example).

[SV33640( ALL)04/95] ❑Operating in severe dust conditions.

[SV33645( ALL)04/95] NOTE: Use of a transmission fluid other thanspecified could result in transmissionmalfunction and/or failure. Refer to“Adding automatic transmission fluid”,“Refill capacities” and “lubricantspecifications” for further information.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 321: 1996 econoline

323

%*[SV33651( ALL)02/95] Checking the Automatic TransmissionFluid

*[SV33701( ALL)05/95] It is preferable to check the transmission fluidlevel at normal operating temperature150˚F-170˚F (66˚C-77˚C), after approximately 20miles (30 km) of driving. However, if necessary,you can check the fluid level without having todrive 20 miles (30 km) to obtain a normaloperating temperature if outside temperaturesare above 50˚F (10˚C).

*[SV33801( ALL)01/95] NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for anextended period at high speeds or incity traffic during hot weather, orpulling a trailer, the vehicle should beturned off for about 30 minutes toallow the fluid to cool before checking.

*[SV33910( ALL)06/95] With the vehicle on a level surface, start theengine and move the transmission shift selectorthrough all of the gear ranges allowing sufficienttime for each position to engage. Securely latchthe transmission shift selector in the P (Park)position, fully set the parking brake and leavethe engine running.

*[SV33930( ALL)10/89] RWARNING

Your vehicle should not be driven if thefluid level is below the bottom hole onthe dipstick and outside temperatures areabove 50˚F (10˚C).

*[SV33940( ALL)02/95] Wipe off the dipstick cap, pull the dipstick outand wipe the indicator end clean. Put thedipstick back into the filler tube and make sureit is fully seated. Pull the dipstick out and readthe fluid level.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 322: 1996 econoline

324

*[SV33950( ALL)03/90] When checking fluid at normal operatingtemperature, the fluid level should be within thecrosshatched area on the dipstick. When thevehicle has not been driven, and outsidetemperature is above 50˚F (10˚C), the fluid levelshould be between the holes on the dipstick.

%*[SV33960( ALL)05/95] Adding Automatic Transmission Fluid

*[SV33970( ALL)03/94] The fluid type is stamped on the dipstick. Beforeadding any fluid, be sure that the correct typewill be used.

*[SV33980( ALL)10/89] Add fluid in 1/2 pint (.25L) increments throughthe filler tube to bring the level to the correctarea on the dipstick. If an overfill occurs, excessfluid should be removed by a qualifiedtechnician.

%*[SV33990( ALL)04/95] NOTE: Always dispose of used automotivefluids in a responsible manner. Followyour community’s standards fordisposing of these types of fluids. Callyour local recycling center to find outabout recycling automotive fluids.

*[SV34100( EF )03/94]

one third page art:0020946-A

Automatic transmission dipstick

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 323: 1996 econoline

325

[SV34200( E )03/93]

half page art:0020374-C

Automatic transmission dipstick location

[SV34300( E )12/91]

one third page art:0020375-B

Automatic transmission dipstick location

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 324: 1996 econoline

326

%*[SV35800( ALL)03/91] Driveline Universal Joint andSlip Yoke

*[SV36000(BEF )06/93] The universal joints that come standard withyour vehicle do not require lubrication. If youroriginal equipment universal joints are replacedwith universal joints equipped with greasefittings, lubrication will be necessary at theintervals shown in the Maintenance Schedule andRecord booklet.

*[SV36300( ALL)03/95] Brake Fluid*[SV36350( ALL)05/90] Your vehicle is equipped with a brake fluid level

indicator in the master cylinder which lights theBRAKE warning light on the instrument panelwhen the brake fluid level is low.

*[SV36400( ALL)04/95] Under normal circumstances, your vehicleshould not use up brake fluid rapidly. However,expect the level of the brake fluid to slowly fallas you put more mileage on your vehicle andthe brake lining wears.

*[SV36500( ALL)10/89] Check the brake fluid at least once a year. Youcan do this by looking at the fluid level in theplastic reservoir on the master cylinder. Thefluid level should be at or near the MAX mark.

*[SV36550( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Brake fluid is toxic.

*[SV36560( ALL)06/95] If brake fluid contacts eyes, flush eyes withrunning water for 15 minutes. Get medicalattention if irritation persists. If taken internally,drink water and induce vomiting. Get medicalattention immediately.

%*[SV36600( ALL)02/95] If the fluid is low, carefully clean and removethe filler cap from the reservoir. Fill thereservoir to the MAX line with Ford HighPerformance DOT 3 Brake Fluid C6AZ-19542-AAor DOT 3 equivalent fluid meeting Fordspecification ESA-M6C25-A.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 325: 1996 econoline

327

*[SV36850( ALL)12/91] NOTE: If brake fluid is spilled on paintedsurfaces, it must be flushed and wipedaway immediately. Brake fluid maydissolve the paint finish on yourvehicle.

*[SV36900( ALL)01/95] RWARNING

If you use a brake fluid that is not DOT3, you will cause permanent damage toyour brakes.

*[SV37000( ALL)01/95] Do not fill the reservoir above the MAX line.

*[SV37100( ALL)01/95] If you find that the fluid level is excessively low— below the seam or ridge on the outside of theplastic reservoir — have the brake systeminspected.

*[SV37200( ALL)01/95] RWARNING

Do not let the reservoir for the mastercylinder run dry. This may cause thebrakes to fail.

*[SV37400(BEF )01/89]

quarter page art:0020381-A

Brake master cylinder

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 326: 1996 econoline

328

*[SV37600( ALL)03/95] Power Steering Fluid

*[SV37700( ALL)01/95] Check the level of the power steering fluid atleast twice a year (i.e., every Spring and Fall).

*[SV37800( ALL)03/95] To check the level of your power steering fluid:

*[SV37900( ALL)02/95] 1. Start the engine and let it run until thepower steering fluid reaches normaloperating temperature. The power steeringfluid will be at the right temperature whenthe engine coolant temperature gauge in theinstrument cluster is near the center of theNORMAL operating temperature range.

*[SV38000( ALL)01/95] 2. While the engine idles, turn the steeringwheel back and forth several times. Makesure that the cap assembly is installed at thistime.

*[SV38100(BEF )05/95] 3. Turn the engine off.

[SV38150( E)10/95] All vehicles except E-Super Duty:

%*[SV38200( ALL)03/94] 4. Check the fluid level on the dipstick (whichis highlighted in yellow in your vehicle). Thefluid level should be between the arrows inthe FULL HOT range, which is marked onthe side of the dipstick, opposite the sidemarked FULL COLD. Do not add fluid if thelevel is within the FULL HOT range.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 327: 1996 econoline

329

*[SV38250( ALL)03/94]

one third page art:0021016-B

Power steering dipstick

[SV38700( E )08/91]

quarter page art:0020387-A

Power steering reservoir

*[SV38800( ALL)07/94] 5. If the power steering fluid is low, add fluidin small amounts, continuously checking thelevel, until you reach the FULL HOT range.Do not overfill.

*[SV38850( ALL)03/95] 6. When you are finished, put the dipstick backin and make sure that it fits snugly.

*[SV38855( ALL)02/95] If you check the power steering fluid when it iscold, make sure that the fluid reaches the FULLCOLD range on the dipstick. The reading willonly be accurate if the fluid temperature isapproximately 50˚F to 85˚F (10˚C to 30˚C).

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 328: 1996 econoline

330

[SV38860(E )10/95] E-Super Duty vehicles:

[SV38870( E)10/95] 4. Check the fluid level in the power steeringfluid reservoir. The fluid level should bebetween the MIN and MAX lines on the sideof the reservoir.

[SV38880( E)10/95] 5. If the power steering fluid is below the MINmark, add fluid in small amounts until thelevel is between the MIN and MAX lines onthe side of the reservoir.

[SV38890(E )10/95]

half page art:0021528-A

Power steering reservoir

*[SV38895( E)10/95] If you check the power steering fluid when it iscold, make sure that the fluid reaches the MINon the reservoir. The reading will only beaccurate if the fluid temperature isapproximately 50˚F to 85˚F (10˚C to 30˚C).

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 329: 1996 econoline

331

*[SV38900(BEF )01/95] Use only power steering fluid that:

%*[SV39000(BEF )01/95] ❑meets Ford’s Specification, such as MerconHAutomatic Transmission Fluid.

*[SV39200( ALL)01/95] If the power steering fluid is low, do not driveyour vehicle for a long period of time beforeadding fluid. This can damage the powersteering pump.

*[SV39405( ALL)06/93] NOTE: Do not turn the steering wheel of yourvehicle with the engine off. It couldforce power steering fluid out from thereservoir cap or in extreme cases, itcould unseat the cap.

*[SV39500( ALL)04/95] Fuses, Fuse Links and CircuitBreakers

*[SV39600( E )12/91] Fuses and circuit breakers protect your vehicle’selectrical system from overloading. If electricalparts in your vehicle are not working, thesystem may have been overloaded and blown afuse or tripped a circuit breaker. Before youreplace or repair any electrical parts, check theappropriate fuses or circuit breakers.

*[SV39700( ALL)10/89] The following charts tell you which fuses orcircuit breakers protect each electrical part ofyour vehicle. If a fuse blows or a circuit breakeropens a circuit, all the parts of your vehicle thatuse that circuit will not work.

*[SV39800( ALL)06/95] Once you have determined which fuses or circuitbreakers to check, follow the procedures underChecking and replacing fuses or Checking andreplacing circuit breakers later in this chapter.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 330: 1996 econoline

332

%[SV40300(E)05/94]

fullpageart:0020392-I

Fuses/circu

itb

reakers

and

their

locations

File:14ltsve.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 331: 1996 econoline

333

[SV40400( E )02/95]

thirty pica chart:0021000-F

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 332: 1996 econoline

334

[SV40500( E )02/95]

thirty-six pica chart:00210

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 333: 1996 econoline

335

[SV41000( E )02/95]

thirty-six pica chart:002039

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 334: 1996 econoline

336

[SV41300( ALL)06/95] Power Distribution Box

*[SV41400( ALL)10/92] The high current fuses contained in the PowerDistribution Box protect your vehicle’s mainelectrical systems from overloads; these fusesprovide the connection between the battery andyour vehicle’s electrical systems.

*[SV41500( ALL)10/92] The high current fuses are coded as follows: 30amp -light green, 40 amp - orange, 50 amp - red,60 amp -blue.

*[SV41600( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Always disconnect the battery beforeservicing high current fuses.

*[SV41620( ALL)05/95] Ford recommends that high current fuses bereplaced by a qualified technician.

*[SV41700( ALL)03/93] RWARNING

Always replace the cover to the PowerDistribution Box before reconnecting thebattery or refilling fluid reservoirs.

*[SV41800( ALL)04/95] A blown high current fuse may be replaced butwill continue to blow until the cause of theoverload condition is corrected.

*[SV41900( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Always replace a fuse with one that hasthe specified amperage rating. Using afuse with a higher amperage rating cancause severe wire damage and could starta fire.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 335: 1996 econoline

337

[SV42175( E )07/94]

full page art:0020841-I

Power distribution box

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 336: 1996 econoline

338

[SV42190( E )03/91] Non-fuse panel circuit protection

[SV42195( E )02/95]

twelve pica chart:0020853-E

%*[SV42200( ALL)06/95] Checking and Replacing Fuses

*[SV42300( ALL)02/95] If you need to check a fuse, follow these steps:

[SV42950( E )02/91] 1. You can access the fuse panel through thesteering column lower opening. Remove thecover using the quick release fasteners.

*[SV43300( ALL)06/95] 2. On the fuse panel cover, find the number ofthe fuse you want to check. The diagram onthe cover tells you where to locate the fuseon the panel.

*[SV43400( ALL)06/95] 3. Check the fuse to see if it is blown. Lookthrough the clear side of the fuse to see ifthe metal wire inside is separated. If it is,the fuse is blown and should be replaced.

*[SV43500( ALL)06/95]

quarter page art:0020405-A

The side view of a fuse

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 337: 1996 econoline

339

*[SV43600( ALL)06/95] 4. Replace the fuse with one that has the rightamperage rating (see previous chart).

*[SV43700( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Always replace a fuse with one that hasthe specified amperage rating. Using afuse with a higher amperage rating cancause severe wire damage and could starta fire.

*[SV43800( ALL)06/95] 5. Put the fuse panel cover back on.

*[SV44000( ALL)05/93] Even after you replace a fuse, it will continue toblow if you do not find what caused theoverload. If the fuse continues to blow, haveyour electrical system checked.

%*[SV44100( ALL)03/95] Circuit Breakers

*[SV44200(BEF )06/95] If you need to check a circuit breaker on thefuse panel, see Checking and replacing fuses tofind out how to locate the fuse panel. Otherwise,locate the circuit breaker according to theinstructions on the charts given earlier in thischapter.

*[SV44300( ALL)02/95] Since you need diagnostic equipment to checkwhether a circuit breaker works and suchequipment comes with instructions, we do notdiscuss how to check circuit breakers.

*[SV44400( ALL)10/92] However, you should know that the circuitbreakers will reset themselves and allow theelectrical parts to work again once the overloadon the circuit is removed. If the circuit breakerscontinue to cut off electricity, have your vehicle’selectrical system checked.

*[SV44500( ALL)06/95] If you replace a circuit breaker, use one with thesame amperage rating. To remove a circuitbreaker mounted in the fuse panel, grip it withyour finger and thumb and pull it straight outof its socket.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 338: 1996 econoline

340

*[SV44600(BEF )03/95] Lights and Bulb Replacement

*[SV44700(BEF )01/95] It is a good idea to check the operation of thefollowing lights frequently:

*[SV44800(BEF )01/95] ❑headlamps

*[SV44900(BEF )01/95] ❑ tail lamps

*[SV45000(BEF )01/95] ❑brakelamps

*[SV45050(BEF )02/95] ❑high-mount brakelamp

*[SV45100(BEF )01/95] ❑hazard flasher

*[SV45200(BEF )01/95] ❑ turn signals

*[SV45300(BEF )01/95] ❑ license plate lamp

%*[SV45400(BEF )01/95] The alignment of your headlamps should bechecked if:

*[SV45500(BEF )01/95] ❑oncoming motorists frequently signal you toturn off your vehicle’s high beams when youdo not have the high beams on

*[SV45600(BEF )01/95] ❑ the headlamps do not seem to give youenough light to see clearly at night

*[SV45700(BEF )01/95] ❑ the headlamp beams are pointed substantiallyaway from a position slightly down and tothe right

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 339: 1996 econoline

341

*[SV45800(BEF )03/95] Headlamp Bulb

[SV45850( E )12/91] Hi series (Aerodynamic)

*[SV45900(BEF )01/95] The headlamps on your vehicle use replaceablebulbs. When the lamp burns out, simply replacethe bulb, rather than the whole lamp.

*[SV46000(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

Handle a halogen headlamp bulb carefullyand keep out of children’s reach. Graspthe bulb only by its plastic base and donot touch the glass. The oil from yourhand could cause the bulb to break thenext time the headlamps are operated.

*[SV46050(BEF )12/91] NOTE: If the bulb is accidently touched, itshould be cleaned with rubbingalcohol before being used.

*[SV46100(BEF )01/95] Do not remove the burned-out bulb unless youcan immediately replace it with a new one. If abulb is removed for an extended period of time,contaminants may enter the headlamp housingand affect its performance.

*[SV46200(BEF )03/91]

one third page art:0020406-B

Parts of a headlamp

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 340: 1996 econoline

342

*[SV46300(BEF )03/95] Removing the headlamp bulb

*[SV46400(BEF )01/95] 1. Make sure that the headlamp switch on theinstrument panel is in the OFF position.

[SV46550( E )04/95] 2. Lift the hood and fix in up position usingprop rod.

[SV46600( E )04/95] 3. Bend back slightly and lift up on the twometal tabs while holding the lamp to vehicle.This will release the lamp from the installedposition.

[SV46650( E )05/91]

one third page art:0020844-B

Removing/Installing the headlamp bulb

[SV46750( E )04/95] 4. Remove the bulb retaining ring by turning it1/8 of a turn to free it from the socket. Thenslide the ring off the plastic base. Keep thering. You must use it again to hold the newbulb in place.

[SV46850( E )04/95] 5. Carefully remove the bulb assembly from itssocket by gently pulling it rearward withoutturning.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 341: 1996 econoline

343

*[SV46900(BEF )03/95] Installing the headlamp bulb

*[SV47000(BEF )02/95] 1. With the flat side of the bulb’s plastic basefacing upward, insert the glass end of thebulb into the socket. You may need to turnthe bulb left or right to line up the groovesin the plastic base with the tabs in thesocket. When the grooves are aligned, pushthe bulb into the socket until the plastic basecontacts the rear of the socket.

*[SV47100(BEF )02/95] 2. Slip the bulb retaining ring over the plasticbase until it contacts the rear of the socket.Lock the ring into the socket by rotating itclockwise until you feel a “stop”.

[SV47250( E )12/91] 3. Reposition the three adjuster screws into theretaining holes and hold while pushing thetwo black tabs downward to engage theends of the adjuster screws. You will hear a“snap” when the tabs are properly engaged.Make sure lamp is secured properly bypulling it forward. If it is loose, removelamp and reinstall.

*[SV47300(BEF )02/95] 4. Turn the headlamps on and make sure thatthey work properly. If the headlamp wascorrectly aligned before you changed thebulb, you should not need to align it again.

*[SV47406( E )02/95] High-Mount Brakelamp Bulbs

[SV47410( E )03/91] E-150 — E-350 without cargo lamp attached

[SV47420( E )03/91] To remove/install or replace a bulb:

[SV47430( E )03/91] 1. Remove the two screws that secure the lampand lift up from the vehicle.

[SV47440( E )03/91] 2. Remove the socket that contains theburned-out bulb and replace the bulb.

[SV47450( E )03/91] 3. To install a bulb, reverse the proceduresabove.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 342: 1996 econoline

344

[SV47460( E )03/91] E-150 — E-350 with cargo lamp attached

[SV47470( E )03/91] To remove/install or replace a bulb:

[SV47480( E )03/91] 1. Remove the two screws that secure theHi-mount stop lamp/cargo lamp and lift theassembly from the vehicle.

[SV47490( E )03/91] 2. After removing the two screws that securethe lens, remove the cargo lamp lens.

[SV47501( E )03/91] 3. Remove the two screws attaching the cargolamp to the Hi-mount stop lamp.

[SV47510( E )03/91] 4. Remove or replace the burned-out bulb(s) inthe Hi-mount stop lamp.

[SV47520( E )03/91] 5. To install a bulb, reverse the proceduresabove.

[SV47530( E )12/91]

half page art:0020852-B

Replacing the stop lamp bulb

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 343: 1996 econoline

345

[SV47625(BEF )06/95] Bulb Specifications

[SV47900( E )04/95]

thirty-six pica chart:0

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 344: 1996 econoline

346

[SV47950( E )05/91]

six pica chart:0020500-F

*[SV48400( E )10/90] Rear lighting wire functions

[SV48500( E )12/91]

twelve pica chart:0020416-B

*[SV48600( ALL)03/95] Emission Control System

*[SV48700(BEF )05/95] Your vehicle is equipped with a catalyticconverter which enables your vehicle to complywith applicable exhaust emission requirements.

*[SV48725( ALL)06/95] RWARNING

Exhaust leaks may result in the entry ofharmful and potentially lethal fumes intothe passenger compartment. Underextreme conditions excessive exhausttemperatures could damage the fuelsystem, the interior floor covering, orother vehicle components, possiblycausing a fire.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 345: 1996 econoline

347

*[SV48800(BEF )05/95] To make sure that the catalytic converter and theother emission control parts continue to workproperly:

*[SV48900( ALL)01/95] ❑Use only unleaded fuel.

*[SV49000( ALL)01/95] ❑Avoid running out of fuel.

*[SV49100( ALL)01/95] ❑Do not turn off the ignition while yourvehicle is moving, especially at high speeds.

*[SV49200( ALL)03/95] ❑Have the services listed in the MaintenanceSchedule and Record booklet performedaccording to the specified schedule. Thescheduled maintenance services are requiredbecause they are considered essential to thelife and performance of your vehicle and toits emissions system.

*[SV49250( ALL)03/95] In general, maintenance, replacement, or serviceof the emissions control devices or systems inyour new Ford Motor Company vehicle orengine may be performed at your expense byany automotive repair establishment orindividual using automotive parts equivalent tothose which your vehicle or engine wasoriginally equipped.

*[SV49300( ALL)05/95] RWARNING

Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle indry grass or other dry ground cover. Theemission system heats up the enginecompartment and exhaust system, whichcan start a fire.

*[SV49400(BEF )05/95] RWARNING

On vehicles without original equipmentfloor covering or insulation, do not letpassengers ride in your truck in a mannerthat allows contact between skin and themetal floor.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 346: 1996 econoline

348

*[SV49450( ALL)05/95] If other than Ford or Motorcraft or Fordauthorized remanufactured parts are used formaintenance, replacement, or for the service ofcomponents affecting emissions control, theowner should be assured that such parts arewarranted by their manufacturer to beequivalent to genuine Ford Motor Companyparts in performance and durability. Pleaseconsult your warranty information booklet forcomplete warranty information.

*[SV49500(BEF )05/95] Watch for fluid leaks, strange odors, smoke, lossof oil pressure, the charge warning light, thecheck engine light, or the temperature warninglight. These sometimes indicate that the emissionsystem is not working properly.

*[SV49600( ALL)01/95] Do not make any unauthorized changes to yourvehicle or engine. Changes that cause moreunburned fuel to reach the exhaust system canincrease the temperature of the engine orexhaust system.

*[SV49700( ALL)01/95] By law, anyone who manufactures, repairs,services, sells, leases, trades vehicles, orsupervises a fleet of vehicles is not permitted tointentionally remove an emission control deviceor prevent it from working. In some of theUnited States and in Canada, vehicle ownersmay be liable if their emission control device isremoved or is prevented from working.

*[SV49900( ALL)01/95] Do not drive your vehicle if it does not operateproperly. See your dealer if the engine runs onfor more than five seconds after you shut it offor if it misfires, surges, stalls, or backfires.

%*[SV50000( ALL)05/95] Information about your vehicle’s emissioncontrol system is on the Vehicle EmissionControl Information decal located on or near theengine. This decal identifies engine displacementand gives some tune-up specifications.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 347: 1996 econoline

349

*[SV50050( EF )10/90] NOTE: All current model year vehicles arecertified to the same year emissionsstandards except certain vehiclesequipped with engines built prior toJanuary 1 of the model year which maybe certified to prior year emissionsstandards. In either case, themaintenance schedules contained in theback of this Owner Guide must beused to maintain your engine.

%*[SV50100( EFM)01/89] Noise emissions warranty, prohibitedtampering acts

[SV50300( E )03/93] On January 1, 1978, Federal regulations becameeffective governing the noise emissions on truckswith a GVWR of over 10,000 lbs (4,536 kgs). Thefollowing statements concerning prohibitedtampering acts and the noise warranty are foundin the Warranty Information Booklet, and areapplicable to completed Econoline cutaways witha GVWR of over 10,000 lbs (4,536 kgs).

*[SV50400( EFM)01/89] Do not tamper with the noise controlsystem

*[SV50500( EFM)01/89] Federal law prohibits the following acts:

*[SV50600( EFM)01/89] 1. The removal or dismantlement, (by anyperson unless for maintenance, repair orreplacement purposes) of any device ordesign element incorporated into any newvehicle to control noise output, prior to itssale or delivery to the consumer, or while itis being used, or

*[SV50700( EFM)01/89] 2. Using your light truck after a device ordesign element has been removed ordismantled, by any person.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 348: 1996 econoline

350

*[SV50800( EFM)01/89] The following are some of the acts that areconsidered tampering:

[SV51000( E )01/89] ❑Removing the hood liner, fender apronabsorbers, fender apron barriers, under bodynoise shield or material constructed to absorbnoise output.

*[SV51100( EFM)01/89] ❑Removing or dismantling the engine speedgovernor, so that the engine’s speed exceedsthe manufacturer’s specifications.

*[SV51200( EFM)01/89] ❑Removing the air duct, air intake choke orsilencer, air cleaner and/or air cleanerelement.

*[SV51300( EFM)01/89] ❑Removing or dismantling any of the exhaustsystem components including the catalystinlet pipe, muffler, outlet pipe, resonator ordiffuser.

*[SV51400( EFM)01/89] ❑Removing the fan shroud. Removing ordismantling the fan clutch so that it no longerfunctions properly.

*[SV51450( EFM)04/89] Maintenance

*[SV51455( EFM)06/93] Instructions for maintenance and service of thenoise control system have been included in theMaintenance Schedule and Record booklet and inthe “General Maintenance Checklist.” To aid thenoise control system throughout the life of thevehicle, Ford Motor Company recommends thatthis vehicle should be operated according to theOwner’s Guide. When installing replacementparts, use caution not to violate the tamperingact as described above. Use the MaintenanceRecord Log to list any inspections and servicesperformed on the vehicle.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 349: 1996 econoline

351

%*[SV51456( ALL)06/95] Readiness for Inspection/MaintenanceTesting

*[SV51457( ALL)06/95] In some localities it may become a legalrequirement to pass anInspection/Maintenance (I/M) test of theOn-Board Diagnostic (OBD) II system. If thevehicle’s powertrain system or its battery hasjust been serviced, the OBD II system is reset toa not ready for I/M testing condition. Toprepare for I/M testing, the law specifies a“need for additional mixed city and highwaydriving to complete the check” of the OBD IIsystem. As soon as all of the OBD II systemchecks are successfully completed, the OBD IIsystem is set to the ready condition. The amountof driving required to reach the ready conditionvaries with individual driving patterns. Tocomplete this requirement in the minimumamount of time, refer to the OBD II Drive Cycledefined below. If the vehicle owner cannot ordoes not want to do the additional drivingrequired by law, a service center can performthis drive cycle as it would any other type ofrepair work.

[SV51458( ALL)05/95] OBD II Drive Cycle

*[SV51459( ALL)05/95] The engine must be warmed up and atoperating temperature before proceeding withthe drive modes of the following OBD II DriveCycle.

*[SV51461( ALL)05/95] 1. Start the engine. Drive or idle (in neutral)the vehicle for 4 minutes.

[SV51463( ALL)04/95] 2. Idle the vehicle in drive (neutral for manualtransmission) for 40 seconds.

*[SV51465( ALL)06/95] 3. Accelerate the vehicle to 45 mph (70 km/h)at 1/4 to 1/2 throttle for 10 seconds.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 350: 1996 econoline

352

*[SV51467( ALL)06/95] 4. Drive the vehicle with a steady throttle at45 mph (70 km/h) for 30 seconds.

*[SV51469( ALL)05/95] 5. Idle the vehicle in Drive (Neutral for manualtransmissions) for 40 seconds.

*[SV51471( ALL)06/95] 6. Continue to drive the vehicle in city traffic atspeeds between 25 and 40 mph(40-60 km/h) for 15 minutes. During the 15minute drive cycle the following modes mustbe achieved:

*[SV51473( ALL)06/95] a. at least 5 stop and idle modes at 10seconds each

*[SV51475( ALL)06/95] b. acceleration from idles at 1/4 to 1/2throttle position, and

*[SV51477( ALL)06/95] c. choose 3 different speeds to do 1.5minute steady state throttle drives.

*[SV51479( ALL)06/95] 7. Accelerate the vehicle up to between 45 and60 mph (70-100 km/h). This should takeapproximately 5 minutes.

*[SV51481( ALL)06/95] 8. Drive vehicle and hold the throttle steady atthe selected speed between 45 and 60 mph(70-100 km/h) for approximately 5 minutes.

*[SV51483( ALL)06/95] 9. Drive the vehicle for 5 minutes at varyingspeeds between 45 and 60 mph(70-100 km/h).

*[SV51485( ALL)06/95] 10. Bring the vehicle back to idle. Idle in Drivefor 40 seconds.

*[SV51487( ALL)06/95] 11. OBD II drive cycle has been completed.Vehicle can be turned off when convenient.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 351: 1996 econoline

353

*[SV51500( ALL)03/95] Refill Capacities, Motorcraft Parts,and Lubricant Specifications

*[SV51600( ALL)03/95] Refill Capacities

*[SV51650( EF )05/89] NOTE: Refer to the Diesel Engine Owner’sGuide Supplement for refill capacitieson diesel engines.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 352: 1996 econoline

354

[SV52100( E )05/95]

thirty-six pica chart:00

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 353: 1996 econoline

355

[SV52200( E )03/94]

twenty-two pica chart:00204

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 354: 1996 econoline

356

*[SV52800( ALL)05/95] Motorcraft Parts

[SV53200( E )05/95]

eighteen pica chart:0020431

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 355: 1996 econoline

357

%*[SV53500(ALL)05/95]

Lu

brican

tS

pecification

s%[SV54500(E)05/95]

thirty-sixpicachart:00204

File:14ltsve.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 356: 1996 econoline

358

[SV54600(E)05/95]

thirty-sixpicachart:0020

File:14ltsve.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 357: 1996 econoline

359

[SV54650(E)04/95]

thirty-sixpicachart:00

File:14ltsve.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 358: 1996 econoline

360

[SV54670(E)03/94]

thirty-sixpicachart:002

File:14ltsve.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 359: 1996 econoline

361

*[SV56000( ALL)01/95] Vehicle Storage

*[SV56100( ALL)01/95] Maintenance Tips

*[SV56150( ALL)01/95] If you plan on storing your vehicle for anextended period of time (60 days or more), referto the following maintenance recommendationsto ensure your vehicle stays in good operatingcondition.

*[SV56200( ALL)01/95] General

*[SV56300( ALL)01/95] ❑Store all vehicles in a dry, ventilated place.

*[SV56400( ALL)01/95] ❑Protect from sunlight, if possible.

*[SV56500( ALL)01/95] ❑ If vehicles are stored outside, they requireregular maintenance to protect against rustand damage.

*[SV56600( ALL)01/95] Body

*[SV56700( ALL)01/95] ❑Wash vehicle thoroughly to remove dirt,grease, oil, tar or mud from exterior surfaces,rear wheel housing and underside of frontfenders.

*[SV56800( ALL)01/95] ❑Periodically wash vehicles stored in exposedlocations.

*[SV56900( ALL)01/95] ❑Touch-up raw or primed metal to preventrust.

*[SV57000( ALL)01/95] ❑Cover chrome and stainless steel parts with athick coat of auto wax to preventdiscoloration. Re-wax as necessary when thevehicle is washed.

*[SV57100( ALL)04/95] ❑Lubricate all hood, door and trunk lid hingesand latches with a light grade oil.

*[SV57200( ALL)01/95] ❑Cover interior soft trim to prevent fading.

*[SV57300( ALL)01/95] ❑Keep all rubber parts free from oil andsolvents.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 360: 1996 econoline

362

%*[SV57350( ALL)01/95] Engine

*[SV57400( ALL)01/95] ❑Start engine every 15 days. Run at fast idleuntil it reaches normal operating temperature.

*[SV57500( ALL)01/95] ❑With your foot on the brake, shift through allthe gears while the engine is running.

%*[SV57600( ALL)01/95] Fuel system

%*[SV57700( ALL)07/94] ❑Fill fuel tank with high-quality unleaded fueluntil the first automatic shutoff of the fuelpump nozzle.

*[SV57900( ALL)03/95] NOTE: During extended periods of vehiclestorage (60 days or more), fuel maydeteriorate due to oxidation. This candamage rubber and other polymers inthe fuel system and may also clogsmall orifices.

*[SV58000( ALL)01/95] Ford Gas Stabilizer should be added wheneveractual or expected storage periods exceed 60days. Follow the instructions on the label. Thevehicle should then be operated at idle speed tocirculate the additive throughout the fuel system.

*[SV58050( EF )05/94] NOTE: Read the 7.3L Diesel Engine OwnerGuide Supplement for informationregarding vehicle storage for yourdiesel-powered vehicle.

*[SV58100( ALL)01/95] A volatile corrosion inhibitor added to the fuelsystem will protect the fuel system’s innersurfaces from corrosion. Follow the instructionspackaged with the product.

%*[SV58200( ALL)01/95] Cooling system

*[SV58300( ALL)01/95] ❑Protect against freezing temperatures.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 361: 1996 econoline

363

%*[SV58400( ALL)01/95] Battery

*[SV58500( ALL)01/95] ❑Check and recharge as necessary.

*[SV58600( ALL)01/95] ❑Keep connections clean and covered with alight coat of grease.

%*[SV58700( ALL)01/95] Brakes

*[SV58800( ALL)01/95] ❑Make sure brakes and parking brake are fullyreleased.

%*[SV58900( ALL)01/95] Tires

[SV59000( ALL)10/95] ❑Maintain recommended air pressures.

*[SV59100( ALL)01/95] Miscellaneous

*[SV59200( ALL)01/95] ❑Make sure all linkages, cables, levers andclevis pins under vehicle are covered withgrease to prevent rust.

*[SV59300( ALL)05/95] ❑Move vehicles at least 25 feet (10 m) every 15days to lubricate working parts to preventcorrosion.

File:14ltsve.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:40:13 1996

Page 362: 1996 econoline

369

[QI02500( E )05/95]

full page art:0021505-B

Warning label locations

File:15ltqie.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:37:06 1996

Page 363: 1996 econoline

370

[QI02800(E)06/93]

fullpageart:0021025-A

Front

exteriorview

File:15ltqie.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:37:06 1996

Page 364: 1996 econoline

371

[QI03400(E)06/93]

fullpageart:0021031-A

Rear

exteriorview

File:15ltqie.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:37:06 1996

Page 365: 1996 econoline

372

[QI04000(E)05/94]

fullpageart:0021037-C

En

trance

view

File:15ltqie.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:37:06 1996

Page 366: 1996 econoline

373

[QI04600(E)06/93]

fullpageart:0021043-A

Driver’s

door

File:15ltqie.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:37:06 1996

Page 367: 1996 econoline

374

[QI05200(E)06/93]

fullpageart:0021049-B

Instru

men

tp

anel

File:15ltqie.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:37:06 1996

Page 368: 1996 econoline

375

[QI05800(E)05/94]

fullpageart:0021055-B

Instru

men

tclu

ster

File:15ltqie.exU

pdate:W

ed A

pr 17 08:37:06 1996

Page 369: 1996 econoline

Inde x 377

Index

AABS warning light

(see Anti-loc k brake system). . . . . . . 70Accessory positio n on the ignitio n . . . 55–56Accessory power source,

power point outlet . . . . . . . . . . 148Additives , engine oil . . . . . . . . . . 297Air bag supplementa l restraint system . . . 29

and child safety seats. . . . . . . . . . 41descriptio n. . . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 31disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36driver air bag . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 31indicato r light . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31passenger air bag. . . . . . . . . . . . 31proper seating . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30service and informatio n label s. . . . . . 36tone generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32wearing safety belt s. . . . . . . . . . . 29

Air cleaner filterlocation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283specification s. . . . . . . . . . . . . 356

Air conditioningauxiliary heater and air conditione r . . . 91manual heatin g and air conditioning

system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87Alarm, activating remote personal . . . . 117Alcohol , in fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291Antenna, radio

(see Electroni c sound system) . . . 149, 190Antifreez e (see Engine coolant). . . . . . 301Anti-loc k brake system (ABS)

descriptio n. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209see also Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . 206warning light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70

Page 370: 1996 econoline

378 Index

Anti-theft systemarming the system . . . . . . . . . . 121description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121disarming an untriggered system . . . . 122disarming a triggered system. . . . . . 122triggering . . . . . . . . . . . . 121–122warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75

Appeals (see Dispute settlement board) . . 262Assistance (see Customer assistance). . . . 259Audio system

(see Electronic sound system) . . . . . 149Automatic transaxle, fluid,

refill capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . 353Automatic transmission

driving an automatic overdrive. 197, 199, 203driving a regular automatic . . . . . . 195fluid, adding . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324fluid, checking . . . . . . . . . . . . 323fluid, refill capacities . . . . . . . . . 353fluid, specification . . . . . . . . . . . 357

Axlelubricant specifications. . . . . . . . . 357refill capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . 353traction lok . . . . . . . . . . . . 216, 312

BBacking up . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197, 202Basic vehicle warranty . . . . . . . . . . . 4Battery

acid, treating emergencies . . . 244, 320–321auxiliary battery . . . . . . . . . . . 320charging system warning light . . . . . . 74disconnecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247how to service . . . . . . . . . . . . 319jumping a disabled battery . . . . . . . 243maintenance-free . . . . . . . . . . . 319proper disposal, recycling . . . . . . . 320replacement, specifications . . . . . . . 356servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320voltage gauge. . . . . . . . . . . . 74–75when storing your vehicle . . . . . . . 363

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 371: 1996 econoline

Index 379

Brake fluidbrake warning light . . . . . . . . . . . 69checking and adding . . . . . . . . . 326description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326

Brakelamp, high-mount brakelamp . . . 96, 343Brakes

adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206anti-lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206anti-lock brake system (ABS)

warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . 70applying the brakes . . . . . . . . . . 212brake warning light . . . . . . . . . . . 69fluid, checking and adding . . . . . . 326fluid, refill capacities . . . . . . . . . 353fluid, specifications . . . . . . . . . . 326front disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206if brakes do not grip well . . . . . . . 211master cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . 326new brake linings. . . . . . . . . . . . 8noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212power braking . . . . . . . . . . . . 206rear anti-lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211stopping distances . . . . . . . . . . 212trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238when storing your vehicle . . . . . . . 363

Brake-shift interlock . . . . . . . 60, 196, 202Break-in period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8Brights (high beams) . . . . . . . . . . . 77Bulbs, replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340

halogen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341high-mount brakelamp . . . . . . . . 343

CCanada, customer assistance . . . . . . . 268Canada, warranty information . . . . . . . 4Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan

(CAMVAP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 372: 1996 econoline

380 Index

Capacities for refilling fluids . . . . . . . 353Carbon monoxide in exhaust . . . . . . . . 65Car seats for children

(see Child safety seats) . . . . . . . . . 41Cassette tape player

(see Electronic sound system) 164, 170, 178, 184Catalytic converter. . . . . . . . . . . . 346CD player (see Electronic sound system). . 156Chains, tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318Changing a tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247Charging system gauge . . . . . . . . . . 75Charging system warning light . . . . . . . 74Child safety restraints . . . . . . . . . . . 38

child safety belts . . . . . . . . . . . . 40child safety seats . . . . . . . . . . . . 41

Child safety seatsand air bags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41attaching with tether straps . . . . . . . 53automatic locking mode (retractor) . . . . 41in front seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41in rear outboard seat . . . . . . . . . . 41tether anchorage hardware . . . . . . . . 53

Chimeheadlamps on. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77key in ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56safety belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71

Circuit breakerschecking and replacing . . . . . . . . 339see also fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331

Cleaning your vehicleCD player and discs. . . . . . . . . . 161chrome and aluminum parts . . . . . . . 10engine compartment. . . . . . . . . . 287exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9exterior lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93fabric . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93instrument panel lens . . . . . . . . . . 97interior lamps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97plastic parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10polishing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 373: 1996 econoline

Index 381

Cleaning your vehicle (continued)rustproofing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10safety belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28tail lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93upholstery and interior trim . . . . . . 141washing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319

Climate control systemair conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . 87heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87heating onlsystem. . . . . . . . . . . . 83heating only system. . . . . . . . . . . 83

Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156, 173, 189Cold engine starting. . . . . . . . . . . . 59Combination lap and shoulder belts . . 11, 14Compact disc player

(see Electronic sound system) . . . 150, 156Compact disc radio

(see Electronic sound system) . . . . . 150Console, description . . . . . . . . . . . 147Controls

instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . 81mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143, 146power seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140steering column . . . . . . . . . . . . 99

Coolant (see Engine coolant) . . . . . . . 301checking and adding . . . . . . . . . 301drain and flush . . . . . . . . . . . . 306preparing for storage . . . . . . . . . 362proper solution . . . . . . . . . . . . 303refill capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . 353specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . . . 78

Cooling fan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280Crankcase emission filter. . . . . . . . . 356Cruise control (see Speed control) . . . . 106Customer Assistance Center, Ford (U.S.). . 261Customer Assistance Centre,

Ford of Canada. . . . . . . . . . 261, 268

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 374: 1996 econoline

382 Index

D

Dashboard (see Instrument panel) . . . . . . 81Daytime running light system . . . . . . . 93Defects, reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . 266Dipstick

automatic transmission fluid . . . . 322, 324engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . 328

Disabled vehicle (see Towing) . . . . . . 258Dispute Settlement Board . . . . . . . . 262Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113Driveline universal joint and slip yoke . . 326Driving under special conditions

bad weather . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216heavy load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218high speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215high water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217slippery roads . . . . . . . . . . . . 216tips for safe driving . . . . . . . . . . 214towing a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . 219

E

Electrical systemcircuit breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . 339fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331, 338operating when the engine is off . . . . . 56power point outlet . . . . . . . . . . 148

Electronic AM radio (see Electronic soundsystem). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187

Electronic radio with cassette(see Electronic sound system) . . . . . 178

Electronic sound systemradio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . 190tuning the radio . . . . . 151, 165, 180, 188warranty and service information. . . . 193

Electronic stereo cassette radio(see Electronic sound system) . . . . . 178

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 375: 1996 econoline

Index 383

Electronic stereo radio(see Electronic sound system) . . . . . 178

Emergencies, roadsideassistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259battery acid spills . . . . . . . . . 243, 321jump-starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258

Emergency brake (parking brake) . . . . . 212Emission control system . . . . . . . . . 346

catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . 346emissions warranty . . . . . . . 4, 346, 349

Enginecheck engine warning light . . . . . . . 71diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6fuel injected engine, starting . . . . . 57, 59fuel pump shut-off switch . . . . . . . . 63preparing to start . . . . . . . . . . . . 58refill capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . 353service points . . . . . . . . . . . . 283starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55, 59starting after a collision . . . . . . . . . 63storing your vehicle. . . . . . . . 361–362

Engine block heater . . . . . . . . . . . . 62Engine coolant

checking and adding . . . . . . . . . 301checking hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . 305disposal . . . . . . . . . . . 301, 304, 324drain and flush . . . . . . . . . . . . 306preparing for storage . . . . . . . . . 362proper solution . . . . . . . . . . . . 303recovery reservoir . . . . . . . . 283, 302refill capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . 353refill procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . 306specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . . . 78

Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . . 78

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 376: 1996 econoline

384 Index

Engine fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280Engine knocking. . . . . . . . . . . . . 290Engine oil

changing oil and oil filter . . . . . . . 300checking and adding . . . . . . . . . 298dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298disposal . . . . . . . . . . . 301, 304, 324engine oil pressure gauge . . . . . . . . 76filter, specifications . . . . . . . . . . 356refill capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . 353specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297synthetic oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297“break-in” oils . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297

Entry systemilluminated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116

Exhaust fumes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65Extended Service Plan, Ford . . . . . . . . 4

F

Fan, engine fan, avoiding injury . . . . . 280Federal Communications Commission . . . 192Federal Highway Administration

Regulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7Flashers, hazard . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103Flashing the lights . . . . . . . . . . . . 101Flat tire. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247Fluid refill capacities . . . . . . . . . . . 353Ford Customer Assistance Center . . . . . 261Ford Dispute Settlement Board . . . . . . 262Ford Extended Service Plan . . . . . . . . 4Ford Motor Company of Canada . . . . . 268Ford of Canada Customer

Assistance Centre . . . . . . . . . . . 268Foreign registration . . . . . . . . . . . 267Four-Wheel Drive vehicles, special notice . . 5French owner guides, how to obtain . . . . 3

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 377: 1996 econoline

Index 385

Fuelcalculating fuel economy . . . . . . . 295capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353choosing the right fuel . . . . . . . . 289comparisons with EPA fuel economy

estimates . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296filling your vehicle with fuel. . . . . . 287filter, specifications . . . . . . . . . . 356fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77improving fuel economy . . . . . . . 296octane rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290quality. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289, 291running out of fuel . . . . . . . . . . 295safety information relating to

automotive fuels . . . . . . . . . . 292storing your vehicle. . . . . . . . . . 362treating emergencies . . . . . . . . . 292

Fuel capremoving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288replacing. . . . . . . . . . . . . 288, 294

Fuel filler door . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288remote release . . . . . . . . . . . . 287

Fuel filter, specifications . . . . . . . . . 356Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77Fuel pump shut-off switch

engine does not start . . . . . . . . . . 63starting after a collision . . . . . . . . . 63

Fuse panels, instrument panel . . . . 332, 338Fuses

charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338checking and replacing . . . . . . . . 338circuit breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . 339

G

Gas cap (see Fuel cap) . . . . . . . . . . 287Gas mileage (see Fuel economy) . . . 289, 295Gasoline (see Fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . 287

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 378: 1996 econoline

386 Index

Gauges, Mechanicalbattery voltage gauge . . . . . . . . . . 75charging system gauge . . . . . . . . . 75engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . 78engine oil pressure gauge . . . . . . . . 76fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79

GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)calculating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225definition. . . . . . . . . . . . . 218, 223driving with a heavy load . . . . . . . 218

Gearshiftautomatic operation . . . . . . . . 195, 200column-mounted . . . . . . . . . 195, 200locking the gearshift. . . . . . . . . . . 55positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195, 200shifting the gears . . . . . . . . . 195, 200shift-lock . . . . . . . . . . . 60, 196, 202

Gearshift:shifting the gears . . . . . . 195, 200GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)

calculating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225definition. . . . . . . . . . . . . 218, 223driving with a heavy load . . . . . . . 218

H

Hazard flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103Headlamps

aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340checking alignment . . . . . . . . . . 340cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93daytime running lights . . . . . . . . . 93flashing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101high beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100replacing bulbs . . . . . . . . . . 340–341turning on and off . . . . . . . . . . . 92warning chime . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77

Heatingheating and air conditioning system . . . 87

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 379: 1996 econoline

Index 387

Heating (continued)standard heater system . . . . . . . . . 83

High beamsindicator light . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92, 100

High-mount brakelampdescription . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343replacing the bulb . . . . . . . . . . 343

High-mount brakelamp:location . . . . . . 96Hitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237Hood

latch location . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281release lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281working under the hood . . . . . . . 280

Horn. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104Hoses, checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305

IIdentification Number, Vehicle (VIN) . . . . 6Idle, relearning . . . . . . . . . 57, 247, 280Ignition

chime . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56positions of the ignition . . . . . . . . . 55removing the key . . . . . . . . . . . . 56

Indicator lights and chimes (see Lights) . . . 67Infant seats (see Safety seats) . . . . . . 38, 41Instrument cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67

mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69Instrument panel

cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97lighting up panel and interior . . . . . . 94location of components . . . . . . . . . 81registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83

Interval wipers . . . . . . . . . . . 101–102

JJack

operation . . . . . . . . . . . . 250, 252positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 380: 1996 econoline

388 Index

Jump-starting your vehicleattaching cables . . . . . . . . . . . . 245disconnecting cables . . . . . . . . . . 247

KKeys

key in ignition chime . . . . . . . . . . 56positions of the ignition . . . . . . . . . 55removing from the ignition . . . . . . . 56stuck in lock position . . . . . . . . 55–56

LLamps

cargo lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340courtesy lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94daytime running light system . . . . . . 93dome lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94flashing the lamps. . . . . . . . . . . 101hazard flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . 103headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92high beams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100high-mount brakelamp . . . . . . 96, 343illuminated entry system. . . . . . . . 120illuminated mirrors . . . . . . . . . . 143instrument panel, dimming . . . . . . . 94interior lamps. . . . . . . . . . . . 92, 94replacing bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . 340

Lane change indicator (see Turn signal) . . . 99Lap belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22Lights, warning and indicator

air bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74anti-lock brakes (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . 70anti-theft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69charging system. . . . . . . . . . . . . 74check engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71engine oil pressure . . . . . . . . . . . 76hazard warning light . . . . . . . . . 103

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 381: 1996 econoline

Index 389

Lights, warning and indicator (continued)high beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77overdrive off . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201rear ABS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70safety belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71testing the warning lights . . . . . . . . 58theft system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75turn signal indicator . . . . . . . . . . 99

Load limitsGAWR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218GVWR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218trailer towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . 220

Lubricant specifications . . . . . . . . . 357Lug nuts

standard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252tightening sequence . . . . . . . . . . 255

Lumbar support, seats . . . . . . . . . . 141

M

Maintenance schedule and record(see separate Maintenance Scheduleand Record booklet) . . . . . . . . . . 3

Maintenance (see Servicing) . . . . . . . 279Master cylinder, brakes . . . . . . . . . 326Mileage, calculating fuel economy . . . . 295Mirrors

dual electric remote control . . . . . . 146rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143side view mirrors (manual) . . . . . . 144side view mirrors (power) . . . . . . . 146vanity mirror. . . . . . . . . . . . . 143vanity mirror, illuminated . . . . . . . 143

Motorcraft parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . 356

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 382: 1996 econoline

390 Index

NNational Highway Traffic Safety

Administration . . . . . . . . . . . . 266New vehicle break-in . . . . . . . . . . . 8

OOctane rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290Odometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80Oil filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300, 356Oil (see Engine oil) . . . . . . . . . . . 297Oil viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297On-board diagnostic (OBD II) system . . . 351Order forms, service information . . . . . 152Overdrive. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203Overseas offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267

PPanic alarm feature, remote entry system . 117Parking brake

operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69

Parts (see Motorcraft Parts) . . . . . . . . 356PCV valve, specifications . . . . . . . . . 356Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . 116Power features

door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116lumbar support . . . . . . . . . . . . 141mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143, 146seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123–124

Power point electrical outlet . . . . . . . 148Power steering

dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328driving with power steering . . . . . . 206fluid, checking and adding. . . . . . . 328fluid, refill capacity . . . . . . . . . . 353fluid, specifications . . . . . . . . . . 329servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206

Prop rod, hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 383: 1996 econoline

Index 391

RRadio (see Electronic sound systems) . . . 149Rear anti-lock brakes . . . . . . . . . . 208Rear axle

lubricant specification . . . . . . . . . 357refill capacity. . . . . . . . . . . . . 353traction lok. . . . . . . . . . . . 216, 312

Rear window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123washer reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . 308

Refill capacities for fluids . . . . . . . . 353Remote entry system . . . . . . . . . . 116

arming and disarming the anti-theftsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118

illuminated entry . . . . . . . . . . . 120locking/unlocking doors . . . . . . . 117panic alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117replacement/additional transmitters . . 120replacing the batteries . . . . . . . . . 118

Reporting safety defects . . . . . . . . . 266Restraints, safety (see Safety restraints)

adult . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11child. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38infant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38, 41

Roadside assistance . . . . . . . . . . . 259Roadside emergencies . . . . . . . . . . 243Rotating the tires . . . . . . . . . . . . 312

SSafe driving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . 214Safety belts (see Safety restraints) . . . . . . 11Safety chains, when towing a trailer . . . 238Safety defects, reporting . . . . . . . . . 266Safety information relating to automotive

fuels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292Safety restraints

automatic locking mode (retractor) . . . . 13center front lap belt . . . . . . . . . . . 22center rear lap belt . . . . . . . . . . . 22cleaning the safety belts . . . . . . . . . 28

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 384: 1996 econoline

392 Index

Safety restraints (continued)dual locking mode retractors . . . . . . . 13extension assembly . . . . . . . . . . . 27for adults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11for children. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38for infants . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38, 41for pregnant women. . . . . . . . . . . 11for third row bench seats . . . . . . . . 16lap and shoulder belts . . . . . . . . . . 14maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28proper use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28untwisting or unjamming the safety belt . 24warning light and chime. . . . . . . . . 71

Safety seats for childrenand air bags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41attaching with tether straps . . . . . . . 53in front seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41in rear outboard . . . . . . . . . . . . 41in rear seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41tether anchorage hardware . . . . . . . . 53

Seat belts (see Safety restraints) . . . . . . . 11Seats

adjusting the seat, manual . . . . . . . 124adjusting the seats, power . . . . . . . 140bench, removable . . . . . . . . . . . 129bench, three passenger. . . . . . . . . 129child safety seats . . . . . . . . . . . . 41cleaning upholstery . . . . . . . . . . 141lumbar support . . . . . . . . . . . . 141quick release rear captain’s chair . . . . 126seat/bed conversion . . . . . . . . . . 138

Serial number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . 6Service concerns . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260Servicing your vehicle

precautions when servicing . . . . . . 280servicing when you tow . . . . . . . . 258

Shift-lock system . . . . . . . . 60, 196, 202Shift positions (see Gearshift) . . . . . 195, 200

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 385: 1996 econoline

Index 393

Shoulder and lap belts(see Safety restraints) . . . . . . . . . . 14

Shoulder belts (see Safety restraints) . . . . 14Side mirrors, adjusting. . . . . . . . . . 146Snow tires and chains . . . . . . . . . . 318Spare tire

changing the tire . . . . . . . . . 247, 250conventional spare . . . . . . . . . . 247finding the spare . . . . . . . . . . . 248removing the spare tire . . . . . . . . 248

Spark plugs, specifications . . . . . . . . 356Special driving conditions . . . . . . . . 214Special notice

ambulance conversions . . . . . . . . . 5diesel-powered vehicles . . . . . . . . . 6

Specification chart, lubricants. . . . . . . 357Speed control

accelerating . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108canceling a set speed . . . . . . . . . 111resetting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108resuming a set speed . . . . . . . . . 111tap up/tap down . . . . . . . . . . . 108when towing a trailer . . . . . . . . . 239

Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79Starting your vehicle

preparing to start your vehicle . . . . . . 58starting a cold engine . . . . . . . . . . 59starting after a collision . . . . . . . . . 63starting a warm engine . . . . . . . . . 60starting your vehicle if the battery

is disabled . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243Steering, power . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206Steering wheel

horn. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55speed controls . . . . . . . . . . . . 106tilting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105

Storage compartmentscenter console . . . . . . . . . . . . 147underseat storage drawer . . . . . . . 142

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 386: 1996 econoline

394 Index

Storing your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 361Supplemental air bag readiness light . . . . 74Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) . . . . 29

T

Tail lamps, cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . 93Temperature control (see Climate control) . . 83Testing the warning lights . . . . . . . . . 58Tether anchor installation

(see Child restraints) . . . . . . . . . . 53Tilt steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . 105Tires

changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247checking the pressure . . . . . . . 310–311cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319inspection and maintenance . . . . . . 311replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315rotating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312snow tires and chains . . . . . . . . . 318spare tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247–248storing your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 363tire grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315treadwear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315wear bands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315wheel and tire matching . . . . . . . . 318

Towing a trailer (see Trailer towing) . . . 219Towing your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 258

with a tow truck . . . . . . . . . . . 258Traction-lok rear axle . . . . . . . . 216, 312Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219Trailer towing

calculating maximum trailer weight . . . 225safety chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238trailer brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238

Transmissionautomatic operation . . . . . . . . 195, 200

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 387: 1996 econoline

Index 395

Transmission (continued)fluid, checking and adding (automatic) . 323fluid, refill capacities . . . . . . . . . 353lubricant specifications . . . . . . . . 357

Transmission control switch . . . . . 197, 203Transmitter (see Remote entry) . . . . . . 116Tune-up specifications (VECI) . . . . . . 348Turn signal

indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99

UUsed engine oil, disposal . . . . 301, 304, 324

VVanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143Variable interval wipers . . . . . . . . . 102VECI (Vehicle Emission

Control Information) decal. . . . . . . 348Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . . . . 6Vehicle loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220

calculating the load . . . . . . . . . . 225Vehicle storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361Ventilating your vehicle

(see Climate control) . . . . . . . . . . 83Viscosity (see Engine oil) . . . . . . . . 297Voltmeter (see Battery voltage gauge) . . . . 75

WWarm engine, starting . . . . . . . . . . . 60Warning chimes

headlamps on . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77key in ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56safety belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71

Warning lights, testing. . . . . . . . . . . 58Warning lights (see Lights). . . . . . . . . 67Warranties

basic. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4

File:ltixe.exUpdate:Wed Apr 17 08:36:26 1996

Page 388: 1996 econoline

39 6 Index

Warranties (continued)radio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193

Warranty Informatio n Bookle t . . . . . . . 4Washer fluid

rear window reservoir. . . . . . . . . 308reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308windshiel d . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308

Weight limit s (GAWR, GVWR ). . . . . . 218Wheel and tire matching. . . . . . . . . 318Wheel bearing s lubrican t specification s . . 357Wheel dollie s (see Towing ). . . . . . . . 258Wheels

cleanin g . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252inspectio n and maintenanc e . . . . . . 310lug nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250replacemen t . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318

Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123power windows, operating. . . . . . . 123

Windshield , washing. . . . . . . . . . . 101Windshiel d washer flui d and wipers . . . 101

checkin g and adding flui d. . . . . . . 308checkin g and replacin g wiper blades . . 309liftgat e reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . 308operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308specification s . . . . . . . . . . . 308, 357variabl e interval wipers . . . . . . . . 102

Windshiel d wipers and washer. . . . . . 101Wrecker towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258